Attached files

file filename
EX-23.1 - EX-23.1 - CVENT INCd642717dex231.htm
Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 16, 2014

Registration No. 333-193188

 

 

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

 

Amendment No. 2 to

FORM S-1

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

Under

The Securities Act of 1933

 

CVENT, INC.

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware   7372   54-1954458

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

 

(Primary Standard Industrial

Classification Code Number)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification Number)

Cvent, Inc.

8180 Greensboro Dr.

9th Floor

McLean, VA 22102

(703) 226-3500

(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of Registrant’s principal executive offices)

 

 

 

Rajeev K. Aggarwal

Chief Executive Officer

Cvent, Inc.

8180 Greensboro Dr.

9th Floor

McLean, VA 22102

(703) 226-3500

(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)

 

 

 

Copies to:

Mark R. Fitzgerald, Esq.

Michael C. Labriola, Esq.

Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati,

Professional Corporation

1700 K Street, N.W., Fifth Floor

Washington, D.C. 20006

Telephone: (202) 973 8800

Facsimile: (202) 973 8899

 

Lawrence Samuelson

General Counsel and Corporate Secretary

Cvent, Inc.

8180 Greensboro Dr.

9th Floor

McLean, VA 22102

Telephone: (703) 226-3500

 

Richard D. Truesdell, Jr., Esq.

Davis Polk & Wardwell LLP

450 Lexington Avenue

New York, New York 10017

Telephone: (212) 450-4000

Facsimile: (212) 701-5800

 

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.

If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box. ¨

If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. ¨

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. ¨

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer ¨

   Accelerated filer ¨

Non-accelerated filer x (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

   Smaller reporting company ¨

 

 

 

The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a) may determine.

 

 


Table of Contents

EXPLANATORY NOTE

 

The sole purpose of this Amendment No. 2 to Registration Statement on Form S-1 of the Registrant is to identify one additional selling stockholder that was not previously participating in the offering described herein. Neither the total number of shares subject to this offering nor the total number of shares offered by the selling stockholders is increased as a result of the inclusion of this additional selling stockholder. The respective number of shares offered by the other selling stockholders has been reduced on a pro rata basis accordingly.


Table of Contents

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

PROSPECTUS (Subject to completion)

Issued January 16, 2014

4,800,000 Shares

 

LOGO

 

 

Cvent, Inc. is offering 650,000 shares of its common stock and the selling stockholders identified in this prospectus are offering an additional 4,150,000 shares. We will not receive any of the proceeds from the sale of the shares being sold by the selling stockholders.

 

 

Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CVT.” On January 14, 2014, the last reported sale price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange was $35.86 per share.

 

 

We are an “emerging growth company” as defined under the federal securities laws and, as such, we may elect to comply with certain reduced public company reporting requirements for future filings. Investing in our common stock involves risks. See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 14.

 

 

PRICE $         A SHARE

 

 

 

      

Price to

  Public  

      

Underwriting

Discounts

and

Commissions(1)

      

Proceeds to
      Cvent      

      

Proceeds to
Selling
Stockholders

 

Per Share

       $                    $                    $                    $            

Total

       $                               $                               $                               $                       

 

  (1)   We have agreed to reimburse the underwriters for certain expenses. See “Underwriting.”

We and the selling stockholders have granted the underwriters the right to purchase up to an additional 720,000 shares of common stock at the price to public less underwriting discounts and commissions.

The Securities and Exchange Commission and state securities regulators have not approved or disapproved these securities, or determined if this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

The underwriters expect to deliver the shares of common stock to purchasers on                     , 2014.

 

 

 

MORGAN STANLEY   GOLDMAN, SACHS & CO.

 

PACIFIC CREST SECURITIES

 

            STIFEL

   NEEDHAM & COMPANY

                    , 2014


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page  

Prospectus Summary

     1   

Risk Factors

     14   

Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements

     37   

Industry Data

     37   

Use of Proceeds

     38   

Market Price of Common Stock

     38   

Dividend Policy

     38   

Capitalization

     39   

Dilution

     40   

Selected Consolidated Financial Data

     41   

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

     43   

Business

     74   
 

 

 

 

Neither we nor the underwriters have authorized anyone to provide you with information that is different from that contained in this prospectus or in any free writing prospectus we may authorize to be delivered or made available to you. We take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. We and the underwriters are offering to sell shares of common stock and seeking offers to buy shares of common stock only in jurisdictions where offers and sales are permitted. The information contained in this prospectus is accurate only as of the date on the front of this prospectus, regardless of the time of delivery of this prospectus or any sale of shares of our common stock.

 

For investors outside the United States: Neither we nor the underwriters have done anything that would permit this offering, or possession or distribution of this prospectus, in any jurisdiction where action for that purpose is required, other than in the United States. Persons outside the United States who come into possession of this prospectus must inform themselves about, and observe any restrictions relating to, the offering of the shares of common stock and the distribution of this prospectus outside of the United States.

 

i


Table of Contents

 

 

 

(This page left intentionally blank)

 

 

 

 

 

ii


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

 

This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus and does not contain all of the information that you should consider in making your investment decision. Before investing in our common stock, you should carefully read this entire prospectus, including our consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto and the information set forth under the sections “Risk Factors” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” in each case included in this prospectus. Some of the statements in this prospectus constitute forward-looking statements. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.” Unless the context requires otherwise, the words “we,” “us,” “our” and “Cvent” refer to Cvent, Inc.

 

CVENT, INC.

 

Our Mission

 

Our mission is to transform the events and meetings industry. Our software platform disrupts the traditional processes for the event planners who organize events and the venues that host them, creating more value for the entire events and meetings ecosystem.

 

Overview

 

We are a leading cloud-based enterprise event management platform. We provide solutions for both sides of the events and meetings value chain: (i) event and meeting planners, and (ii) hotels and venues. Our integrated, cloud-based solution addresses the entire event lifecycle by allowing event and meeting planners to organize, market and manage their meetings, conferences, tradeshows and other events. Our online marketplace connects event planners and venues through our vertical search engine that accesses our proprietary database of detailed hotel and venue information. The combination of these solutions creates an integrated platform that allows us to generate revenue from both sides of the events and meetings value chain.

 

Events and meetings reach across every industry vertical, from consumer products to energy to healthcare. A 2013 independent study conducted by Frost & Sullivan, which was commissioned by us, estimated that the global event management software market was $5.6 billion in 2012, which we view as an immediately addressable opportunity. The same study estimated that the global market for non-software event and meeting management was $22 billion in 2012, which included the additional labor of planning, managing and executing events and meetings using manual processes that we believe our platform could address and make more efficient.

 

For the event and meeting planner side of the value chain, which includes enterprises such as corporations, associations, not-for-profits, government agencies and universities, events and meetings are an integral way to build and strengthen relationships with customers, prospects, employees and partners. Enterprise events and meetings include external events, such as conferences, tradeshows, and customer summits, as well as internal functions, such as sales meetings, training seminars and team-building events. According to a 2013 study conducted by Frost & Sullivan, enterprises spend an average of 1.1% of their revenue on events and meetings.

 

Planning and running an event can be a highly complex, inefficient and time-consuming task when managed using traditional manual processes and disparate point software solutions. We address these challenges by providing planners an integrated platform with solutions that unify the full lifecycle of an event. Meeting planners use our solutions to identify the appropriate venue, secure a competitive proposal from hotels, manage budgets, market the event, send invitations, utilize pre-event surveys, establish a social media presence for the event, process registrations, manage fee collections, build an event-specific mobile app, manage event logistics such as travel and lodging, survey and engage attendees, and analyze event results and survey feedback following the event. Our platform helps planners decrease costs and increase attendance for their events.

 

 

1


Table of Contents

For the hotel and venue side of the value chain, group events and meetings are a vital source of revenue and profit. At certain types of hotels, group events and meetings can constitute approximately one-third of total revenue. Group meeting business is often a large hotel’s most profitable segment as these groups typically contract not only for significant sleeping room blocks, but also for meeting space, catering and audio visual equipment. Meeting attendees are often a captive audience at the hotel that can generate substantial incremental revenue.

 

Our online marketplace, the Cvent Supplier Network, or CSN, connects tens of thousands of event and meeting planners seeking the best venue for their event with more than 200,000 venues featured in our proprietary database. We believe that our CSN contains the world’s largest, most accurate database of detailed venue information with listings of hotels and venues in more than 175 countries that can be searched and filtered based on approximately 200 characteristics and data fields. Our CSN has become a leading solution for event and meeting planners who are researching potential locations and venues for their events, as well as for hotels and venues that are seeking to increase their group business revenue. The number of event requests for proposal, or RFPs, submitted through our CSN has increased from approximately 12,000 in 2008 to approximately 1.1 million in 2012 and to more than 947,000 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013.1 We believe we have achieved critical mass and are benefiting from substantial network effects by simultaneously increasing the volume of RFPs transmitted from planners to venues, expanding our proprietary venue database and growing the number of hotel personnel trained on and using our system.

 

Our dual role as a provider to both event planners and venues allows us to generate revenue from both sides of the value chain. Event and meeting planners enter into annual and multi-year subscription contracts to utilize our cloud-based event and meeting management software solutions. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 6,700 event and meeting planner customers, including Aimia Proprietary Loyalty (formerly Carlson Marketing), Corporate Executive Board, Edwards Lifesciences, Incisive Media, Maritz Travel Company, Merck KGaA, Visa, Walmart and Wellpoint Health Networks. Hotels and venues enter into annual and multi-year contracts with us for marketing solutions that increase the prominence of their properties in our CSN. As of September 30, 2013, more than 5,600 hotels and venues have purchased marketing solutions from us, including brands such as Hilton, Hyatt, IHG (InterContinental Hotels Group), Marriott and Starwood.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2012, our revenue was $83.5 million, representing year-over-year revenue growth of 37%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2013, our revenue was $80.4 million, a 34% increase over the same period in 2012. Our enterprise-focused, cloud-based platform for event and meeting planners has historically constituted the majority of our revenue and represented 70% of our total revenue for the year ended December 31, 2012 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2013. For the year ended December 31, 2012, we generated net income of $4.3 million, representing a margin of 5%, and adjusted EBITDA2 of $20.3 million, representing a margin of 24%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2013, we generated a net loss of $2.8 million and adjusted EBITDA of $12.7 million, representing an adjusted EBITDA margin of 16%.

 

Industry Background

 

The hospitality and travel industry serves three types of customers: individual business travelers, leisure travelers, and group events and meetings. In the 1990s, American Express began offering travel services and subsequently transformed the way business travelers book hotel rooms and air travel. In the 2000s, online travel

 

  1    For an explanation of how we measure number of RFPs transmitted, see “—Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Key Metrics.”
  2    Adjusted EBITDA is not calculated in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP. A reconciliation of this non-GAAP measure to the most directly comparable GAAP measure along with a summary of the definition and its material limitations are included at footnote (2) of “—Summary Consolidated Financial Statements—Other Financial Metrics.”

 

 

2


Table of Contents

agencies revolutionized the industry for leisure travelers. We believe that we are driving a similar revolution today in the way group events and meetings are planned, booked and managed, both by the event planners and the hotels and venues that host these events.

 

Key Issues and Industry Trends Affecting Event and Meeting Planners

 

Highly Complex Planning Process. Planning and running a group meeting or event is a highly complex, tedious and often manual process that requires event planners to coordinate across numerous internal departments and external constituencies, including the event venue, service providers and potential attendees. Event and meeting planners have historically lacked an integrated software platform to manage and automate their activities.

 

Continued Importance of Events and Meetings. Events and meetings are among the most high-profile and high-impact marketing initiatives available to an enterprise. Mission critical events such as product launches and user conferences provide enterprises with a valuable opportunity to maximize their marketing and sales potential by having as many as hundreds, or even thousands, of customers, partners and employees all in one location. We believe that events and meetings represent approximately one quarter of an organization’s marketing budget. As a result, we believe that Chief Marketing Officers and other C-level executives are increasingly focused on events and meetings and seeking solutions to ensure they succeed.

 

Need for More Visibility Into Event and Meeting Expenses and Return on Investment. Many event and meeting planners, as well as others within their organizations, are seeking more transparency regarding the true costs of an event and looking to justify the return on investment for their events, while also ensuring that the events are effectively designed, planned and managed to meet targeted objectives. In addition, certain event planners in more regulated environments, such as pharmaceutical sales, are also facing increased regulatory reporting and accountability requirements that are not easily manageable with manual processes.

 

Increasing Number of Channels to Engage with Attendees. With the recent emergence of more diverse communication channels, including email, online marketing and social media platforms, event planners face a wide variety of options to market their event, increase engagement and more easily connect with attendees. However, many event planners struggle to efficiently present a consistent message across the numerous channels through which they are interacting with attendees.

 

Events are Increasingly Mobile. With the mass proliferation of mobile devices, attendees and event planners increasingly expect to use dedicated mobile applications, or apps, at events.

 

Key Issues and Industry Trends Affecting Hotels and Venues

 

Fiercely Competitive Hospitality Landscape. The global hospitality industry has become more competitive, and the group events and meetings segment has become increasingly important to the ultimate success or failure of many hotels. Frost & Sullivan estimates that group events and meetings represented $103 billion of revenue in 2012 globally for hotels. As a result, hotels spent an estimated aggregate of $3.9 billion on marketing and advertising to win that business. Group revenue often constitutes a large hotel’s most profitable segment, and the competition among hotels for event business continues to escalate.

 

Hotel Budgets for Group Marketing Shifting to Digital Mediums. Worldwide ad spending continues to shift from traditional mediums to online and mobile channels. Hotels are beginning to realize the power of online advertising.

 

Hotels Have Under-Invested in Group Segment Sales Relative to their Revenue Contribution. Although group events and meetings can account for approximately one-third of revenue for certain types of hotels, hotels on average spent only 13% of their marketing budget to solicit events and meetings business according to a 2013 study conducted by Frost & Sullivan. Hotels frequently find it challenging to identify event and meeting planners

 

 

3


Table of Contents

and even more difficult to market to them. Given the right marketing solutions to identify and engage event planners more accurately, we expect their marketing spending mix to increase in favor of the group events segment.

 

Harnessing Technology to Automate Operations and Improve Performance. Many hotels use a variety of media channels to respond to RFPs, which can result in inefficient and non-standardized RFP response processes. Hotels that host a high volume of events and meetings can benefit from software for their group business segments that enhances sales and marketing activities, automates and improves the RFP process, and captures data that can provide actionable insights and increase the conversion of group sales leads.

 

The Cvent Solution

 

Solutions for Event and Meeting Planners. We offer planners a robust platform that addresses the entire lifecycle of events and meetings, including budgeting, planning, venue sourcing, marketing, management and measurement of meetings. We offer six major product categories: event management software, strategic meetings management software, mobile event apps, pre- and post-event web surveys, ticketing software and the Cvent Supplier Network. Our cloud-based platform allows event and meeting planners to:

 

   

Increase Event and Meeting Attendance. By offering integrated, multi-channel marketing and event registration solutions, we believe that we enable event and meeting planners to drive higher attendance at their events in a cost-effective manner.

 

   

Increase Efficiency through Automation. Our solutions automate and streamline the labor-intensive process of organizing, marketing and managing events and meetings.

 

   

Reduce Costs. Our solutions automate many tasks for event and meeting planners creating the potential for increased efficiency and cost savings. They also enable procurement professionals to define sophisticated thresholds and controls to restrict meeting planners from making unauthorized or out-of-policy expenditures.

 

   

Enhance Returns on Investment from Events and Meetings. Our solutions enable planners to regularly reach out to potential attendees through social media and surveys, build more accurate customer profiles and databases, customize event communications and send automated event reminders. Our software enables event planners to capture and analyze a wide variety of attendee metrics, and we believe it allows them to improve their future events with these insights.

 

Solutions for Hotels and Venues. Through the Cvent Supplier Network, we have created a proprietary online marketplace to connect hotels and venues with enterprise event and meeting planners. Our CSN allows hotels and venues to:

 

   

Increase Revenue in the Group Events and Meetings Segment. Our CSN is an effective solution to help hotels increase the number of in-bound sales leads and amount of revenue from enterprise event and meeting planners.

 

   

More Accurately Target Meeting Planners through Online Marketing. Through our online marketing solutions, hotels and venues are able to target ready-to-transact event and meeting planners in a more cost efficient manner than many other marketing channels. Our solutions also make it easier for hotels and venues to market to hard-to-identify relevant planner personnel within organizations, which results in an increase in the number of sales leads and converted group bookings.

 

   

Enhance Employee Productivity and Efficiency. Through our CSN, we offer hotels and venues tools to automate and standardize the process by which they receive and respond to RFPs from event and meeting planners. During the nine months ended September 30, 2013, more than 947,000 RFPs were transmitted using our standardized format and could be easily pre-populated by hotels and venues with responses, enabling hotel and venue employees to respond quickly and accurately.

 

 

4


Table of Contents
   

Better Analyze Operational Results. Hotels and venues can closely track the volume of potential and actual business that they receive through our CSN allowing them to more effectively measure the return on marketing investments. Managers can also improve the performance and productivity of their sales representatives by monitoring responsiveness to RFPs and tracking successful bids.

 

Our Competitive Strengths

 

We believe that the following competitive strengths differentiate us from our competitors:

 

End-to-End, Cloud-Based Software Platform. We offer an integrated cloud-based software platform that addresses the entire lifecycle of events and meetings. We believe that our ability to offer the entire suite of event and meeting management solutions on a single integrated platform is a key competitive differentiator for us compared to some of our competitors that typically offer only point solutions.

 

Massive Online Marketplace. We believe that the Cvent Supplier Network is an important resource for event and meeting planners as well as hotels and venues due to its:

 

   

Depth and Breadth of Venue Profiles. The Cvent Supplier Network includes detailed meeting profile information on more than 200,000 hotels and other venues, substantially more than the number of venues listed by any of our competitors. Our CSN allows planners to conduct searches and filters based on approximately 200 characteristics and data fields per hotel profile. The size and accuracy of the database is of critical importance to planners because they want to ensure that they use the most comprehensive and current database when selecting a venue for their meeting.

 

   

RFP Volume. The RFPs sent through the Cvent Supplier Network during the nine months ended September 30, 2013, represented an estimated total of 15.6 million hotel room nights requested and 42.4 million attendee days.3) For hotel partners that manage the largest number of properties, we believe that our CSN is an important external source for group business leads.

 

   

Integration with Hotels. Thousands of hotel managers have been trained to respond promptly to RFPs submitted by planners through our CSN. As of September 30, 2013, there are more than 139,000 hotel and venue employee user accounts within our system to respond to RFPs.

 

Powerful Network Effects Across the Value Chain. By bringing together both sides of the value chain, our CSN creates significant network effects.

 

   

Event and meeting planners use our CSN, generally at no cost, to search for venues, request price quotes and proposals from hotels and venues and compare proposals to identify the venue that best meets their needs and requirements. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 57,000 active CSN event and meeting planner users as compared to the approximately 50,000 active CSN event and meeting planner users as of December 31, 2012. The CSN is available with the same functionality to users of our paid subscription event and meeting platform solutions as well as to event and meeting planners that simply visit the CSN site and establish a free user account. All of these users have the ability to submit RFPs to hotels and venues free of charge using the CSN. We consider an event and meeting planner to be “active” if such user accessed their account within the 12 months preceding the date of measurement.

 

   

Hotels and event venues are listed, free-of-charge, in our CSN and can receive and respond to event proposal requests from meeting planners. Due to the extensive scope of our marketplace, many hotels have integrated our CSN into their core back-end technical systems. To date, more than 10,000 hotels have integrated their customer relationship management software systems with our platform.

 

  3    For an explanation of how we measure room nights requested, see “—Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Key Metrics.”

 

 

5


Table of Contents

As the volume of RFPs delivered to hotels and venues through the Cvent Supplier Network increases, we become even more important to hotels and venues. As more hotels and venues realize the potential of our CSN, the number of listings in our CSN will continue to grow, making it more valuable to event and meeting planners. Greater usage by more event planners increases the volume of RFPs delivered to hotels and venues, thereby increasing the value we deliver to those hotels and venues.

 

Relationships with Extensive Number of Event and Meeting Planners. We have created a large, proprietary database of individuals who we believe engage in event and meeting planning activities within their organizations. With the size and scale of our database, as well as our 157,000 aggregate prospect interactions with planners during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 alone, we believe that we are highly effective at proactively and systematically identifying and building relationships with event and meeting planners.

 

Recurring Revenue Model. Our subscription-based model for our event and meeting planner platform along with our annual or multi-year marketing solutions results in strong visibility and predictability of future revenue, enhancing our ability to effectively manage our business.

 

Strategic Capabilities in India. As of September 30, 2013, we employed approximately 750 personnel in India. Our Indian operations help us accomplish three important business objectives: (i) near-continuous technical development and customer service, (ii) worldwide geographic reach for marketing efforts and (iii) building and maintaining our proprietary databases. These operations allow us to benefit from the labor and infrastructure cost advantages of the region and to accomplish many critical business tasks in an efficient and cost effective manner.

 

Strong Corporate Culture that Defines Us. Our corporate culture drives and defines us. Seven of the nine executive officers and key employees identified in the “Management” section of this prospectus, have been employed with us since 2000. We seek to hire highly talented, enthusiastic employees that will help us foster a positive workplace environment, and we also offer substantial training opportunities for those employees.

 

Our Growth Strategy

 

Aggressively Pursue New Customers. We believe that there is substantial opportunity to expand our business as adoption of technology platforms to manage events and meetings increases. According to a 2013 Frost & Sullivan study, 68% of organizations in the mid-market have never licensed event management software, and the majority of mid-market organizations’ events are still planned using manual processes. Likewise, their report also shows that 63% of large enterprises do not have a complete strategic meetings management program in place.

 

Up-Sell and Cross-Sell Existing Event Planner Customers. As of September 30, 2013, only 14% of our event and meeting planner customers paid us to use more than one of our solutions. We believe that as we enhance the functionality of our platform, our customers will not only renew their existing subscriptions but purchase additional solutions as well.

 

Up-Sell and Cross-Sell Existing Hotel Customers. In addition to the annual or multi-year marketing solutions available to increase their visibility in search results on our CSN, hotels and venues can reach an even greater number of meeting planners through other offerings that are a part of our platform. We continue to add specialized marketing placements and create new marketing inventory that hotels or venues can purchase. For example, venues can pay fees to be featured prominently in our Cvent Destination Guide, which is an online resource for planners in the early stages of researching and comparing cities for upcoming meetings. The Cvent Destination Guide received an average of 340,000 page views per month during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and covers 1,000 profiled destinations around the world through more than 11,000 pages of content to provide planners with destination-specific information and key statistics.

 

 

6


Table of Contents

Grow Our Revenue Outside North America. Our recent strategic focus on global expansion has increased our non-North American revenue from approximately 7% of our revenue for the year ended December 31, 2011 to approximately 9% of revenue for the year ended December 31, 2012 and 10% of revenue for the nine months ended September 30, 2013. To support our international expansion efforts and to increase global sales for all of our solutions, we opened our first European sales office in London in May 2013 and ultimately plan to expand our sales force in Europe. We also plan to introduce select European and Asian language planner interfaces in the near future.

 

Further Monetize the Cvent Supplier Network by Creating Value for Hotels and Venues. We can increase the value we provide to hotels by offering enhanced marketing solutions and analytics that enable them to better target event and meeting planners and increase their group meeting sales. We also expect to provide hotels and venues with additional marketing models beyond our current offerings, including more targeted options.

 

Expand Our Direct Sales Force and Channel Partners. We intend to expand our direct sales force to augment our current marketing efforts. We are also focused on improving and developing our relationships with our channel partners.

 

Enhance Our Mobile Applications and Social Media Offerings. We currently offer a platform that enables event and meeting planners to create and deploy mobile applications and social media offerings for both corporate and large consumer events. We have already made significant investments in the area of social media to enhance the social experience for attendees. We believe that these solutions and enhancements position us well to capitalize on the growing mobile trend.

 

Continue to Add New Solutions to Our Platform. Investing in research and development is an integral part of our long-term growth strategy and has been a key factor in solidifying our position as the industry’s leading event management platform. For example, since 2008, we developed the Cvent Supplier Network, our Strategic Meetings Management solution and the Cvent Destination Guide.

 

Risks Related to Our Business

 

Investing in our common stock involves risk. You should carefully consider all the information in this prospectus prior to investing in our common stock. These risks are discussed more fully in the section entitled “Risk Factors” immediately following this prospectus summary. These risks and uncertainties include, but are not limited to, the following:

 

   

We are substantially dependent upon customer renewals, the addition of new customers and the continued growth of the market for cloud-based event and meeting management solutions;

 

   

We are subject to U.S. and foreign data privacy and protection laws and regulations as well as contractual privacy obligations, and our failure to comply could subject us to fines and damages and would harm our reputation and business;

 

   

We have experienced rapid growth and organizational change in recent periods and expect continued future growth. If we fail to manage our growth effectively, we may be unable to execute our business plan, maintain high levels of service or address competitive challenges adequately;

 

   

Our long-term success depends, in part, on our ability to expand the sales of our solutions to customers located outside of the United States;

 

   

Our business depends on maintaining and expanding our relationships with hotel and venue providers; and

 

   

Claims by third parties that we infringe their intellectual property rights could result in significant costs and have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results or financial condition.

 

 

7


Table of Contents

Company Information

 

We were incorporated in 1999 as a Delaware corporation. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 1,400 employees at our operations in the United States, India and the United Kingdom. Our headquarters are located at 8180 Greensboro Dr., 9th Floor, McLean, VA 22102, and our telephone number is (703) 226-3500. You can access our website at www.cvent.com. Information contained on our website is not part of this prospectus and is not incorporated in this prospectus by reference.

 

 

 

We have registered the “CVENT,” “CVENT.COM,” “CROWDCOMPASS,” “CROWDTORCH” and “TICKETMOB” trademarks in the U.S. in certain classes of goods and services applicable to our business. We also have pending trademark applications for “CVENT,” “CROWDCOMPASS” and “CROWDTORCH” in the European Union, Canada, Australia and China. This prospectus also contains trademarks of other persons.

 

 

8


Table of Contents

THE OFFERING

 

Common stock offered by:

  

Us

   650,000 shares

The selling stockholders

   4,150,000 shares

Total

   4,800,000 shares

Total common stock to be outstanding after this offering

  

40,543,357 shares

Underwriters’ option to be offered by:

  

Us

   97,500 shares

The selling stockholders

   622,500 shares

Total

   720,000 shares

Use of proceeds

  

The principal purposes of this offering are to facilitate an orderly distribution of shares for the selling stockholders in the offering and increase our public float. The selling stockholders are selling a substantial majority of the shares of common stock being sold in this offering, including a substantial majority of the shares sold upon any exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of common stock by the selling stockholders.

 

We intend to use the net proceeds from the sale of common stock by us to pay for the expenses of this offering and any remainder for working capital and general corporate purposes, including further expansion of our operations and product development.

 

We will pay all of the expenses relating to the registration and offering of the shares sold by the selling stockholders, other than underwriting discounts and commissions relating to those shares and the fees and expenses of counsel to the selling stockholders. See “Use of Proceeds.”

Risk factors

   See “Risk Factors” and other information included in this prospectus for a discussion of factors you should carefully consider before deciding to invest in shares of our common stock.

NYSE symbol

  

“CVT”

 

The number of shares of common stock that will be outstanding after this offering is based on 39,884,357 shares outstanding as of September 30, 2013. This number excludes:

 

   

3,642,071 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of options outstanding of which options for 9,000 shares will be exercised for sale by selling stockholders in this offering, including 318,369 shares underlying stock options that have been early exercised and remain subject to vesting, at a weighted-average exercise price of $5.51 per share under our Stock and Equity Incentive Plans as of September 30, 2013; and

 

 

9


Table of Contents
   

an additional 4,923,771 shares of our common stock reserved for future issuance under our 2013 Equity Incentive Plan following this offering.

 

Except as otherwise indicated herein, all information in this prospectus, including the number of shares that will be outstanding after this offering, assumes or gives effect to:

 

   

no exercise of options outstanding as of September 30, 2013 except, where indicated, the 9,000 shares subject to options as of September 30, 2013 that were subsequently exercised for sale in this offering; and

 

   

no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares in this offering.

 

 

10


Table of Contents

SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

 

In the following tables, we provide our summary consolidated financial data. We have derived the summary consolidated statement of operations data for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 from our audited consolidated financial statements appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. We have derived the summary consolidated statement of operations data for the year ended December 31, 2010 from our unaudited consolidated financial statements not included in this prospectus. We have derived the summary consolidated statement of operations data for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013 and balance sheet data as of September 30, 2013 from our unaudited consolidated interim financial statements appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. The unaudited consolidated financial data for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013 and as of September 30, 2013 includes all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring accruals, that are necessary in the opinion of our management for a fair presentation of our financial position and results of operations for these periods.

 

Our historical results are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected in the future, and our operating results for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the entire year ended December 31, 2013. When you read this summary consolidated financial data, it is important that you read it together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, related notes, and other financial information included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

Consolidated Statement of Operations Data

 

    Year ended December 31,     Nine months ended September 30,  
            2010                     2011                     2012                     2012                     2013          
    (In thousands, except per share amounts)  

Revenue

  $ 45,060      $ 60,854      $ 83,474      $ 59,865      $ 80,440   

Cost of revenue(1)

    10,122        16,660        20,573        14,648        21,588   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

    34,938        44,194        62,901        45,217        58,852   

Operating expenses:

         

Sales and marketing(1)

    18,227        29,305        35,873        25,748        35,202   

Research and development(1)

    2,201        4,172        7,605        5,391        8,105   

General and administrative(1)

    6,946        8,422        11,523        7,957        16,891   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    27,374        41,899        55,001        39,096        60,198   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

    7,564        2,295        7,900        6,121        (1,346

Interest income

    111        270        811        670        677   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations before income tax expense

    7,675        2,565        8,711        6,791        (669

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

    2,932        2,749        4,406        4,007        2,136   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ 4,743      $ (184   $ 4,305      $ 2,784      $ (2,805
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per share:

         

Basic

  $ 0.28      $ (0.01   $ 0.13      $ 0.08      $ (0.14
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

  $ 0.14      $ (0.01   $ 0.12      $ 0.08      $ (0.14
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding:

         

Basic

    17,194        16,758        33,167        33,252        20,336   

Diluted

    33,914        16,758        34,791        34,847        20,336   

 

 

11


Table of Contents

 

  (1)   Stock-based compensation expense included in these line items are as follows:

 

     Year ended December 31,      Nine months ended September 30,  
     2010      2011      2012         2012            2013     
     (In thousands)  

Cost of revenue

   $ 33       $ 690       $ 762       $ 586       $ 886   

Sales and marketing

     57         2,376         2,895         2,105         2,092   

Research and development

     9         373         539         392         553   

General and administrative

     12         512         1,010         734         689   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total stock-based compensation expense

   $ 111       $ 3,951       $ 5,206       $ 3,817       $ 4,220   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Balance Sheet Data

 

The following table presents summary consolidated balance sheet data as of September 30, 2013:

 

   

on an actual basis without any adjustments to reflect subsequent or anticipated events;

 

   

on an as adjusted basis reflecting the receipt by us of the net proceeds from the sale of 650,000 shares of common stock in this offering at an assumed public offering price of $35.86 per share, which is the last reported sales price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on January 14, 2014, after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us and excluding the exercise of any option held by the underwriters with respect to this offering.

 

The unaudited as adjusted consolidated financial data is presented for informational purposes only and does not purport to represent what our consolidated results of operations or financial position actually would have been had the transactions reflected occurred on the date indicated or to project our financial condition as of any future date or results of operations for any future period.

 

     September 30, 2013  
     Actual      As Adjusted  
     (In thousands)  

Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments, net of restricted cash

   $ 157,811       $ 179,419   

Total current assets

     184,236         205,844   

Total assets

     214,964         236,572   

Deferred revenue

     48,754         48,754   

Total current liabilities

     70,612         70,612   

Total non-current liabilities

     2,397         2,397   

Stockholders’ equity

     141,955         163,563   

 

Other Financial Metrics

 

     Year ended December 31,      Nine months ended September 30,  
     2010      2011      2012      2012      2013  
     (In thousands)  

Adjusted EBITDA(2)

   $ 10,781       $ 11,782       $ 20,344       $ 14,919       $ 12,717   

 

  (2)  

To provide investors with additional information regarding our financial results, we have used adjusted EBITDA, a financial measure not calculated in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP, within this prospectus. We define adjusted EBITDA as net income (loss) calculated in accordance with GAAP plus: (i) interest expense (income); (ii) income tax expense; (iii) depreciation; (iv) amortization; (v) stock-based compensation expense; (vi) foreign currency (gains) losses associated with remeasurement and transactions; and (vii) transaction and severance costs included as a component of compensation or consideration paid in connection with acquisitions. We have included adjusted EBITDA in

 

 

12


Table of Contents
  this prospectus because it is a key measure used by our management and board of directors to understand and evaluate our core operating performance and trends, to prepare and approve our annual budget and to develop short- and long-term operational plans. In particular, we believe that the exclusion of the expenses eliminated in calculating adjusted EBITDA can provide a useful measure for period-to-period comparisons of our core business. Accordingly, we believe that adjusted EBITDA provides useful information to investors and others in understanding and evaluating our operating results in the same manner as our management and board of directors.

 

Although adjusted EBITDA measures are frequently used by investors and securities analysts in their evaluations of companies, adjusted EBITDA measures each have limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider them in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results of operations as reported under GAAP. Some of these limitations are:

 

   

although depreciation and amortization are non-cash charges, the assets being depreciated and amortized may have to be replaced in the future, and adjusted EBITDA does not reflect cash capital expenditure requirements for such replacements or for new capital expenditure requirements;

 

   

adjusted EBITDA does not reflect cash interest income or expense;

 

   

adjusted EBITDA does not reflect cash payments for transaction costs related to acquisitions and divestitures;

 

   

adjusted EBITDA does not reflect cash payments for employment or consulting compensation included as a component of the consideration paid related to acquisitions;

 

   

adjusted EBITDA does not reflect changes in, or cash requirements for, our working capital needs;

 

   

adjusted EBITDA does not reflect the potentially dilutive impact of stock-based compensation;

 

   

adjusted EBITDA does not reflect tax payments that may represent a reduction in cash available to us; and

 

   

other companies, including companies in our industry, may calculate adjusted EBITDA or similarly titled measures differently, which reduces its usefulness as a comparative measure.

 

Because of these and other limitations, you should consider adjusted EBITDA alongside other GAAP-based financial performance measures, including various cash flow metrics, net income (loss) and our other GAAP financial results. Management addresses the inherent limitations associated with using adjusted EBITDA through disclosure of such limitations, presentation of our financial statements in accordance with GAAP and reconciliation of adjusted EBITDA to the most directly comparable GAAP measure, net income (loss). Further, management also reviews GAAP measures, and evaluates individual measures that are not included in adjusted EBITDA such as our level of capital expenditures and interest expense, among other items.

 

The following table presents a reconciliation of adjusted EBITDA to net income (loss), the most comparable GAAP measure, for each of the periods identified.

 

     Year ended December 31,     Nine months ended September 30,  
     2010      2011      2012              2012                         2013            
     (In thousands)  

Net income (loss)

   $ 4,743       $ (184    $ 4,305      $ 2,784       $ (2,805)   

Adjustments:

             

Interest income

     (111      (270      (811     (670)         (677)   

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

     2,932         2,749         4,406        4,007         2,136   

Depreciation and amortization expense

     3,106         3,917         5,446        3,863         5,782   

Stock-based compensation expense

     111         3,951         5,206        3,817         4,220   

Foreign currency losses (gains) associated with remeasurement and transactions

             1,619         286        110         2,009   

Costs related to acquisitions

                     1,506        1,008         2,052   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 10,781       $ 11,782       $ 20,344      $ 14,919       $ 12,717   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

 

13


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

 

Investing in our common stock involves a high degree of risk. Before you invest in our common stock, you should carefully consider the following risks, as well as general economic and business risks, and all of the other information contained in this prospectus. Any of the following risks could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition and cause the trading price of our common stock to decline, which would cause you to lose all or part of your investment. When determining whether to invest, you should also refer to the other information contained in this prospectus, including our consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto.

 

Risks Related to Our Business and Industry

 

We are substantially dependent upon customer renewals, the addition of new customers and the continued growth of the market for cloud-based event and meeting management platform.

 

We derive, and expect to continue to derive, a substantial portion of our revenue from the sale of our cloud-based event and meeting management platform. During the year ended December 31, 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013, 70% of our total revenue was derived from our cloud-based event and meeting management platform. The market for event and meeting management software is still evolving, and competitive dynamics may cause pricing levels to change as the market matures and as existing and new market participants introduce new types of solutions and different approaches to enable event and meeting planners and hotels to address their respective needs. As a result, we may be forced to reduce the prices we charge for our solutions and may be unable to renew existing customer agreements or enter into new customer agreements at the same prices and upon the same terms that we have historically.

 

Widespread acceptance and use of the cloud-based business model for delivery of our event and meeting management platform is critical to our future growth and success. Under the perpetual or periodic license model for software procurement, users of the software would typically install and operate the applications on their hardware. Because many companies were historically predisposed to maintaining control of their information technology, or IT, systems and infrastructure, there may be resistance to the concept of accessing a cloud-based service provided by a third party. If the market for cloud-based event and meeting management software fails to grow, grows more slowly than we currently anticipate or evolves and forces us to reduce the prices we charge for our solutions, our operating results and financial condition could be materially adversely affected.

 

We are subject to U.S. and foreign data privacy and protection laws and regulations as well as contractual privacy obligations, and our failure to comply could subject us to fines and damages and would harm our reputation and business.

 

We are subject to the data privacy and protection laws and regulations adopted by federal, state and foreign governmental agencies. Data privacy and protection is highly regulated, and may become the subject of additional regulation in the future. Privacy laws restrict our storage, use, processing, disclosure, transfer and protection of non-public personal information, including credit card data, provided to us by our event and meeting planners and registrants. We strive to comply with all applicable laws, regulations, policies and legal obligations relating to privacy and data protection. However, it is possible that these requirements may be interpreted and applied in a manner that is inconsistent from one jurisdiction to another and may conflict with other rules or our practices. Any failure, or perceived failure, by us to comply with federal, state, or international laws, including laws and regulations regulating privacy, data or consumer protection, could result in proceedings or actions against us by governmental entities or others.

 

The regulatory framework for privacy and data protection issues worldwide is evolving, and various government and consumer agencies and public advocacy groups have called for new regulation and changes in industry practices, including some directed at providers of mobile and online resources in particular. In addition,

 

14


Table of Contents

as we expand our operations globally, compliance with regulations that differ from country to country may also impose substantial burdens on our business. In particular, the European Union, or EU, has traditionally taken a broader view as to what is considered personal information and has imposed greater obligations under data privacy regulations. In addition, individual EU member countries have had discretion with respect to their interpretation and implementation of the regulations, which has resulted in variation of privacy standards from country to country. Complying with any additional or new regulatory requirements could force us to incur substantial costs or require us to change our business practices in a manner that could compromise our ability to effectively pursue our growth strategy.

 

We are subject to the privacy and data protection-related obligations in our contracts with our customers and other third parties, including voluntary third-party trade associations and industry self-regulatory groups that promulgate best practices or codes of conduct such as the Direct Marketing Association. We could be adversely affected by changes to these guidelines and codes in ways that are inconsistent with our practices or in conflict with the laws and regulations of the United States, foreign or international regulatory authorities. We may also be contractually liable to indemnify and hold harmless our clients from the costs or consequences of inadvertent or unauthorized disclosure of data that we store or handle as part of providing our services. Finally, we are also subject to contractual obligations and other legal restrictions with respect to our collection and use of data, and we may be liable to third parties in the event we are deemed to have wrongfully used or gathered data.

 

Any failure by us or a third-party contractor providing services to us to comply with applicable privacy and data protection laws, regulations, self-regulatory requirements or industry guidelines, our contractual privacy obligations or our own privacy policies, may result in fines, statutory or contractual damages, litigation or governmental enforcement actions. These proceedings or violations could force us to spend significant amounts in defense or settlement of these proceedings, result in the imposition of monetary liability, distract our management, increase our costs of doing business, and adversely affect our reputation and the demand for our solutions.

 

We have experienced rapid growth and organizational change in recent periods and expect continued future growth. If we fail to manage our growth effectively, we may be unable to execute our business plan, maintain high levels of service or address competitive challenges adequately.

 

Our head count and operations have grown, both domestically and internationally, since our inception. In particular, during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 alone, we have added over 340 full-time positions. This growth has placed, and will continue to place, a significant strain on our management, administrative, operational and financial infrastructure. We anticipate further growth will be required to address increases in our platform offerings and continued expansion. Our success will depend in part upon the ability of our management team to manage this growth effectively. To do so, we must continue to recruit, hire, train, manage and integrate a significant number of qualified managers, technical personnel and employees in specialized roles within our company, including in technology, sales and marketing. If our new employees perform poorly, or if we are unsuccessful in recruiting, hiring, training, managing and integrating these new employees, or retaining these or our existing employees, our business may suffer.

 

In addition, to manage the expected continued growth of our head count, operations and geographic expansion, we will need to continue to improve our information technology infrastructure, operational, financial and management systems and procedures. Our anticipated additional head count and capital investments will increase our costs, which will make it more difficult for us to address any future revenue shortfalls by reducing expenses in the short term. If we fail to successfully manage our growth, we will be unable to successfully execute our business plan, which could have a negative impact on our business, results of operations or financial condition.

 

15


Table of Contents

Federal, state and foreign laws impose certain obligations on the senders of commercial emails, which could minimize the effectiveness of our event management email solutions, limit our ability to market to prospective customers and impose financial penalties for noncompliance.

 

The U.S.’s CAN-SPAM Act establishes certain requirements for commercial email messages and specifies penalties for the transmission of commercial email messages that are intended to deceive the recipient as to source or content. The CAN-SPAM Act, among other things, obligates the sender of commercial emails to provide recipients with the ability to opt out of receiving future emails from the sender. In addition, some states have passed laws regulating commercial email practices that are significantly more punitive and difficult to comply with than the CAN-SPAM Act. The ability of recipients of emails from our customers using our event management software to opt out of receiving commercial emails may minimize the effectiveness of our solutions for our customers. Also, the ability of event planners to opt out of receiving future emails from us may minimize our ability to expand our event planner network. In addition, noncompliance with the CAN-SPAM Act carries significant litigation, regulatory investigation and related risks. If we were found to be in violation of the CAN-SPAM Act or similar state or international laws regulating the distribution of commercial email, whether as a result of violations by our customers or if we were deemed to be directly subject to and in violation of these requirements, we could incur penalties, and significant litigation and investigation-related expenses, and any inquiries might impact the deliverability of our commercial email regardless of outcome. This would adversely affect our operating results and financial condition and significantly harm our business, and our reputation would suffer. We also may be required to change one or more aspects of the way we operate our business, which could impair our ability to attract and retain customers or could increase our operating costs.

 

Our business depends on maintaining and expanding our relationships with hotels and venues.

 

An important component of our business success depends on our ability to maintain and expand relationships with hotels and venues. A substantial portion of our revenue is derived from compensation negotiated with hotels and venues for marketing solutions, particularly through the Cvent Supplier Network. If we are unable to continue to successfully sell marketing solutions to individual hotels and venues, our financial results may suffer. Furthermore, although individual hotel properties typically make separate decisions as to their advertising spending, the influence of the corporate offices of major hotel chains may affect the decisions of their individual properties. For example, if the corporate parent discontinues its relationship with us in favor of another solution, our relationship with the properties under that brand may suffer even though, in nearly all cases, we negotiate with each property individually. This may lead to considerable lost revenue or result in additional costs to complete sales of our advertising, any of which would adversely affect our operating results. Finally, our strong network relationships with hotels and venues are a key differentiator for our event management solutions. If we are unable to maintain and grow our network of hotels and venues, we may be unable to satisfy our customers’ needs, lose market share or incur additional costs to support our customers, all of which may adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.

 

Our long-term success depends, in part, on our ability to operate offices located outside of the United States including India.

 

We currently maintain offices and have sales personnel in the United States, the United Kingdom and India, and we are exploring opening additional international offices. Any international expansion efforts that we may undertake may not be successful. In addition, conducting more extensive international operations subjects us to new risks that we have not generally faced in the United States. These risks include: unexpected costs and errors in the localization of our solutions, including translation into foreign languages and adaptation for local practices and regulatory requirements; challenges posed by different pricing environments and different forms of competition; lack of familiarity and burdens of complying with foreign laws, legal standards, regulatory requirements, tariffs, and other barriers; unexpected changes in regulatory requirements, taxes, trade laws, tariffs, export quotas, custom duties or other trade restrictions; difficulties in managing technology partners; differing technology standards; difficulties in collecting accounts receivable; difficulties in managing and staffing international operations; varying expectations as to employee standards; fluctuations in exchange rates that may

 

16


Table of Contents

increase the volatility of our foreign based revenue and costs; potentially adverse tax consequences, including arising from the complexities of foreign value added tax (or other tax, including transfer pricing) systems and restrictions on the repatriation of earnings; uncertain political and economic climates; and reduced or varied protection for intellectual property rights in some countries. These factors may cause our costs of doing business in new geographies to exceed the existing costs of our comparable operations in the United States and India. Operating in new international markets also requires significant management attention and financial resources. Any negative impact from our international business efforts could negatively impact our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

We have significant operations in India. As of September 30, 2013, approximately 750 of our approximately 1,400 employees were based in India. Operating in India requires substantial resources and management attention and subjects us to economic, political and operational risks that are different from those in the United States. For example, there have been armed conflicts between India and neighboring Pakistan. Also, extremist groups within India and neighboring Pakistan have from time to time targeted Western interests. Other risks specific to our operations in India include, but are not limited to, difficulty with responding to changes in economic conditions that may include inflation and fluctuations in exchange rates and interest rates; problems that impair our business infrastructure, such as telephone system failure or an international disruption of our information technology systems by a third party; failure to act in accordance with labor, environmental, health and safety standards and regulations; and the need to increase the levels of our employee compensation more rapidly than in the past to retain talent. If any of these risks materialize, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be materially adversely affected.

 

If the security of our customers’ confidential information stored in our systems is breached or otherwise subjected to unauthorized access, our reputation may be severely harmed and we may be exposed to liability.

 

Our system stores personally identifiable information, proprietary email distribution lists, credit card information and other critical data for our customers and our customers’ event participants. We believe that we take reasonable steps to protect the security, integrity and confidentiality of the information we collect and store, but there is no guarantee that inadvertent (e.g., software bugs or other technical malfunctions, employee error or malfeasance, or other factors) or unauthorized disclosure will not occur or that third parties will not gain unauthorized access to this information despite our efforts. We have in the past and we may again in the future experience successful attempts by third-parties to obtain unauthorized access to our data despite our security measures. Since techniques used to obtain unauthorized access change frequently, we and our third-party hosting facilities may be unable to anticipate these techniques or to implement adequate preventative measures. Any willful or accidental security breaches or other unauthorized access could expose us to liability for the loss of such information, adverse regulatory action by federal and state governments, time-consuming and expensive investigation and litigation, extensive downtime of our systems and other possible liabilities.

 

If our security measures are breached because of third-party action, employee error, malfeasance or otherwise, or if design flaws in our software are exposed and exploited, and, as a result, a third party obtains unauthorized access to any of our customers’ data, our relationships with our customers will be severely damaged, and we could incur significant liability. In addition, many jurisdictions have enacted laws requiring companies to notify individuals of data security breaches involving certain types of personal data, and our agreements with certain partners require us to notify them in the event of a security incident. These mandatory disclosures regarding a security breach often lead to widespread negative publicity and may cause our customers to lose confidence in the effectiveness of our data security measures. Any security breach, whether actual or perceived, would harm our reputation, and we could lose customers or fail to acquire new customers.

 

If we experience compromises to our information technology as a result of security lapses, technical difficulties or otherwise that result in performance or availability problems of our cloud-based solutions, the complete shutdown of our cloud-based solutions, or the loss or unauthorized disclosure of confidential information, our partners or customers may be harmed or lose trust and confidence in us, and decrease the use of

 

17


Table of Contents

our solution or stop using our solution in its entirety, and we would suffer reputational and financial harm. Our third-party vendors may also suspend or discontinue their relationships with us. Additionally, in the future, we could be subject to regulatory investigations and litigation in connection with a security breach or related issue, and we could also face regulatory fines and be liable to third parties for these types of breaches. For example, we work with third-party vendors to process credit card payments by our customers and are subject to payment card association operating rules. If our security measures fail to protect this information adequately or we fail to comply with the applicable operating rules, we could be liable to both our customers for their losses, as well as the vendors under our agreements with them, we could be subject to fines and higher transaction fees, we could face regulatory action, and our customers and vendors could end their relationships with us, any of which could harm our business, results of operations or financial condition.

 

There can be no assurance that the limitations of liability in our contracts would be enforceable or adequate or would otherwise protect us from any such liabilities or damages with respect to any particular claim. We also cannot provide assurances that our existing general liability insurance coverage and coverage for errors and omissions will continue to be available on acceptable terms or will be available in sufficient amounts to cover one or more large claims or that the insurer will not deny coverage as to any future claim. The successful assertion of one or more large claims against us that exceeds available insurance coverage, or the occurrence of changes in our insurance policies, including premium increases or the imposition of large deductible or co-insurance requirements, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Failure to adequately protect our intellectual property, in the United States and abroad, could harm our business and operating results.

 

Our business depends on proprietary technology and content, including software, databases, confidential information and know-how, the protection of which is crucial to the success of our business. We rely on a combination of trademark, domain name, trade secret, and copyright law and contractual restrictions to protect our proprietary technology and content. We have begun to seek patent protection for certain of our technologies and currently have one U.S. patent application on file, although there can be no assurance that a patent will ultimately be issued. We are also pursuing the registration of our domain names, trademarks and service marks in the United States and in certain locations outside the United States. Effective trademark, trade secret, patent, copyright and domain name protection is expensive to develop and maintain, both in terms of initial and ongoing registration requirements and the costs of defending our rights. The intellectual property rights we obtain may not be sufficient to provide us with a competitive advantage, and could be challenged, invalidated, circumvented, infringed or misappropriated. For example, in the past, competitors in both the United States and foreign jurisdictions have from time-to-time infringed our trademark rights and infringed our copyright rights in Cvent proprietary software and content, and we have incurred varying levels of costs to respond to such infringement. We may, over time, increase our investment in protecting our intellectual property through additional trademark, patent and other intellectual property filings that could be expensive and time-consuming. Some aspects of our business and services also rely on technologies, software and content developed by or licensed from third parties, and we may not be able to maintain our relationships with such third parties or enter into similar relationships in the future on reasonable terms or at all.

 

We may also be required to protect our proprietary technology and content in an increasing number of jurisdictions, a process that is expensive and may not be successful, or which we may not pursue in every location. In addition, effective intellectual property protection may not be available to us in every country, and the laws of some foreign countries may not be as protective of intellectual property rights as those in the United States. Additional uncertainty may result from changes to intellectual property legislation enacted in the United States and elsewhere, and from interpretations of intellectual property laws by applicable courts and agencies. Accordingly, despite our efforts, we may be unable to obtain and maintain the intellectual property rights necessary to provide us with a competitive advantage.

 

18


Table of Contents

We attempt to further protect our proprietary technology and content by requiring our employees and consultants to enter into confidentiality and assignment of inventions agreements and third parties to enter into nondisclosure agreements. These agreements may not effectively prevent unauthorized use or disclosure of our confidential information, intellectual property or technology and may not provide an adequate remedy in the event of unauthorized use or disclosure of our confidential information, intellectual property or technology. Despite our efforts to protect our proprietary rights, unauthorized parties may attempt to copy aspects of our website features, software and functionality or obtain and use information that we consider confidential or proprietary.

 

Litigation or proceedings before the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office or other governmental authorities and administrative bodies in the United States and abroad may be necessary in the future to enforce our intellectual property rights; to protect our trademarks, trade secrets, patents, copyrights and domain names; and to determine the validity and scope of the proprietary rights of others. We may also be involved in disputes relating to the rights to, and ownership of, the intellectual property developed by our employees, consultants and others. Our efforts to enforce or protect our proprietary rights may be ineffective and could result in substantial costs and diversion of resources, as well as the invalidation or narrowing of the scope of our intellectual property, any of which could harm our business and operating results. Attempting to enforce our intellectual property rights against third parties could also expose us to counterclaims from such third parties.

 

Claims by third parties that we infringe upon their intellectual property rights could result in significant costs and have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results or financial condition.

 

Our success depends, in part, upon our noninfringement of intellectual property rights owned by others and being able to resolve claims of intellectual property infringement without major financial expenditures or adverse consequences. The software industry generally is characterized by extensive intellectual property litigation. Although we were an early pioneer of event management software, a field which continues to rapidly evolve, many participants that own, or claim to own, intellectual property related to elements of our business historically have aggressively asserted their rights. From time to time, we may be subject to legal proceedings and claims that we, our customers, licensees or parties indemnified by us are infringing, misappropriating or otherwise violating the intellectual property rights of others, and the risk of such proceedings and claims may increase as we expand the complexity, scope and public profile of our business. For example, we may be subject to claims that we are infringing the patent, trademark or copyright rights of third parties, or that our employees have misappropriated or divulged their former employers’ trade secrets or confidential information.

 

It may therefore be necessary to defend against future claims by, for example, determining the scope, enforceability and validity of third-party proprietary rights or asserting and defining our proprietary rights. Some claimants may have substantially greater resources than we do and may be able to sustain the costs of complex intellectual property litigation to a greater degree and for longer periods of time than we could. In addition, patent holding companies that focus solely on extracting royalties and settlements by enforcing patent rights may target us. Regardless of whether they have any merit, these claims are time-consuming and costly to evaluate and defend and could:

 

   

adversely affect our relationships with our current or future customers;

 

   

cause delays or stoppages in providing our software solutions;

 

   

divert management’s attention and resources;

 

   

require technology changes to our platform that would cause us to incur substantial cost;

 

   

subject us to significant liabilities;

 

   

necessitate incurring significant legal fees; and

 

   

require us to cease some or all of our activities.

 

19


Table of Contents

In addition to liability for monetary damages against us, which may be tripled and may include attorneys’ fees, or, in some circumstances, damages against our customers, we may be prohibited from developing, commercializing or continuing to provide some or all of our event and meeting management solutions unless we obtain licenses from, and pay royalties to, the holders of the patents or other intellectual property rights, which may not be available on commercially favorable terms, or at all.

 

We face significant competition from established and new companies offering event and meeting management software and from internally developed software.

 

The market for event and meeting management software is evolving, highly competitive and significantly fragmented, and we expect competition to continue to increase in the future. With the increased demands for event and meeting management solutions as well as the potential influx of new entrants to the market, we expect competition to intensify in the future, which could harm our ability to increase sales and maintain our prices.

 

Our competitors vary with each challenge that our event and meeting management solutions address, and include providers of point solutions for email marketing, event registration, ecommerce payments, budgeting, web surveys, web content management, scheduling, room and table assignments, name badging, mobile app development and social media. If individual point solutions become less expensive, we may face general pricing pressure. For example, if mobile app development becomes more prevalent and competition forces developers to reduce their fees, we may be forced to reduce the fees that we charge for our mobile event apps to remain competitive. In addition, we expect to face additional competition with the continued development and expansion of the event management software market. We expect that new competitors, such as software vendors that have traditionally focused on other applications, may enter the event and meeting management market with competing products, which could have an adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition. Additionally, competitors may develop a comprehensive event and meeting management platform that is similar to our own.

 

Our current and potential competitors may have significantly more financial, technical, marketing and other resources than we have; be able to devote greater resources to the development, promotion, sale and support of their products and services; have more extensive customer bases and broader customer relationships than we have; and have longer operating histories and greater name recognition than we have. As a result, these competitors may be better able to respond quickly to new technologies and to undertake more extensive marketing campaigns. In some cases, these vendors may also be able to offer event and meeting management solutions at little or no additional cost by bundling them with their existing applications. If we are unable to compete with such companies, the demand for our solutions could substantially decline. To the extent any of our competitors have existing relationships with potential customers, those customers may be unwilling to purchase our solutions because of those existing relationships with that competitor. To the extent that we consider acquiring one of our competitors, this heightened competition could increase the cost of an acquisition within our industry.

 

We have in the past completed acquisitions and may acquire or invest in other companies or technologies in the future, which could divert management’s attention, fail to meet our expectations, result in additional dilution to our stockholders, increase expenses, disrupt our operations and harm our operating results.

 

We have in the past acquired, and we may in the future acquire or invest in, businesses, products or technologies that we believe could complement or expand our platform, enhance our technical capabilities or otherwise offer growth opportunities. We cannot assure you that we will realize the anticipated benefits of these or any future acquisitions. The pursuit of potential acquisitions may divert the attention of management and cause us to incur various expenses related to identifying, investigating and pursuing suitable acquisitions, whether or not they are consummated.

 

There are inherent risks in integrating and managing acquisitions. If we acquire additional businesses, we may not be able to assimilate or integrate the acquired personnel, operations and technologies successfully or effectively manage the combined business following the acquisition and our management may be distracted from

 

20


Table of Contents

operating our business. We also may not achieve the anticipated benefits from the acquired business due to a number of factors, including, without limitation: unanticipated costs or liabilities associated with the acquisition; incurrence of acquisition-related costs, which would be recognized as a current period expense; inability to generate sufficient revenue to offset acquisition or investment costs; the inability to maintain relationships with customers and partners of the acquired business; the difficulty of incorporating acquired technology and rights into our platform and of maintaining quality and security standards consistent with our brand; delays in customer purchases due to uncertainty related to any acquisition; the need to integrate or implement additional controls, procedures and policies; challenges caused by distance, language and cultural differences; harm to our existing business relationships with business partners and customers as a result of the acquisition; the potential loss of key employees; use of resources that are needed in other parts of our business and diversion of management and employee resources; the inability to recognize acquired revenue in accordance with our revenue recognition policies and the loss of acquired deferred revenue; and use of substantial portions of our available cash or the incurrence of debt to consummate the acquisition. Acquisitions also increase the risk of unforeseen legal liability, including for potential violations of applicable law or industry rules and regulations, arising from prior or ongoing acts or omissions by the acquired businesses which are not discovered by due diligence during the acquisition process. Generally, if an acquired business fails to meet our expectations, our operating results, business and financial condition may suffer. Acquisitions could also result in dilutive issuances of equity securities or the incurrence of debt, which could adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition.

 

In addition, a significant portion of the purchase price of companies we acquire may be allocated to goodwill and other intangible assets, which must be assessed for impairment at least annually. Also, contingent consideration related to acquisitions will be remeasured to fair value at each reporting period, with any changes in the value recorded as income or expense. Our recent acquisitions all contained a contingent consideration element as well as other compensatory arrangements based on continued employment of certain key employees. If our acquisitions do not ultimately yield expected returns, we may be required to take charges to our operating results based on our impairment assessment process, which could harm our results of operations.

 

Any significant disruption in service on our websites, mobile applications or in our computer systems, which are hosted primarily by third-party providers, could damage our reputation and result in fees to customers or a loss of users, which would harm our business and operating results.

 

We have experienced limited interruptions in these systems in the past, including server failures that temporarily slowed down the performance of our websites and mobile applications, but we may experience more significant interruptions in the future. Interruptions in these systems, whether due to system failures, computer viruses, physical or electronic break-ins or other catastrophic events, could affect the security or availability of our services on our websites and mobile applications and prevent or inhibit the ability of our customers and event and meeting registrants to access our services. Problems with the reliability or security of our systems could harm our reputation or result in substantial costs to remedy these problems, any of which could negatively affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

We have entered into agreements with many of our customers and business partners that obligate us to compensate them should an interruption affect their use of our services. While some of the communications, network and computer hardware used to provide our services, including our websites and mobile applications, are located at our headquarters in McLean, Virginia, a significant amount of this hardware is located in a facility in Ashburn, Virginia which we do not own or control. Also, businesses we have acquired rely heavily on third-party service providers to host their software applications, web services, data storage, credit card processing and other computing infrastructure, thereby increasing our dependence on these third party providers. Problems faced by our third-party information technology providers could adversely affect the experience of our customers. Any errors, defects, disruptions or other performance problems with our third-party information technology providers could directly affect our ability to provide services to our customers, which may result in liabilities to us and our customers, harm our reputation and negatively affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

 

21


Table of Contents

We are dependent on the maintenance and expansion of the infrastructure of the internet, over which we have no control. Any failure of the internet infrastructure we rely on, even for a short period of time, could harm our business, operating results and financial condition. In addition, our systems and operations are vulnerable to damage, interruption or complete failure from fire, flood, power loss, telecommunications failure, terrorist attacks, acts of war, electronic and physical break-ins, computer viruses, earthquakes and similar events. Our systems are not completely redundant, so a failure of our system at one site could result in reduced functionality for our customers, and a total failure of our systems at both sites could cause our platform to be completely unavailable for all customers.

 

We are subject to the rules and regulations adopted by the payment card networks, such as Visa, MasterCard and American Express, and if we fail to adhere to their rules and regulations, we would be in breach of our contractual obligations to payment processors and merchant banks, which could subject us to damages and liability and could eventually prevent us from processing or accepting credit card payments.

 

The payment card networks, such as Visa, MasterCard and American Express, have adopted rules and regulations that apply to all merchants who process and accept credit cards for payment of goods and services. We are obligated to comply with these rules and regulations as part of the contracts we enter into with payment processors and merchant banks. The rules and regulations adopted by the payment card networks include the Payment Card Industry Data Security Standards, or the PCI DSS. Under the PCI DSS, we are required to adopt and implement internal controls over the use, storage and security of payment card data to help prevent fraud. We assess our compliance with the PCI DSS on a periodic basis, and make necessary improvements to our internal controls. If we fail to comply with the rules and regulations adopted by the payment card networks, including the PCI DSS, we would be in breach of our contractual obligations to payment processors and merchant banks. Such failure to comply may subject us to fines, penalties, damages and civil liability, and could eventually prevent us from processing or accepting debit and credit cards or could lead to a loss of payment processor partners. Further, there is no guarantee that even if we comply with the rules and regulations adopted by the payment card networks, we will be able to maintain our compliance. For example, we have acquired businesses in the past that were not immediately compliant with PCI DSS at the time of our acquisition. Until those businesses are fully integrated with our own systems we may be unable to comply with PCI DSS standards for those acquired businesses without substantial additional costs. We also cannot guarantee that such compliance will prevent illegal or improper use of our payments systems or the theft, loss or misuse of the debit or credit card data of customers or participants or regulatory or criminal investigations. Any such event would harm our reputation and may result in a loss of service for our customers, which would adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

 

Our business is susceptible to declines or disruptions in the demand for events and meetings, including those due to economic downturns or natural disasters.

 

Our business and financial performance are affected by the health of the worldwide events and meetings industry. Events and meetings are sensitive to business-related discretionary spending levels and tend to grow more slowly or even decline during economic downturns. Decreased expenditures by meeting planners and participants could also result in decreased demand for our event management solutions, thereby causing a reduction in our sales. In addition, sales of our marketing solutions to hotels and venues may suffer if fewer event and meeting planners use our solutions. Although we are optimistic about the capabilities of our solutions to assist event and meeting planners in maximizing return on investment when funds available to spend on events are limited, further economic weakness and uncertainty may nonetheless result in significantly decreased spending on our event and meeting management solutions, which may adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

 

External factors beyond our control may adversely affect the events and meetings industry, with a corresponding negative impact on our business and operating results. Economic downturns, natural disasters, such as hurricanes, tsunamis, earthquakes or volcanic eruptions, and other phenomena, such as pandemics and

 

22


Table of Contents

epidemics, have previously disrupted normal travel patterns and levels, which has correspondingly disrupted the events and meetings industry. The events and meetings industry is also sensitive to other events beyond our control, such as political instability, regional hostilities, increases in fuel prices, the emergence and widespread adoption of more-effective teleconference and virtual meeting technologies, imposition of taxes or surcharges by regulatory authorities, travel related accidents and terrorist attacks, any of which could have an impact on our business and results of operations. For example, the September 2001 terrorist attacks in the U.S. had a dramatic and sustained impact on the travel industry generally, which had a corresponding negative impact on the events and meetings industry thereafter. Any future terrorist attack, whether on a small or large scale, could have a material and negative impact on our business, results of operations or financial condition.

 

We are dependent in part upon our relationships with our strategic partners to sustain the flow of business through the Cvent Supplier Network.

 

Our access to certain customers is facilitated in some cases by strategic partner relationships with certain companies. If these strategic partners terminate or do not renew their relationships with us, it could have a negative effect on revenue for sales of our event management software solutions. Approximately 60% of the RFPs transmitted to hotels and venues through our CSN during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 originated from event planners introduced to us through these partnerships. As such, the loss of several of these partnerships would greatly diminish the value of the CSN.

 

Growth of our business will depend on a strong brand, and any failure to maintain, protect, and enhance our brand would hurt our ability to retain or expand our base of users, or our ability to increase their level of engagement.

 

We believe that a strong brand is necessary to continue to attract and retain event and meeting planners and, in turn, the hotels and venues who choose to advertise on the Cvent Supplier Network. We need to maintain, protect, and enhance our brand to expand our base of customers and users and increase their engagement with our solutions. This will depend largely on our ability to continue to provide high-value, differentiated solutions, and we may not be able to do so effectively. While we may choose to engage in a broader marketing campaign to further promote our brand, this effort may not be successful. Furthermore, negative publicity about our company, including our content, technology, sales practices, personnel or customer service could diminish confidence in, and the use of, our solutions, any of which could harm our operating results. If we are unable to maintain or enhance customer awareness of our brand cost-effectively, our business, operating results and financial condition could be harmed.

 

Event and meeting planners may not widely adopt our applications to manage the important aspects of their events and meetings, which would limit our ability to grow our business.

 

Our ability to grow our business and increase revenue depends on our success in educating event and meeting planners about the potential benefits of our cloud-based platform. Cloud applications for organizing and managing important aspects of events and meetings have not previously been widely adopted by event and meeting planners. Concerns about cost, fraud, privacy, security, reliability and other issues may cause event and meeting planners not to adopt our applications. Moreover, event and meeting planners who have already invested substantial resources in other registration and management systems or methods may be reluctant to adopt a new approach like ours to supplement or replace existing systems or methods. If event and meeting planners do not widely adopt applications such as ours, our ability to grow our business will be limited.

 

We have experienced losses in the past and we may not sustain profitability in the future.

 

We have incurred a significant accumulated deficit in prior periods, in large part due to accretion of redemption features on previously outstanding preferred stock in those periods. We experienced net losses of $0.2 million and $2.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and the nine months ended September 30,

 

23


Table of Contents

2013, respectively, and have an accumulated deficit as of September 30, 2013 of $22.6 million. We also anticipate a net loss for the three months and full year ended December 31, 2013. We anticipate that our operating expenses will increase substantially in the foreseeable future as we continue to invest to grow our business and acquire clients, develop our platform, develop new solutions and comply with the requirements of being a public company. These efforts may prove to be more expensive than we currently anticipate, and we may not succeed in increasing our revenue sufficiently to offset these higher expenses. Many of our efforts to generate revenue from our business, particularly with respect to our marketing solutions, are unproven, and any failure to increase our revenue or generate revenue from new solutions could prevent us from attaining or increasing profitability. Furthermore, to the extent we are successful in increasing our customer base, we could also incur increased losses because costs associated with entering into customer agreements are generally incurred up front, while revenue is generally recognized ratably over the term of the agreement. If we are unable to effectively manage these risks and difficulties as we encounter them, our business, financial condition and results of operations may suffer.

 

Seasonality may cause fluctuations in our revenue and operating results.

 

We generally experience seasonality in our marketing solutions sales due to the seasonality of the underlying marketing budgets of hotels and venues. Hotels and venues advertising on the Cvent Supplier Network have historically made more purchasing decisions in the fourth quarter of the calendar year.

 

If we do not continue to innovate and provide solutions that are useful to our customers and event registrants and attendees, we may not remain competitive, and our revenue and operating results could suffer.

 

Our success depends on continued innovation to provide features and services that make our solutions, websites and mobile apps useful for event and meeting planners, hotels and venues and event registrants and attendees. Our competitors are frequently developing innovations in services and features. Additionally, the rapid pace at which technology evolves generally requires us to find new ways to deliver our solutions to end users with better performance and functionality. As a result, we must continue to invest significant resources in research and development in order to continually improve the speed, accuracy and comprehensiveness of our solutions. We may introduce significant changes to our existing solutions or develop and introduce new and unproven solutions, including using technologies with which we have little or no prior development or operating experience. If we are unable to continue offering innovative solutions or if new or enhanced solutions fail to engage event and meeting planners, hotels and venues or event registrants and attendees, we may be unable to attract additional customers or event registrants or retain our current customers or event registrants and attendees, which may adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

 

Defects or disruptions in the rollout of our new products and product enhancements could diminish demand for our service, adversely affect our reputation and subject us to substantial liability.

 

Like many internet-based cloud companies, we provide frequent incremental releases of product updates and functional enhancements. Such new versions frequently contain undetected errors when first introduced or released. We have, from time to time, found defects in our service, and new errors in our existing service may be detected in the future. In addition, our customers may use our service in unanticipated ways that may cause a disruption in service for other customers or for event registrants. Since our customers use our service for important aspects of their business, any errors, defects, disruptions in service or other performance problems with our service could hurt our reputation and may damage our customers’ businesses. If that occurs, our customers may delay or withhold payment to us, elect not to renew, make service credit claims, warranty claims or other claims against us, and we could lose future sales. The occurrence of any of these events could result in an increase in our bad debt expense, an increase in collection cycles for accounts receivable, require us to increase our warranty provisions or incur the expense or risk of litigation. Further, if we are unable to meet the stated service level commitments we have guaranteed to our customers or suffer extended periods of unavailability for our service, we may be contractually obligated to provide these customers with credits for future service, and there would be a negative impact on our reputation.

 

24


Table of Contents

We rely on the performance of highly skilled personnel, including senior management and our sales and technology professionals; if we are unable to retain or motivate key personnel or hire, retain and motivate qualified personnel, our business would be harmed.

 

We believe our success has depended, and continues to depend, on the efforts and talents of our senior management and our highly skilled team members, including our sales personnel and software engineers. Competition for well-qualified employees in all aspects of our business, including sales personnel and software engineers, is intense. Our continued ability to compete effectively depends on our ability to attract new employees and to retain and motivate existing employees. If we do not succeed in attracting well-qualified employees or retaining and motivating existing employees, our business would be adversely affected. The loss of any of our senior management or key employees could adversely affect our ability to build on the efforts they have undertaken and to execute our business plan, and we may not be able to find adequate replacements. We cannot ensure that we will be able to retain the services of any members of our senior management or other key employees.

 

Our business depends substantially on renewing agreements with existing customers and selling additional solutions to them. Any decline in our customer renewals or expansions would likely harm our future operating results, especially if we are unable to recognize sufficient revenue to offset related customer acquisition costs prior to such termination or cancellation of our customer agreements.

 

In order for us to improve our operating results, it is important that our event and meeting management customers renew their subscription agreements and our hotel and venue advertisers renew their advertising agreements with us when the initial term expires, as well as purchase additional solutions and advertising from us. We offer our event and meeting management solutions primarily through annual and multi-year subscription agreements and our hotel and venue marketing solutions primarily through a mix of single-year and multi-year arrangements. In some cases, our customers have no renewal obligation after their initial term expires, and we cannot assure you that we will be able to renew agreements with any of our customers at the same or higher contract value. Some agreements also contain a termination right for the customer in the event of customer dissatisfaction with our services because of substantial nonperformance that remains uncured by us. In addition, some of our customer contracts allow for a termination for convenience. Our ten largest event and meeting management customers and our largest ten hotel and venue advertising customers during the year ended December 31, 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013 represented 3% and 2%, respectively, of our total revenue during those periods. If our customers do not renew their agreements, renew on less favorable terms or fail to purchase additional solutions or advertising, our revenue may decline, and our operating results would likely be harmed.

 

We typically bill customers for no longer than the next fiscal year with payment due upfront regardless of the full length of the contract, although we incur most of our customer acquisition costs at the time of sale. Depending upon the scope of the customer’s needs, these costs can be significant. If a customer does not renew or cancels its agreement with us, we may not recognize sufficient revenue from that customer prior to the termination or cancellation to offset the acquisition costs associated with that customer.

 

If we fail to offer high quality customer support, our business and reputation would suffer.

 

Our customers rely on our customer support services. High-quality education and customer support is important for the successful marketing and sale of our solutions and for the renewal of our agreements with existing customers. The importance of high quality customer support will increase as we expand our business and pursue new customers. If we do not help our customers quickly resolve issues and provide effective ongoing support, our ability to sell new services to existing and new customers would suffer and our reputation with existing or potential customers would be harmed.

 

25


Table of Contents

Our growth rate over the past few years may not be sustainable. If we fail to maintain an adequate growth rate, our business will be adversely affected and we may not achieve or maintain profitability.

 

Our revenue has grown rapidly over the past few years. We may not be able to sustain this level of growth in future periods, and you should not rely on the revenue growth of any prior quarterly or annual period as an indication of our future performance. Further, a portion of our revenue growth in the year ended December 31, 2012 and the nine months September 30, 2013 resulted from acquisitions and not organic growth. We may not complete acquisitions in the future that increase our revenue at the same rate as in prior periods. The identification of suitable acquisition candidates can be difficult, time-consuming and costly, and we may not be able to successfully complete the acquisitions we do identify as worth pursuing. If we are unable to maintain an adequate rate of growth, our business will be adversely affected and we may not maintain profitability.

 

Failure to adequately expand our direct sales force will impede our growth.

 

We will need to continue to expand and optimize our sales infrastructure in order to grow our customer base and our business. We plan to continue to expand our direct sales force, both domestically and internationally. Identifying and recruiting qualified personnel and training them requires significant time, expense and attention. It can take several months before our sales representatives are fully trained and productive. Our business may be adversely affected if our efforts to expand and train our direct sales force do not generate a corresponding increase in revenue. In particular, if we are unable to hire, develop and retain talented sales personnel, or if new direct sales personnel are unable to achieve desired productivity levels in a reasonable period of time, we may not be able to realize the expected benefits of this investment or increase our revenue.

 

We have previously identified material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting, and if we are unable to achieve and maintain effective internal control over financial reporting or effective disclosure controls, this could have a material adverse effect on our business.

 

We produce our consolidated financial statements in accordance with the requirements of U.S. GAAP. Effective internal controls are necessary for us to provide reliable financial reports to help mitigate the risk of fraud and to operate successfully as a publicly traded company. A material weakness is defined as a deficiency, or a combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of a company’s annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis by the company’s internal controls.

 

In connection with the preparation of our consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, we identified a material weakness in the design and operation of our internal controls over financial reporting relating to management review controls over complex, non-routine accounting transactions and the preparation and review of financial statements. Specifically, we determined that we had significant deficiencies related to our review of equity transactions, controls related to the preparation and review of our tax provision and the operation of our financial reporting controls, all of which aggregated to a material weakness in internal control over financial reporting. In 2013, we began implementing procedures and controls designed to mitigate the material weakness and underlying significant deficiencies. Amongst other actions, we have expanded our in-house accounting and finance resources, including hiring eleven new personnel since October 2012, including our chief financial officer; implemented enhanced review procedures; begun a comprehensive documentation of our internal controls and procedures; and implemented more formal procedures as to the evaluation of non-routine judgments and estimates. In addition, we are currently implementing an internal audit function and expect to complete our documentation of our internal controls and procedures by the end of 2014.

 

Although we believe these controls will be effective, we have not performed an evaluation of our internal control over financial reporting, pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, nor have we engaged our independent registered public accounting firm to perform an audit of our internal control over financial reporting as of any balance sheet date or for any period reported in our financial statements. Had we

 

26


Table of Contents

performed such an evaluation or had our independent registered public accounting firm performed an audit of our internal control over financial reporting, material weaknesses, in addition to those discussed above, may have been identified. For so long as we qualify as an “emerging growth company” as defined by the Jumpstart our Business Startups Act of 2012, or the JOBS Act, which may be up to five years following the date of our initial public offering that priced on August 8, 2013, or IPO, we will not be required to provide an auditor’s attestation report on our internal controls in future annual reports on Form 10-K as otherwise required by Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. During the course of the evaluation, documentation or attestation, we or our independent registered public accounting firm may identify weaknesses and deficiencies that we may not otherwise identify in a timely manner or at all as a result of the deferred implementation of this additional level of review.

 

In addition, as a result of various factors including in part the identified material weakness in the design and operation of our internal controls over financial reporting, our management concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures as of September 30, 2013 were not effective. Furthermore, our management may be unable to conclude in future periods that our disclosure controls and procedures are effective due to the effects of various factors, which may, in part, include unremediated material weakness in internal controls over financial reporting. The term “disclosure controls and procedures,” as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, means controls and other procedures of a company that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by a company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the rules and forms of the Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC. Disclosure controls and procedures include, without limitation, controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by a company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to the company’s management, including its principal executive and principal financial officers, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

 

We cannot assure you that we will be able to remediate our existing material weaknesses in a timely manner, if at all, or that in the future additional material weaknesses will not exist or otherwise be discovered, a risk that is significantly increased in light of the complexity of our business. If our efforts to remediate these material weaknesses are not successful or if other deficiencies occur, our ability to accurately and timely report our financial position, results of operations, cash flows or key operating metrics could be impaired, which could result in late filings of our annual and quarterly reports under the Exchange Act, restatements of our consolidated financial statements or other corrective disclosures, a decline in our stock price, suspension of trading or delisting of our common stock by the New York Stock Exchange, or other material adverse effects on our business, reputation, results of operations, financial condition or liquidity. Furthermore, if we continue to have our existing material weaknesses or other material weaknesses or significant deficiencies in the future, it could create a perception that our financial results do not fairly state our financial condition or results of operations. Any of the foregoing could have an adverse effect on the value of our common stock.

 

If we cannot maintain our corporate culture as we grow, we could lose the innovation, teamwork, passion and focus on execution that we believe contribute to our success, and our business may be harmed.

 

We believe that a critical component to our success has been our corporate culture. We have invested substantial time and resources in building our team. As we grow and develop the infrastructure of a public company, we may find it difficult to maintain these important aspects of our corporate culture. Any failure to preserve our culture could negatively affect our future success, including our ability to retain and recruit personnel and to effectively focus on and pursue our corporate objectives.

 

Because we generally recognize revenue from subscriptions ratably over the term of the agreement, near term changes in sales may not be reflected immediately in our operating results.

 

We offer our event and meeting management solutions primarily through a mix of single-year and multi-year subscription agreements and generally recognize revenue ratably over the related subscription period. We

 

27


Table of Contents

offer our hotel and venue marketing solutions primarily through a mix of single-year and multi-year arrangements and generally recognize revenue ratably over the related advertising period. As a result, much of the revenue we report in each quarter is derived from the recognition of previously billed and unbilled contract value relating to agreements entered into during prior quarters or years. In addition, as we generally invoice for no more than the next fiscal year for any customer contracts, including those for multiple years, we do not record deferred revenue beyond amounts invoiced as a liability on our balance sheet. A decline in new or renewed subscriptions or marketing solutions agreements in any one quarter is not likely to be reflected immediately in our revenue results for that quarter. Such declines, however, would negatively affect our revenue and deferred revenue balances in future periods, and the effect of significant downturns in sales and market acceptance of our solutions, and potential changes in our rate of renewals, may not be fully reflected in our results of operations until future periods. Our subscription and advertising model also makes it difficult for us to rapidly increase our total revenue and deferred revenue balance through additional sales in any period, as revenue from new customers must be recognized over the applicable subscription or advertising term.

 

We may not be able to secure additional financing on favorable terms, or at all, to meet our future capital needs.

 

We have funded our operations since inception primarily through equity financings, lease arrangements, and cash from operations. In the future, we may require additional capital to respond to business opportunities, challenges, acquisitions, a decline in the level of operating cash flows or unforeseen circumstances. We may determine to engage in equity or debt financings or enter into credit facilities for other reasons, and we may not be able to secure additional debt or equity financing in a timely manner on favorable terms, or at all. We do not currently have access to a credit arrangement, and we currently fund our operations using cash generated from operations. Any debt financing obtained by us in the future could involve restrictive covenants relating to our capital raising activities and other financial and operational matters, which may make it more difficult for us to obtain additional capital and to pursue business opportunities, including potential acquisitions. If we raise additional funds through further issuances of equity, convertible debt securities or other securities convertible into equity, our existing stockholders could suffer significant dilution in their ownership of our company, and any new equity securities we issue could have rights, preferences and privileges senior to those of holders of our common stock. If we are unable to obtain adequate financing or financing on terms satisfactory to us, when we require it, our ability to continue to grow or support our business and to respond to business challenges could be significantly limited.

 

Our internal controls over financial reporting may not be effective and our independent registered public accounting firm may not be able to certify as to their effectiveness, which could have a significant and adverse effect on our business and reputation.

 

We are not currently required to comply with Securities and Exchange Commission rules that implement Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, and are therefore not required to make a formal assessment of the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting for that purpose. At such time as we cease to be an “emerging growth company,” as defined by the JOBS Act, we will be required to comply with Section 404. We may subsequently identify material weaknesses or significant deficiencies in addition to those previously identified that we may not be able to remediate in time to meet the applicable deadline imposed upon us for compliance with the requirements of Section 404. In addition, if we fail to achieve and maintain the adequacy of our internal controls, as such standards are modified, supplemented or amended from time to time, we may not be able to ensure that we can conclude on an ongoing basis that we have effective internal controls over financial reporting in accordance with Section 404. We cannot be certain as to the timing of completion of our evaluation, testing and any remediation actions or the impact of the same on our operations. If we are not able to implement the requirements of Section 404 in a timely manner or with adequate compliance, our independent registered public accounting firm may issue an adverse opinion due to ineffective internal controls over financial reporting and we may be subject to sanctions or investigation by regulatory authorities, such as the Securities and Exchange Commission. As a result, there could be a negative reaction in the financial markets due to a loss of

 

28


Table of Contents

confidence in the reliability of our financial statements. In addition, we may be required to incur costs in improving our internal control system and the hiring of additional personnel. Any such action could negatively affect our operating results and financial condition.

 

Changes in financial accounting standards or practices, or our application of those standards or practices may cause adverse, unexpected financial reporting fluctuations and affect our reported results of operations.

 

Generally accepted accounting principles in the United States are subject to interpretation by the Financial Accounting Standards Board, or FASB, the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants, the Securities and Exchange Commission and various bodies formed to promulgate and interpret appropriate accounting principles. A change in accounting standards or practices can have a significant effect on our reported results and may even affect our reporting of transactions completed before the change is effective. New accounting pronouncements and varying interpretations of accounting pronouncements have occurred and may occur in the future. In addition, we may have flexibility to choose among multiple accounting methods that are generally accepted. Changes to existing rules, our application of those rules or the questioning of current practices may adversely affect our reported financial results or the way we conduct our business.

 

We may have difficulty scaling and adapting our existing infrastructure to accommodate increased traffic and storage demands, technology advances or customer requirements, which could cause delays or service interruptions and adversely affect our operating and financial results.

 

In the future, advances in technology, increases in traffic and storage demands and new customer requirements may require us to change our infrastructure, expand our infrastructure or replace our infrastructure entirely. Scaling and adapting our infrastructure is likely to be complex and require additional technical expertise. If we are required to make any changes to our infrastructure, we may incur substantial costs and experience delays or interruptions in our service. These delays or interruptions may cause customers and partners to become dissatisfied with our service and move to competing providers of event and meeting management solutions. Our failure to accommodate increased traffic and storage demands, increased costs, inefficiencies or failures to adapt to new technologies or customer requirements and the associated adjustments to our infrastructure could harm our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Some of our applications utilize open source software, and any failure to comply with the terms of one or more of these open source licenses could negatively affect our business.

 

Some of our applications include software covered by open source licenses, which may include, by way of example, GNU General Public License and the Apache License. The terms of various open source licenses have not been interpreted by courts, and there is a risk that such licenses could be construed in a manner that imposes unanticipated conditions or restrictions on our ability to market our applications. By the terms of certain open source licenses, we could be required to release the source code of our applications and to make our applications available under open source licenses, if we combine or distribute our applications with open source software in a certain manner. In the event that portions of our applications are determined to be subject to an open source license, we could be required to publicly release the affected portions of our source code, re-engineer all, or a portion of, those applications or otherwise be limited in the licensing of our applications, each of which could reduce or eliminate the value of our technologies and services. In addition to risks related to license requirements, usage of open source software can lead to greater risks than use of third party commercial software, as open source licensors generally do not provide warranties or controls on the origin of the software. Many of the risks associated with usage of open source software cannot be eliminated, and could negatively affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

If we do not or cannot maintain the compatibility of our solutions with third-party applications that our customers use in their businesses, demand for our solutions could decline.

 

The functionality of our cloud-based platform depends, in part, on our ability to integrate it with third-party applications and data management systems that our customers use and from which they obtain data. In addition,

 

29


Table of Contents

we rely on access to third-party application programming interfaces, or APIs, to provide our social media channel offerings through social media platforms. Third-party providers of these applications, data management systems and APIs may terminate their relationships with us, change the features of their applications and platforms, restrict our access to their applications and platforms or alter the terms governing use of their applications, data management systems and APIs and access to those applications and platforms in an adverse manner. Such changes could functionally limit or terminate our ability to use these third-party applications and platforms with our cloud-based platform, which could negatively impact our offerings and harm our business. Further, if we fail to integrate our platform with new third-party applications and platforms that our customers use, or to adapt to the data transfer requirements of such third-party applications and platforms, we may not be able to offer the functionality that our customers need, which would negatively impact our offerings and, as a result, could negatively affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Our business may be adversely affected by third-party claims, including by governmental bodies, regarding the content and advertising distributed by our customers through our service.

 

We rely on our customers to secure the rights to redistribute content over the internet or through mobile event apps, and we do not screen the content that they distribute using our solutions. There is no assurance that our customers have licensed all rights necessary for distribution, including internet or mobile app distribution. Other parties may claim certain rights in the content of our customers. In the event that our customers do not have the necessary distribution rights related to content, we may be required to cease distributing such content, or we may be subject to lawsuits and claims of damages for infringement of such rights. If these claims arise with frequency, the likelihood of our business being adversely affected would rise significantly.

 

We may not be able to utilize a significant portion of our net operating loss carryforwards, which could adversely affect our profitability.

 

As of September 30, 2013, we had federal and state net operating loss carryforwards due to prior period losses, which, if not utilized, will begin to expire in 2021 for both federal and state purposes. These net operating loss carryforwards could expire unused and be unavailable to offset future income tax liabilities, which could adversely affect our profitability. In addition, under Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, our ability to utilize net operating loss carryforwards or other tax attributes, such as research tax credits, in any taxable year may be further limited if we experience an “ownership change”. A Section 382 “ownership change” generally occurs if one or more stockholders or groups of stockholders who own at least 5% of our stock increase their ownership by more than 50 percentage points over their lowest ownership percentage within a rolling three-year period. Similar rules may apply under state tax laws. For example, we had an “ownership change” under Section 382 in 2001. This offering or future issuances of our stock could cause an “ownership change.” It is possible that an ownership change in connection with this offering, or any future ownership change, could have a material effect on the use of our net operating loss carryforwards or other tax attributes, which could adversely affect our profitability.

 

We are a multinational organization faced with increasingly complex tax issues in many jurisdictions, including in the United States, and we could be obligated to pay additional taxes in various jurisdictions.

 

As a multinational organization that operates in numerous jurisdictions in the United States and around the world, we may be subject to taxation in several jurisdictions with increasingly complex tax laws, the application of which can be uncertain. The authorities in these jurisdictions, including state and local taxing authorities in the United States, could successfully assert that we are obligated to pay additional taxes, interest and penalties. In addition, the amount of taxes we pay could increase substantially as a result of changes in the applicable tax principles, including increased tax rates, new tax laws or revised interpretations of existing tax laws and precedents, which could have a material adverse effect on our liquidity and operating results. The authorities could also claim that various withholding requirements apply to us or our subsidiaries or assert that benefits of tax treaties are not available to us or our subsidiaries, any of which could have a material impact on us and the results of our operations.

 

30


Table of Contents

We are exposed to fluctuations in currency exchange rates.

 

We face exposure to movements in currency exchange rates, which may cause our revenue and operating results to differ materially from expectations. Our operating results could be negatively affected depending on the amount of expense denominated in foreign currencies, primarily the Indian rupee. As exchange rates vary, revenue, cost of revenue, operating expenses and other operating results, when remeasured, may differ materially from expectations. In addition, our operating results are subject to fluctuation if our mix of U.S. and foreign currency denominated transactions and expenses changes in the future. Although we may apply certain strategies to mitigate foreign currency risk, these strategies might not eliminate our exposure to foreign exchange rate fluctuations and would involve costs and risks of their own, such as ongoing management time and expertise, external costs to implement the strategies and potential accounting implications. Additionally, as we anticipate growing our business further outside of the U.S., the effects of movements in currency exchange rates will increase as our transaction volume outside of the U.S. increases.

 

A significant portion of our revenue is derived from event and meeting planners. As such, our business is dependent upon identifying new event planners.

 

Revenue from our solutions for event and meeting planners has historically constituted the majority of our revenue and represented 70% of our total revenue for both the year ended December 31, 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013. Event and meeting planners can be found in a range of corporate departments, which makes it difficult to identify prospective planner customers. Since our formation, we have proactively and systematically worked to identify potential event planner customers. However, we cannot guarantee that we will be able to continue to identify new event planner customers, and the effort to identify new event planner customers will be more costly and time-consuming than seeking marketing contracts with new and existing venue customers.

 

If the estimates and assumptions we use to determine the size of our target market, customer groups or the verticals within customer groups are inaccurate, our future growth rate may be limited and our business would be harmed.

 

We calculate the size of our target market, customer groups and verticals within customer groups, based on data published by third parties and on internally generated data and assumptions. We have not independently verified any third-party information and cannot assure you of its accuracy or completeness. While we believe our market size information is generally reliable, such information is inherently imprecise. In addition, our projections, assumptions and estimates of future opportunities within our target market are necessarily subject to a high degree of uncertainty and risk due to a variety of factors, including those described in this prospectus. If third-party or internally generated data prove to be inaccurate or we make errors in our assumptions based on that data, our future growth rate may be limited. In addition, these inaccuracies or errors may cause us to misallocate capital and other business resources, which would harm our business.

 

As Internet commerce develops, federal, state and foreign governments may propose and implement new taxes and new laws to regulate Internet commerce, which could increase our operating costs and negatively affect our business.

 

As Internet commerce continues to evolve, increasing regulation by federal, state or foreign governments becomes more likely. Our business could be negatively impacted by the enforcement of existing laws and regulations or the enactment of new laws applicable to interactive marketing. The cost to comply with such laws or regulations could be significant and would increase our operating expenses, and we may be unable to pass along those costs to our customers in the form of increased fees. Legislation introduced in Congress in 2013, if enacted into law, would authorize states to require out-of-state retailers to collect and remit sales taxes on goods sold online. In addition, federal, state and foreign governmental or regulatory agencies may decide to impose taxes on services provided over the Internet or via email. Such taxes could discourage the use of the Internet and email as a means of commercial marketing, which would adversely affect the viability of our software.

 

31


Table of Contents

If Internet search engines’ methodologies are modified or our search result page rankings decline for other reasons, participant engagement in our websites and online communities could decline.

 

We depend in part on various Internet search engines to direct a significant amount of traffic to our websites. Our ability to maintain the number of potential participants directed to our websites is not entirely within our control. Our competitors’ search engine optimization, or SEO, efforts may result in their websites receiving a higher search result page ranking than ours, or Internet search engines could revise their methodologies in an attempt to improve search results, which could adversely affect placement of our search result page rankings. If search engine companies revise their search algorithms in ways that are detrimental to new participant growth on our websites or in ways that make it more difficult for organizers or participants to use our websites, or if competitors’ SEO efforts are more successful than ours, the overall growth in the numbers of organizers and participants using our websites could slow, participant engagement could decrease and we could lose existing participants and become less attractive to existing and prospective organizer customers. Our websites have experienced fluctuations in search result rankings in the past, and we anticipate similar fluctuations in the future. Any reduction in the number of participants directed to our website would harm our business and operating results.

 

Risks Related to this Offering and Ownership of Our Common Stock

 

Our quarterly results may fluctuate significantly and may not fully reflect the underlying performance of our business.

 

Our quarterly results of operations, including the level of our revenue, profitability, cash flow and deferred revenue, may vary significantly in the future and period-to-period comparisons of our operating results may not be meaningful. Accordingly, the results of any one quarter should not be relied upon as an indication of future performance. Our quarterly financial results may fluctuate as a result of a variety of factors, many of which are outside of our control, and as a result, may not fully reflect the underlying performance of our business. Fluctuation in quarterly results may negatively impact the value of our common stock. Factors that may cause fluctuations in our quarterly financial results include, without limitation, those listed below:

 

   

our ability to attract new customers;

 

   

the addition or loss of existing customers, including through acquisitions or consolidations;

 

   

the timing of recognition of revenue;

 

   

the amount and timing of operating expenses related to the maintenance and expansion of our business, operations and infrastructure;

 

   

network outages or security breaches;

 

   

general economic, industry and market conditions;

 

   

customer renewal rates;

 

   

increases or decreases in the number of features and functionality of our services or pricing changes upon any renewals of customer agreements;

 

   

changes in estimates used in the calculation of our income tax provision;

 

   

changes in our pricing policies or those of our competitors; and

 

   

seasonal variations in sales of our solutions, which has historically been highest in the fourth quarter of a calendar year.

 

If securities or industry analysts do not publish or cease publishing research or reports about us, our business or our market, or if they change their recommendations regarding our stock adversely, or if our actual results differ significantly from our guidance, our stock price and trading volume could decline.

 

The trading market for our common stock will be influenced by the research and reports that industry or securities analysts may publish about us, our business, our market or our competitors. If any of the analysts who

 

32


Table of Contents

may cover us change their recommendation regarding our stock adversely, or provide more favorable relative recommendations about our competitors, our stock price would likely decline. If any analyst who may cover us were to cease coverage of our company or fail to regularly publish reports on us, we could lose visibility in the financial markets, which in turn could cause our stock price or trading volume to decline.

 

In addition, from time to time, we may release earnings guidance or other forward-looking statements in our earnings releases, earnings conference calls or otherwise regarding our future performance that represent our management’s estimates as of the date of release. Some or all of the assumptions of any future guidance that we furnish may not materialize or may vary significantly from actual future results. Any failure to meet guidance or analysts’ expectations could have a material adverse effect on the trading price or volume of our stock.

 

An active, liquid and orderly trading market for our common stock may not develop, the price of our stock may be volatile, and you could lose all or part of your investment.

 

Prior to our initial listing of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on August 9, 2013 in connection with our IPO, there was no public market for shares of our common stock. We cannot assure you that an active trading market for our shares will continue to develop or be sustained. If an active market for our common stock does not continue to develop or is not sustained, it may be difficult to sell shares without depressing the market price for the shares or to sell your shares at all.

 

The price to the public of the common stock sold in this offering is determined through negotiation with the underwriters. That price does not necessarily reflect the price at which investors in the market will be willing to buy and sell our shares of common stock following this offering. In addition, the trading price of our common stock following this offering is likely to be highly volatile and could be subject to wide fluctuations in response to various factors, some of which are beyond our control.

 

In addition, the stock market in general, and the market for technology companies in particular, has experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of those companies. Broad market and industry factors may seriously affect the market price of companies’ stock, including ours, regardless of actual operating performance. These fluctuations may be even more pronounced in the trading market for our stock shortly following this offering. In addition, in the past, following periods of volatility in the overall market and the market price of a particular company’s securities, securities class action litigation has often been instituted against these companies. This litigation, if instituted against us, could result in substantial costs and a diversion of our management’s attention and resources.

 

If you purchase shares of our common stock in this offering, you will suffer immediate dilution of your investment.

 

The assumed public offering price of our common stock is substantially higher than the net tangible book value per share of our common stock. Therefore, if you purchase shares of our common stock in this offering, you will pay a price per share that substantially exceeds our net tangible book value per share after this offering. Based on an assumed public offering price of $35.86 per share, which was the last reported sales price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on January 14, 2014, you will experience immediate dilution of $32.22 per share, representing the difference between our as-adjusted net tangible book value per share after giving effect to this offering and the assumed public offering price.

 

We may invest or spend the proceeds of this offering in ways with which you may not agree or in ways which may not yield a return.

 

Our management will have considerable discretion in the application of the net proceeds of this offering, and you will not have the opportunity, as part of your investment decision and as a stockholder, to assess whether the proceeds are being used appropriately. The net proceeds may be invested with a view towards long-term

 

33


Table of Contents

benefits for our stockholders and this may not increase our operating results or market value. Until the net proceeds are used, they may be placed in investments that do not produce significant income or that may lose value.

 

We do not expect to declare any dividends in the foreseeable future.

 

We do not anticipate declaring any cash dividends to holders of our common stock in the foreseeable future. We anticipate that we will retain all of our future earnings for use in the development of our business and for general corporate purposes. Any determination to pay dividends in the future will be at the discretion of our Board of Directors. Consequently, investors may need to rely on sales of their common stock after price appreciation, which may never occur, as the only way to realize any future gains on their investment. Investors seeking cash dividends should not purchase our common stock.

 

A significant portion of our total outstanding shares are restricted from immediate resale but may be sold into the market in the near future. This could cause the market price of our common stock to drop significantly, even if our business is doing well.

 

The market price of shares of our common stock could decline as a result of (i) substantial sales of our common stock (particularly sales by our directors, executive officers, employees and significant stockholders), (ii) a large number of shares of our common stock becoming available for sale or (iii) the perception in the market that holders of a large number of shares intend to sell their shares.

 

Based on the total number of outstanding shares of our common stock as of September 30, 2013, upon completion of this offering, we will have 40,543,357 shares of common stock outstanding, assuming no exercise of our outstanding options after September 30, 2013 except the 9,000 shares subject to options exercised for sale by selling stockholders in this offering.

 

As a result of the lock-up agreements described in “Shares Eligible for Future Sale” and “Underwriters,” shares will be available for sale in the public market at various times as follows:

 

   

4,800,000 shares sold in this offering and 6,263,850 shares sold in our IPO will be immediately available for sale in the public market;

 

   

4,189,444 shares will be eligible for sale in the public market, subject to the provisions of Rule 144 or Rule 701, on February 5, 2014, upon the expiration of lock-up agreements entered into prior to our IPO; and

 

   

25,290,063 shares will be eligible for sale in the public market, subject to the provisions of Rule 144 or Rule 701, upon the expiration of lock-up agreements entered into in connection with this offering 90 days from the date of this prospectus.

 

In addition, we have filed a registration statement on Form S-8 registering the issuance of 8,281,472 shares of common stock subject to options or other equity awards issued or reserved for future issuance under our equity incentive plans. Shares registered under that registration statement on Form S-8 will be available for sale in the public market subject to vesting arrangements and exercise of options, the lock-up agreements described above and the restrictions of Securities Act Rule 144 in the case of our affiliates.

 

Additionally, after this offering, the holders of an aggregate of 28,881,251 shares of our common stock will continue to have rights, subject to some conditions, to require us to file one or more registration statements covering their shares or to include their shares in registration statements that we may file for ourselves or other stockholders. If we were to register these shares for resale, they could be freely sold in the public market. If these additional shares are sold, or if it is perceived that they will be sold, in the public market, the trading price of our common stock could decline.

 

34


Table of Contents

Concentration of ownership of our common stock among our existing executive officers, directors and principal stockholders may prevent new investors from influencing significant corporate decisions.

 

Upon completion of this offering, our executive officers, directors and current beneficial owners of 5% or more of our common stock and their respective affiliates will, in aggregate, beneficially own approximately 60% of our outstanding common stock assuming the underwriters do not exercise their right to purchase any additional shares. These persons, acting together, would be able to significantly influence all matters requiring stockholder approval, including the election and removal of directors and any merger or other significant corporate transactions. The interests of this group of stockholders may not coincide with our interests or the interests of other stockholders.

 

Anti-takeover provisions contained in our certificate of incorporation and bylaws, as well as provisions of Delaware law, could impair a takeover attempt.

 

Our certificate of incorporation, bylaws, and Delaware law contain provisions which could have the effect of rendering more difficult, delaying, or preventing an acquisition deemed undesirable by our board of directors. Our corporate governance documents include provisions: creating a classified board of directors whose members serve staggered three-year terms; authorizing “blank check” preferred stock, which could be issued by our board of directors without stockholder approval and may contain voting, liquidation, dividend and other rights superior to our common stock; limiting the liability of, and providing indemnification to, our directors and officers; limiting the ability of our stockholders to call and bring business before special meetings; requiring advance notice of stockholder proposals for business to be conducted at meetings of our stockholders and for nominations of candidates for election to our board of directors; and controlling the procedures for the conduct and scheduling of board of directors and stockholder meetings. These provisions, alone or together, could delay or prevent hostile takeovers and changes in control or changes in our management.

 

As a Delaware corporation, we are also subject to provisions of Delaware law, including Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation law, which prevents some stockholders holding more than 15% of our outstanding common stock from engaging in certain business combinations without approval of the holders of substantially all of our outstanding common stock.

 

Any provision of our certificate of incorporation, bylaws or Delaware law that has the effect of delaying or deterring a change in control could limit the opportunity for our stockholders to receive a premium for their shares of our common stock, and could also adversely affect the market price of our common stock.

 

We will continue to incur significantly increased costs and devote substantial management time as a result of operating as a public company.

 

As a public company, we incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not incur as a private company. For example, we are subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act and will be required to comply with the applicable requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010, as well as rules and regulations subsequently implemented by the Securities and Exchange Commission and the New York Stock Exchange, including the establishment and maintenance of effective disclosure and financial controls and changes in corporate governance practices. We expect that compliance with these requirements will increase our legal and financial compliance costs and will make some activities more time consuming and costly. In addition, our management and other personnel devote substantial time to our public company requirements, which diverts attention from operational and other business matters. In particular, we expect to incur significant expenses and devote substantial management effort toward ensuring compliance with the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, which will increase when we are no longer an “emerging growth company,” as defined by the JOBS Act. We will need to hire additional accounting and financial staff with appropriate public company experience and technical accounting knowledge and maintain an internal audit function. We cannot predict or estimate the amount of additional costs we may incur as a result of becoming a public company or the timing of such costs.

 

35


Table of Contents

As a public company, it is more difficult and more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance on the terms that we would like as compared to prior periods when we were a privately-held company. As a result, it may be more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified people to serve on our board of directors, our board committees or as executive officers.

 

We are an “emerging growth company,” and any decision on our part to comply only with certain reduced reporting and disclosure requirements applicable to emerging growth companies could make our common stock less attractive to investors.

 

We are an “emerging growth company,” as defined in the JOBS Act, and, for as long as we continue to be an “emerging growth company,” we may choose to take advantage of exemptions from various reporting requirements applicable to other public companies but not to “emerging growth companies,” including, but not limited to, not being required to have our independent registered public accounting firm audit our internal controls over financial reporting under Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in our periodic reports and proxy statements, and exemptions from the requirements of holding a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation and stockholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved. We could be an “emerging growth company” for up to five years following the completion of our initial public offering, although, if we have more than $1.0 billion in annual revenue, if the market value of our common stock that is held by non-affiliates exceeds $700 million as of June 30 of any year, or we issue more than $1.0 billion of non-convertible debt over a three-year period before the end of that five-year period, we would cease to be an “emerging growth company” as of the following December 31. We cannot predict if investors will find our common stock less attractive if we choose to rely on these exemptions. If some investors find our common stock less attractive as a result of any choices to reduce future disclosure, there may be a less active trading market for our common stock and our stock price may be more volatile.

 

Under the JOBS Act, emerging growth companies can delay adopting new or revised accounting standards until such time as those standards apply to private companies. We have irrevocably elected not to avail ourselves of this exemption from new or revised accounting standards, and, therefore, we will be subject to the same new or revised accounting standards as other public companies that are not emerging growth companies.

 

36


Table of Contents

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

This prospectus contains forward-looking statements that involve substantial risks and uncertainties. The forward-looking statements are contained principally in the sections entitled “Prospectus Summary,” “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Business,” but are also contained elsewhere in this prospectus. In some cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by the words “may,” “might,” “will,” “could,” “would,” “should,” “expect,” “intend,” “plan,” “aim,” “objective,” “anticipate,” “believe,” “estimate,” “predict,” “project,” “potential,” “continue,” “ongoing,” “target,” “seek” or the negative of these terms, or other comparable terminology intended to identify statements about the future. These statements involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause our actual results, levels of activity, performance or achievements to be materially different from the information expressed or implied by these forward-looking statements. Although we believe that we have a reasonable basis for each forward-looking statement contained in this prospectus, we caution you that these statements are based on a combination of facts and factors currently known by us and our expectations of the future, about which we cannot be certain.

 

You should refer to the “Risk Factors” section of this prospectus for a discussion of important factors that may cause our actual results to differ materially from those expressed or implied by our forward-looking statements. As a result of these factors, we cannot assure you that the forward-looking statements in this prospectus will prove to be accurate. Furthermore, if our forward-looking statements prove to be inaccurate, the inaccuracy may be material. In light of the significant uncertainties in these forward-looking statements, you should not regard these statements as a representation or warranty by us or any other person that we will achieve our objectives and plans in any specified time frame, or at all. We undertake no obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by law.

 

You should read this prospectus and the documents that we reference in this prospectus and have filed as exhibits to the registration statement, of which this prospectus is a part, completely and with the understanding that our actual future results may be materially different from what we expect. We qualify all of our forward-looking statements by these cautionary statements.

 

INDUSTRY DATA

 

Some of the industry and market data contained in this prospectus are based on independent industry publications, including those generated by eMarketer or other publicly available information as well as an independent overview of the global events and meetings industry prepared by Frost & Sullivan, which was commissioned by us. Frost & Sullivan has consented to the references to their reports and the use of their name in this prospectus. This information involves a number of assumptions, estimates and limitations. These industry publications, surveys and forecasts generally indicate that their information has been obtained from sources believed to be reliable, although they do not guarantee the accuracy or completeness of such information. The industry in which we operate is subject to a high degree of uncertainty and risk due to a variety of factors, including those described in “Risk Factors.” These and other factors could cause results to differ materially from those expressed in these publications.

 

37


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS

 

We estimate that the net proceeds from our issuance and sale of 650,000 shares of our common stock in this offering will be approximately $21.6 million, or approximately $25.0 million if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase in full, based upon an assumed public offering price of $35.86 per share, which is the last reported sales price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on January 14, 2014, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. We intend to use the net proceeds from this offering to pay for the expenses of this offering and for working capital and general corporate purposes, including further expansion of our operations and product development.

 

The principal purposes of this offering are to facilitate an orderly distribution of shares for the selling stockholders in the offering and increase our public float. The selling stockholders are selling a significant majority of the shares of common stock being sold in this offering, including a significant majority of the shares sold upon any exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of common stock by the selling stockholders. We will pay all of the expenses relating to the registration and offering of the shares sold by the selling stockholders, other than underwriting discounts and commissions relating to those shares and the fees and expenses of counsel to the selling stockholders.

 

The expected use of net proceeds from this offering represents our intentions based upon our present plans and business conditions. We cannot predict with certainty all of the particular uses for the proceeds of this offering or the amounts that we will actually spend on the uses set forth above. Accordingly, our management will have significant flexibility in applying the net proceeds of this offering.

 

The timing and amount of our actual expenditures will be based on many factors, including cash flows from operations and the anticipated growth of our business. Pending their use, we intend to invest the net proceeds to us of this offering in a variety of capital-preservation investments, including short- and intermediate-term, interest-bearing, investment-grade securities.

 

MARKET PRICE OF COMMON STOCK

 

Our common stock commenced trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CVT” on August 9, 2013. The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the high and low reported sales prices of our common stock as reported on the New York Stock Exchange:

 

     High      Low  

2013

     

Third quarter (from August 9, 2013)

   $ 46.13       $ 30.01   

Fourth quarter

   $ 40.60       $ 30.49   

2014

     

First quarter (through January 14, 2014)

   $ 38.64       $ 33.61   

 

As of January 14, 2014, there were approximately 221 holders of record of our common stock. The actual number of stockholders is greater than this number of record holders and includes stockholders who are beneficial owners but whose shares are held in street name by brokers and other nominees. This number of holders of record also does not include stockholders whose shares may be held in trust by other entities. The last reported sale price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on January 14, 2014 was $35.86 per share.

 

DIVIDEND POLICY

 

We have never declared or paid any cash dividends on our common stock. We anticipate that we will retain any earnings for use in the development of our business and for general corporate purposes. Accordingly, we do not expect to pay cash dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future. Any determination to pay dividends in the future will be at the discretion of our board of directors.

 

38


Table of Contents

CAPITALIZATION

 

The following table sets forth our cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments, net of restricted cash, and capitalization as of September 30, 2013:

 

   

on an actual basis without any adjustments to reflect subsequent or anticipated events; and

 

   

on an as adjusted basis reflecting the receipt by us of the net proceeds from the sale of 650,000 shares of common stock by us in this offering at an assumed public offering price of $35.86 per share, which is the last reported sales price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on January 14, 2014, after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us and excluding the exercise of any option held by the underwriters with respect to this offering.

 

The following information is illustrative only of our cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments, net of restricted cash, and capitalization following the completion of this offering and will change based on the actual public offering price and other terms of this offering determined at pricing. You should read this table together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our financial statements and the related notes appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

     As of September 30, 2013  
         Actual             As Adjusted      
    

(in thousands,

except share and per share data)

 

Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments, net of restricted cash

   $ 157,811      $ 179,419   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity:

    

Preferred stock, $0.001 par value per share; 100,000,000 shares authorized, actual and as adjusted; no shares issued and outstanding, actual and as adjusted

   $      $   

Common stock, $0.001 par value per share; 1,000,000,000 shares authorized, actual and as adjusted; 40,404,571 shares issued and 39,884,357 shares outstanding, actual; and 41,063,571 shares issued and 40,543,357 shares outstanding, as adjusted

     40        41   

Treasury stock

     (3,966     (3,966

Additional paid-in capital

     168,432        190,039   

Accumulated deficit

     (22,551     (22,551
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     141,955        163,563   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capitalization

   $ 141,955      $ 163,563   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

The number of shares of common stock outstanding in the table above does not include:

 

   

3,642,071 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of options outstanding, including 318,369 shares underlying stock options that have been early exercised and remain subject to vesting, at a weighted-average exercise price of $5.51 per share under our Stock and Equity Incentive Plans as of September 30, 2013 except the As Adjusted column reflects the exercise of certain of such options for 9,000 shares for sale by the selling stockholders in this offering; and

 

   

an additional 4,923,771 shares of our common stock reserved for future issuance under our 2013 Equity Incentive Plan following this offering.

 

39


Table of Contents

DILUTION

 

If you invest in our common stock in this offering, your interest will be diluted to the extent of the difference between the public offering price per share and the as adjusted net tangible book value per share of our common stock immediately after this offering. Net tangible book value per share is determined by dividing our total tangible assets less total liabilities by the number of outstanding shares of our common stock.

 

As of September 30, 2013, we had a net tangible book value of $126.1 million, or approximately $3.16 per share of common stock.

 

Investors participating in this offering will incur immediate and substantial dilution. After giving effect to the issuance and sale by us of 650,000 shares of our common stock in this offering at an assumed public offering price of $35.86 per share, which is the last reported sales price of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on January 14, 2014, and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, our as adjusted net tangible book value as of September 30, 2013 would have been approximately $147.7 million, or approximately $3.64 per share of common stock. This represents an immediate increase in the net tangible book value of $0.48 per share to existing stockholders, and an immediate dilution of $32.22 per share to investors purchasing shares of our common stock in this offering. The following table illustrates this per share dilution:

 

Public offering price per share

      $ 35.86   

Net tangible book value per share as of September 30, 2013

   $ 3.16      

Increase in net tangible book value per share attributable to this offering per share to existing investors

     0.48      
  

 

 

    

As adjusted net tangible book value per share after this offering

        3.64   
     

 

 

 

Dilution per share to new investors

      $ 32.22   
     

 

 

 

 

If the underwriters exercise their option in full to purchase 97,500 additional shares of common stock from us in this offering, the as adjusted net tangible book value per share after the offering would be $3.72 per share, the increase in the net tangible book value per share to existing stockholders would be $0.56 per share and the dilution to new investors purchasing common stock in this offering would be $32.14 per share.

 

The number of shares of common stock outstanding after this offering is based on 39,884,357 shares outstanding as of September 30, 2013. This number excludes:

 

   

3,642,071 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of options outstanding, including 318,369 shares underlying stock options that have been early exercised and remain subject to vesting, at a weighted-average exercise price of $5.51 per share under our Stock and Equity Incentive Plans as of September 30, 2013 but includes the exercise of certain of such options for 9,000 shares for sale by the selling stockholders in this offering; and

 

   

an additional 4,923,771 shares of our common stock reserved for future issuance under our 2013 Equity Incentive Plan following this offering.

 

The shares of our common stock reserved for future issuance under our equity plans will be subject to automatic annual increases in accordance with the terms of the plans. To the extent that options or warrants are exercised, new options are issued under our equity incentive plan or we issue additional shares of common stock in the future, there will be further dilution to investors participating in this offering. In addition, we may choose to raise additional capital because of market conditions or strategic considerations, even if we believe that we have sufficient funds for our current or future operating plans. If we raise additional capital through the sale of equity or convertible debt securities, the issuance of these securities could result in further dilution to our stockholders.

 

40


Table of Contents

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

 

The following selected consolidated financial data for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 and the selected consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2011 and 2012 are derived from our audited consolidated financial statements that have been audited by KPMG LLP, independent registered public accounting firm and are included elsewhere in this prospectus. The following selected consolidated financial data for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2009 and 2010 and the selected consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2008, 2009 and 2010 are derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements and are not included in this prospectus. The following selected consolidated statement of operations data for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013 and balance sheet data as of September 30, 2013 from our unaudited consolidated interim financial statements appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. The unaudited consolidated financial data for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013 and as of September 30, 2013 includes, all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring accruals, that are necessary in the opinion of our management for a fair presentation of our financial position and results of operations for these periods.

 

Our historical results are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected in the future, and our operating results for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the entire year ended December 31, 2013. The selected consolidated financial data should be read together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, related notes, and other financial information included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

Consolidated Statement of Operations Data

 

     Year ended December 31,      Nine months  ended
September 30,
 
     2008      2009      2010      2011     2012      2012      2013  
     (In thousands, except per share amounts)  

Revenue

   $ 26,129       $ 31,837       $ 45,060       $ 60,854      $ 83,474       $ 59,865       $ 80,440   

Cost of revenue(1)

     5,573         7,206         10,122         16,660        20,573         14,648         21,588   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     20,556         24,631         34,938         44,194        62,901         45,217         58,852   

Operating expenses:

                   

Sales and marketing(1)

     10,087         12,302         18,227         29,305        35,873         25,748         35,202   

Research and development(1)

     1,015         1,605         2,201         4,172        7,605         5,391         8,105   

General and administrative(1)

     4,754         5,883         6,946         8,422        11,523         7,957         16,891   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     15,856         19,790         27,374         41,899        55,001         39,096         60,198   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     4,700         4,841         7,564         2,295        7,900         6,121         (1,346

Interest income

     180         114         111         270        811         670         677   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations before income tax expense

     4,880         4,955         7,675         2,565        8,711         6,791         (669

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

     1,854         1,641         2,932         2,749        4,406         4,007         2,136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 3,026       $ 3,314       $ 4,743       $ (184   $ 4,305       $ 2,784       $ (2,805
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share:

                   

Basic

   $ 0.22       $ 0.21       $ 0.28       $ (0.01   $ 0.13       $ 0.08       $ (0.14
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ 0.08       $ 0.09       $ 0.14       $ (0.01   $ 0.12       $ 0.08       $ (0.14
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding:

                   

Basic

     13,480         15,971         17,194         16,758        33,167         33,252         20,336   

Diluted

     36,947         36,946         33,914         16,758        34,791         34,847         20,336   

 

41


Table of Contents

 

  (1)   Stock-based compensation expense included in these line items is as follows:

 

     Year ended December 31,      Nine months  ended
September 30,
 
       2008          2009          2010          2011          2012          2012          2013    
     (In thousands)  

Cost of revenue

   $ 8       $ 62       $ 33       $ 690       $ 762       $ 586       $ 886   

Sales and marketing

     14         105         57         2,376         2,895         2,105         2,092   

Research and development

     2         16         9         373         539         392         553   

General and administrative

     3         23         12         512         1,010         734         689   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total stock-based compensation expense

   $ 27       $ 206       $ 111       $ 3,951       $ 5,206       $ 3,817       $ 4,220   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Balance Sheet Data

 

     December 31,      September  30,
2013
 
     2008      2009      2010      2011      2012     
     (in thousands)  

Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments, net of restricted cash

   $ 7,945       $ 10,035       $ 19,315       $ 26,485       $ 26,170       $ 157,811   

Total current assets

     14,367         21,610         36,806         48,764         61,320         184,236   

Total assets

     22,113         28,314         45,376         58,441         90,030         214,964   

Deferred revenue

     12,933         19,687         29,362         37,293         51,554         48,754   

Total current liabilities

     14,779         22,188         34,022         45,189         68,747         70,612   

Total non-current liabilities

     1,043         956         992         1,086         2,553         2,397   

Stockholders’ equity

     6,291         5,170         10,362         12,166         18,730         141,955   

 

42


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF

FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and the related notes to those statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. In addition to historical financial information, the following discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions. Consolidated financial data referenced in this section as of and for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 are derived from our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. Consolidated financial data referenced in this section as of and for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2009 and 2010 are derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements not included in this prospectus. Consolidated financial data referenced in this section as of and for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013 are derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The unaudited consolidated financial data as of and for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013 includes, all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring accruals, that are necessary in the opinion of our management for a fair presentation of our financial position and results of operations for these periods. Our actual results and timing of selected events may differ materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of many factors, including those discussed under “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this prospectus. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.”

 

Overview

 

We are a leading cloud-based enterprise event management platform. We provide solutions for both sides of the events and meetings value chain: (i) event and meeting planners, and (ii) hotels and venues. Our integrated, cloud-based solution addresses the entire event lifecycle by allowing event and meeting planners to organize, market and manage their meetings, conferences, tradeshows and other events. Our online marketplace connects event planners and venues through our vertical search engine that accesses our proprietary database of detailed venue information. The combination of these solutions creates an integrated platform that allows us to generate revenue from both sides of the events and meetings value chain.

 

Our event and meeting planner customers include enterprises such as corporations, associations, not-for-profits, government agencies and universities. These customers enter into annual and multi-year subscription contracts to utilize part or all of our cloud-based software solutions to plan, manage and execute enterprise events and meetings including external events, such as conferences, tradeshows, and customer events, as well as internal events, such as sales meetings, training seminars and team-building events. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 6,700 event and meeting planner customers. Our event and meeting planner customers used our event management solutions to execute more than 157,000 events and meetings and managed 6.7 million registrations during the nine months ended September 30, 2013. Revenue from our event and meeting planning platform subscription solutions were $58.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2012 and $56.0 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2013, or 70% of our total revenue during those periods. We generally recognize revenue from these contracts ratably over the term of the contract.

 

On the other side of the event value chain, hotels and venues utilize our online marketing solutions to generate more visibility with ready-to-transact event and meeting planners. Our online marketplace, the Cvent Supplier Network, or CSN, connects tens of thousands of event and meeting planners seeking the best venue for their event with more than 200,000 venues in our proprietary database. We believe that our CSN contains the world’s largest, most accurate and searchable database of detailed meeting venue information with listings of hotels, conference centers, convention centers, resorts, restaurants, museums, country clubs, wineries, castles and other special event venues in more than 175 countries. Hotels and venues enter into annual and multi-year advertising contracts with us for marketing solutions that increase the prominence of their properties in our CSN; we recognize the revenue from these marketing solutions over the term of the agreement based on the estimated selling prices of each solution. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 57,000 active CSN event and

 

43


Table of Contents

meeting planner users compared to the approximately 50,000 active CSN event and meeting planner users as of December 31, 2012. The CSN is available with the same functionality to users of our paid subscription event and meeting platform solutions as well as to event and meeting planners that simply visit the CSN site and establish a free user account. All of these users have the ability to submit RFPs to hotels and venues free of charge using the CSN. We consider an event and meeting planner to be “active” if such user accessed their account within the 12 months preceding the date of measurement. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 5,600 hotel and venue customers paying for marketing solutions. Event planners transmitted approximately 947,000 RFPs for events requiring approximately 15.6 million room nights during the nine months ended September 30, 2013. Revenue from our marketing solutions were $24.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2012 and $24.4 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2013, or 30% of our total revenue during those periods.

 

We were established in 1999 as a provider of event registration software to event and meeting planners. During the steep economic downturn in the technology sector from 2000 to 2002, we faced initial macroeconomic setbacks to our business and endured substantial austerity. We believe our early struggles have resulted in a strong culture of teamwork and entrepreneurial spirit. We have also evolved during that period from an event registration and event marketing software provider to a comprehensive platform solution covering the entire event value chain starting from venue sourcing to collecting online feedback from attendees.

 

Our revenue has increased from $26.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2008 to $83.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2012 and $80.4 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013. Our net income grew from $3.0 million during the year ended December 31, 2008 to $4.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2012, although we generated a net loss of $2.8 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013. We had adjusted EBITDA of $20.3 million and $12.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013, respectively. We first launched our CSN in 2008, and revenue from advertising solutions has grown from an immaterial percentage of total revenue during the year ended December 31, 2008 to 30% of total revenue during each of the year ended December 31, 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013. Although we have experienced substantial growth in revenues and adjusted EBITDA in recent years, we are dependent on attracting new event and meeting planner customers and new marketing customers to sustain a similar level of growth in future periods.

 

Although we have historically grown our business organically, we acquired three small complementary businesses during the year ended December 31, 2012. In January 2012, we acquired Seed Labs LLC, now branded as our CrowdTorch product, to develop our mobile app capabilities for consumer events. In June 2012, we acquired CrowdCompass, Inc. to develop our mobile app capabilities for business events. In December 2012, we acquired TicketMob LLC to develop our ticketing capabilities. We expect to maintain our focus on organic growth in the future and may pursue opportunistic acquisitions that add complementary technology or expand our geographic footprint.

 

We generate the majority of our revenue from North America. Revenue from outside North America accounted for 7%, 9% and 10% for years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013, respectively. However, we believe our market opportunity is global, and we expect that international revenue will grow as a percentage of our total revenue in future periods as we place increasing emphasis on developing that element of our business. To support our international expansion and to increase global sales for all of our solutions, we opened our first European sales office in London in May 2013 and ultimately plan to expand our sales force in Europe. We also plan to introduce select European and Asian language planner interfaces in future periods to strengthen our penetration within European and Asian event and meeting planner markets.

 

We believe an important element of our past success has been the effective use of our India office. As of September 30, 2013, we employed approximately 750 personnel in India, replicating nearly every U.S.-based business division there, as well as additional functions unique to our India operations. Our India operations help us accomplish three business objectives: (i) near-continuous technical development and customer service,

 

44


Table of Contents

(ii) worldwide geographic reach for marketing efforts and (iii) building and maintaining our proprietary databases. Combining the resources of our U.S. and India operations, we are able to continue technical development and customer support throughout the normal business hours of each region. In addition, our India office houses the majority of our marketing personnel for the Asia-Pacific and Europe, Middle East and Africa regions. Finally, we leverage our Indian operations to build our large event planner contact database and to research and maintain more than 200,000 venues on our CSN. We are able to benefit greatly from the labor and infrastructure cost advantages of the region and accomplish many critical business tasks in an efficient and cost effective manner.

 

Since 1999, we have relied on private placements and our initial public offering of capital stock, and cash from operating activities to fund our ongoing operations. In July 2011, three venture capital funds invested $135.9 million in our business. The net proceeds from this transaction were used to repurchase shares held by long-time early angel and venture capital investors as well as from certain members of our senior management. In August 2013, we closed our initial public offering, pursuant to which we received net proceeds of $122.1 million after underwriters’ discounts and commissions and offering-related costs.

 

Our ability to grow our revenue and capitalize on the significant market opportunity we see for ourselves depends on our ability to get more event planners, hotels and venues to adopt our solutions, grow the number of our solutions being used per customer and expand our geographical presence. In the near-term, although we expect revenue growth, we expect that our cost of revenue and operating expenses will increase as a percentage of revenue. Marketing and sales expenses are also expected to increase as a percentage of revenue, as we continue to expand our direct sales teams, international operations and increase our marketing activities. We believe that we must invest in maintaining a high level of client service and support as we consider it critical for our continued success. As such, we expect to invest in research and development to continue to provide cutting edge solutions for our clients. Finally, we also expect to incur additional general and administrative expenses as a result of both our growth and our transition to becoming a public company.

 

Key Metrics

 

     Year ended December 31,     Nine months ended September 30,  
     2010     2011     2012         2012             2013      
     (In thousands, except percentages)  

Financial metrics

          

Revenue

   $ 45,060      $ 60,854      $ 83,474      $ 59,865      $ 80,440   

Year-over-year percentage increase

     42     35     37     37     34

Net income (loss)

   $ 4,743      $ (184   $ 4,305      $ 2,784      $ (2,805

Adjusted EBITDA(1)

   $ 10,781      $ 11,782      $ 20,344      $ 14,919      $ 12,717   

Cash flows provided by operating activities

   $ 14,056      $ 14,610      $ 23,581      $ 25,748      $ 18,898   

Operating metrics

          

Event registrations processed

     4,664        5,757        7,325        5,656        6,690   

Events and meetings managed

     83        108        139        106        158   

Room nights requested

     6,815        9,114        13,851        10,320        15,563   

Number of RFPs transmitted

     564        825        1,108        840        947   

 

(1)   Adjusted EBITDA is not calculated in accordance with GAAP. A reconciliation of this non-GAAP measure to the most directly comparable GAAP-based measure along with a summary of the definition and its material limitation are included at footnote (2) of “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data—Other Financial Metrics.”

 

We monitor the key financial and operating metrics set forth in the preceding table to help us evaluate trends, establish budgets, measure the effectiveness and efficiency of our operations and gauge our cash generation. We discuss revenue and the components of net income (loss) in the sections titled “—Financial

 

45


Table of Contents

Operations Overview” and “—Results of Operations,” adjusted EBITDA in footnote (2) in the section titled “Prospectus Summary—Summary Consolidated Financial Data—Other Financial Metrics” and cash flows provided by operating activities in the section titled “—Liquidity and Capital Resources.” The other metrics presented are described in further detail as follows:

 

Event Registrations Processed. We measure event registrations processed as the total number of all attendee registrations executed through our platform in a given period. We believe that the number of event registrations processed and the year-on-year growth rate help us evaluate the scale of events being executed through our software platform. We do not generate revenue on the basis of a fixed percentage per registration. Our pricing model is primarily based on contracted fees for blocks of registrations with an additional fee being charged for every registration being processed over and above that contracted amount. Thus, increases in registrations are a leading indicator of future increases in our revenue. These registrations do not include any tickets/registrations sold on the TicketMob event ticketing platform.

 

Events and Meetings Managed. We define events and meetings managed as the total number of all events and meetings managed through our platform in a given period. This amount includes all events and meetings using the date the event was created as listed in our system to determine which period the event was first actively managed by our platform. This also includes meetings being tracked on our platform by large enterprise clients for budgeting and management purposes. This amount does not include events and meetings identified by the planner as not yet active or deleted or any ticketing events managed on the TicketMob event ticketing platform. We generally do not generate revenue on the basis of a rate per event or meeting. Our pricing model is based on a combination of (i) contracted fees for blocks of registrations with an additional fee being charged for every registration being processed over and above that contracted amount, (ii) annual maintenance fees and (iii) a fee per each additional module sold within our platform. Thus, the total number of events and meetings managed is a leading indicator of our revenue and helps us evaluate the scale being executed through our Event Management or Strategic Meetings Management solutions.

 

Room Nights Requested. We measure the number of room nights requested by event planners in a given period based on the total number of hotel guest room nights requested in connection with all unique RFPs transmitted through our CSN in such period less known cancelled RFPs. Although planners may submit a unique RFP created on our system to multiple venues, we consider each individual RFP created and transmitted on our system as an RFP representative of only one event. Event planners occasionally create more than one unique RFP for a particular event under certain circumstances, but we believe such behavior is infrequent. In addition, the actual number of room nights purchased in connection with an event from a particular venue may vary from the room nights requested. Nonetheless, we believe that room nights requested is a leading indicator of our online marketplace’s adoption by event planners and its significant network effects. As the number of room nights requested increases, more venues are incentivized to advertise and list in our CSN due to its value proposition for advertisers.

 

Number of RFPs Transmitted. We calculate the number of RFPs transmitted as the total count of all RFPs sent to all hotels and venues through our CSN during the period excluding events and meetings identified by the planner as cancelled. Most event planners request proposals from multiple venues for a particular event, and this metric reflects the gross level of activity by planners interacting with venues. We believe that the number of RFPs processed through our CSN is a leading indicator of our online marketplace’s adoption by event planners, as it shows the total level of activity on our network. As the number of RFPs transmitted increases, more venues are incentivized to advertise and list in our CSN due to the increased opportunity for venues to connect with planners.

 

46


Table of Contents

Financial Operations Overview

 

Revenue

 

We generate revenue by offering subscriptions to our Event Management platform and marketing solutions on the Cvent Supplier Network. Since 2008, our revenue from our CSN has increased as a percentage of revenue as follows:

 

    Year ended December 31,     Nine months ended September 30,  
    2008     2009     2010     2011     2012         2012             2013      
    (Dollars in thousands)  

Revenue by product:

             

Platform subscriptions

  $ 26,034      $ 29,191      $ 35,162      $ 44,379      $ 58,733      $ 41,991      $ 56,039   

Marketing solutions

    95        2,646        9,898        16,475        24,741        17,874        24,401   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenue

  $ 26,129      $ 31,837      $ 45,060      $ 60,854      $ 83,474      $ 59,865      $ 80,440   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Percentage of revenue by product:

             

Platform subscriptions

    100     92     78     73     70     70     70

Marketing solutions

           8        22        27        30        30        30   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    100     100     100     100     100     100     100
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

Platform Subscriptions. We generate the majority of our revenue through subscriptions for our event management solutions platform, pricing for which is based on the features and functionality selected. Our Strategic Meetings Management solution is targeted towards the large enterprise market, and includes the full functionality of our platform. Our Event Management solution, which is targeted towards mid-market and smaller enterprises, has many of the same features as our Strategic Meetings Management solution but does not include some of the advanced features and functionality required by larger organizations. The number of attendee registrations available to customers subscribing to the registration functionality is contractually fixed, and registrations above the contracted amount result in additional fees paid by the customer.

 

Our customer contracts are typically not cancellable without cause and typically range in length from one to three years. We generally recognize revenue from platform subscriptions ratably over the term of the agreement. Customers are typically invoiced in advance on a quarterly or annual basis. Amounts that have been invoiced are initially recorded as deferred revenue and are recognized as revenue ratably over the subscription period. We refer to contractual amounts that have not been invoiced as unbilled contract value. Unbilled contract value is not reflected in our consolidated financial statements.

 

Platform subscription revenue also includes revenue from our mobile event apps and web survey products.

 

Marketing Solutions. Marketing solutions revenue is generated through the delivery of various forms of advertising sold through annual or multi-year contracts to marketers, principally hotels and venues. Such solutions include prominent display of a customer’s venue within the Cvent Supplier Network, the Cvent Destination Guide or in various electronic newsletters. Pricing for the advertisements is based on the term of the advertisement, targeted geography, number of advertisements and prominence of the ad placement.

 

We generally recognize the revenue from these marketing solutions over the period the advertisements are delivered. Customer contracts are typically not cancellable without cause and typically range in length from one to two years. We generally invoice our customers in advance in annual installments. Amounts that have been invoiced are initially recorded as deferred revenue and are recognized as revenue over the contract period. Contractual amounts that have not been invoiced, which we refer to as unbilled contract value, are not reflected in our consolidated financial statements.

 

47


Table of Contents

Cost of Revenue

 

Cost of revenue primarily consists of employee-related expenses, including salaries, benefits, bonuses and stock-based compensation, related to providing support and hosting our applications, costs of data center capacity, software license fees and amortization expense associated with capitalized software. In addition, we allocate a portion of overhead, such as rent, information technology costs, depreciation and amortization to cost of revenue based on head count.

 

We are invested in our customers’ success and as such, we will continue to invest in providing support and expanding our capacity to support our growth, which in the near-term will result in higher cost of revenue in absolute dollars and as a percentage of revenue.

 

Operating Expenses

 

Sales and Marketing

 

Sales and marketing expenses primarily consist of personnel and related expenses for our sales and marketing staff, including salaries, benefits, bonuses, commissions and stock-based compensation. Commissions are expensed when the customer contract is signed. In addition to staff costs, our cost of marketing includes product marketing and other brand-building activities, such as trade shows, product seminars and online marketing.

 

We intend to continue to invest in sales and marketing and expect spending in these areas to increase in the near-term in absolute dollars and as a percentage of revenue as we continue to expand our business both domestically and internationally. We expect sales and marketing expenses to continue to be among the most significant components of our operating expenses.

 

Research and Development

 

Research and development expenses consist primarily of personnel and related expenses for our research and development staff, including salaries, benefits, bonuses and stock-based compensation and the cost of certain third-party contractors. Research and development costs, other than software development expenses qualifying for capitalization, are expensed as incurred.

 

With the exception of our three 2012 acquisitions, we maintain a unified software code base for our entire platform, which we believe improves the efficiency of our research and development activities. Notwithstanding, we expect research and development expenses to increase in the near-term in absolute dollars and as a percentage of revenue as we add new functionality on the platform and expand our cloud-delivery infrastructure.

 

General and Administrative

 

General and administrative expenses consist primarily of personnel and related expenses for administrative, finance, legal and human resource staffs, including salaries, benefits, bonuses and stock-based compensation, as well as professional fees, insurance premiums, other corporate expenses, and overhead.

 

We expect our general and administrative expenses to increase in absolute dollars and as a percentage of revenue as we continue to expand our operations, hire additional personnel and transition from being a private company to a public company. In transitioning to a public company, we expect to incur additional expenses related to outside legal counsel, accounting and auditing activities, compliance with public company reporting and corporate governance requirements, increased insurance requirements and enhancing our internal control environment.

 

48


Table of Contents

Results of Operations

 

The following table sets forth selected consolidated statement of operations data for each of the periods indicated.

 

     Year ended December 31,      Nine months ended September 30,  
         2011             2012                  2012                      2013          
     (In thousands)  

Revenue

   $ 60,854      $ 83,474       $ 59,865       $ 80,440   

Costs of revenue

     16,660        20,573         14,648         21,588   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     44,194        62,901         45,217         58,852   

Operating expenses:

          

Sales and marketing

     29,305        35,873         25,748         35,202   

Research and development

     4,172        7,605         5,391         8,105   

General and administrative

     8,422        11,523         7,957         16,891   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     41,899        55,001         39,096         60,198   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     2,295        7,900         6,121         (1,346)   

Interest income

     270        811         670         677   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations before income tax expense

     2,565        8,711         6,791         (669)   

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

     2,749        4,406         4,007         2,136   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ (184   $ 4,305       $ 2,784       $ (2,805)   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

The following table sets forth our consolidated statement of operations data as a percentage of revenue for each of the periods indicated.

 

     Year ended December 31,     Nine months ended September 30,  
         2011             2012             2012             2013      

Revenue

     100     100     100     100

Costs of revenue

     27        25        24        27   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     73        75        76        73   

Operating expenses:

        

Sales and marketing

     48        43        43        44   

Research and development

     7        9        9        10   

General and administrative

     14        14        13        21   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     69        66        65        75   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     4        9        11        (2

Interest income

            1        1        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations before income tax expense

     4        10        12        (1

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

     4        5        7        3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     (0 )%      5     5     (4 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

49


Table of Contents

Comparison of Nine Months Ended September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

Revenue

 

     Nine months ended September 30,     Period-to-period  change  
     2012     2013    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Revenue by product:

               

Platform subscriptions

   $ 41,991         70   $ 56,039         70   $ 14,048         33

Marketing solutions

     17,874         30     24,401         30     6,527         37
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

Total revenue

   $ 59,865         100   $ 80,440         100   $ 20,575         34
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

Total revenue increased $20.6 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012, primarily driven by a $16.4 million increase in revenue from sales of features and functionality and new advertising products to new customers, partially offset by customers lost during the nine months ended September 30, 2013.

 

Platform subscription revenue increased $14.0 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 primarily due to a $12.3 million increase in revenue from sales of event planning subscriptions to new customers in 2013. Revenue from sales of additional features and functionality to existing customers, increased registrations and a full quarter of revenue for new 2012 customers contributed $6.7 million in platform subscription revenue during the nine months ended September 30, 2013. These amounts were partially offset by customers lost during the nine months ended September 30, 2013.

 

Marketing solutions revenue increased $6.5 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 primarily due to recognition of $4.1 million in revenue from sales to new 2013 customers. Revenue recognized from sales of additional marketing solutions and price increases contributed an additional $3.7 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013. These amounts were partially offset by customers lost during the nine months ended September 30, 2013.

 

Our year-over-year revenue growth was moderately affected by our acquisitions during 2012. We acquired CrowdTorch in January 2012, CrowdCompass in June 2012 and TicketMob in December 2012. Aggregate revenue from sales of CrowdTorch, and CrowdCompass and TicketMob products included in our consolidated results of operations were $6.9 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 as compared to $0.8 million in the nine months ended September 30, 2012.

 

We generate the majority of our revenue from North America with revenue from outside North America accounting for 10% of total revenue for each of the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013. We expect that the proportion of total revenue from outside of North America will grow in the future.

 

Cost of Revenue

 

     Nine months ended September 30,     Period-to-period  change  
     2012     2013    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Cost of revenue

   $ 14,648         24   $ 21,588         27   $ 6,940         47

 

50


Table of Contents

Cost of revenue increased by $6.9 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 compared to the corresponding period in 2012. The primary drivers of the increase were in customer service support costs of $1.8 million, an increase in technology maintenance expense of $2.5 million, and an increase of $1.3 million in amortization of capitalized software and acquired technology. An increase of $0.6 million in credit card processing fees further contributed to the overall increase in cost of revenue during the comparative periods.

 

Operating Expenses

 

     Nine months ended September 30,     Period-to-period  change  
     2012     2013    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Operating expenses:

               

Sales and marketing

   $ 25,748         43   $ 35,202         44   $ 9,454         37

Research and development

     5,391         9   $ 8,105         10   $ 2,714         50

General and administrative

     7,957         13     16,891         21     8,934         112
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

Total operating expenses

   $ 39,096         65   $ 60,198         75   $ 21,102         54
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

Sales and Marketing

 

Sales and marketing expenses increased by $9.5 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 over the corresponding period in 2012. The increase is primarily due to increased head count and expansion of our marketing efforts. Total head count of our sales and marketing personnel increased by 27% from September 30, 2012 to September 30, 2013, to support revenue growth and new product lines. This increase contributed $5.5 million of additional expenses in the nine months ended September 30, 2013, and an associated increase of $1.4 million of overhead expense. Costs related to expanded marketing efforts contributed to an additional $2.6 million to the period-over-period difference.

 

Research and Development

 

Research and development expenses increased by $2.7 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 over the corresponding period in 2012. The increase is primarily due to increased head count within our software development group and to integrate new product lines. Total head count within research and development increased by 49% from September 30, 2012 to September 30, 2013.

 

General and Administrative

 

General and administrative expenses increased by $8.9 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 over the corresponding period in 2012. This increase is primarily due to increased head count for administrative operations, particularly related to increased personnel necessary to operate as a public company upon the closing of the IPO. Total head count of our general and administrative operations increased by 49% from September 30, 2012 to September 30, 2013, which contributed $3.9 million of increased personnel and related expenses in the nine months ended September 30, 2013. Additionally, professional services fees including legal, tax, and audit fees primarily associated with operating as a public company contributed an additional $1.4 million, expenses associated with increased indirect taxes based on an expanded presence added $0.3 million, and increased expenses associated with foreign currency re-measurement of our India operations added $2.0 million in period-over-period expense, with the remaining increase due to various overhead costs.

 

51


Table of Contents

Interest Income

 

     Nine months ended September 30,     Period-to-period  change  
     2012     2013    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Interest income

   $ 670         1   $ 677         1   $ 7         1

 

Interest income increased slightly for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 as compared to the nine months ended September 30, 2012 due to higher interest rates partially offset by fluctuations in foreign exchange rates in India for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 as compared to the nine months ended September 30, 2012.

 

Provision for Income Taxes

 

     Nine months ended September 30,     Period-to-period  change  
     2012     2013    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount         Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Provision for income taxes

   $ 4,007         7   $ 2,136         3   $ (1,871     (47 %) 

 

Income tax expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 decreased compared to the nine months ended September 30, 2012. The decrease is primarily due to the significant reduction in pre-tax book results achieved year to date in comparison to prior year results, resulting in a loss from operations before income tax expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2013, compared to income from operations before income tax expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2012. The fluctuations in pre-tax book results were offset by the significant impact of stock compensation expense in relation to pre-tax book income (loss).

 

Comparison of Years Ended December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

Revenue

 

     Year ended December 31,     Period-to-period  change  
     2011     2012    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Revenue by product:

               

Platform subscriptions

   $ 44,379         73   $ 58,733         70   $ 14,354         32

Marketing solutions

     16,475         27     24,741         30     8,266         50
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

Total revenue

   $ 60,854         100   $ 83,474         100   $ 22,620         37
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

Total revenue increased during the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the prior year primarily driven by a $13.5 million increase in revenue from sales of products to new customers.

 

Platform subscription revenue increased during the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the prior year primarily due to an $8.8 million increase in revenue from sales of event planning subscriptions to new customers in 2012. Revenue from sales of additional products to existing customers, increased registration usage and a full year of revenue for new 2011 customers contributed $9.2 million in platform subscription revenue during the year ended December 31, 2012. These amounts were partially offset by customers lost during the year ended December 31, 2012.

 

52


Table of Contents

Marketing solutions revenue increased during the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the prior year primarily due to recognition of revenue from additional marketing solutions, price increases and recognition of a full year of revenue for new 2011 customers of $5.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2012. Sales of marketing solutions to new 2012 customers contributed an additional $4.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2012. These amounts were partially offset by customers lost during the year ended December 31, 2012.

 

Our year-over-year revenue growth was moderately affected by our acquisitions during the year ended December 31, 2012. We acquired CrowdTorch in January 2012 and CrowdCompass in June 2012. Aggregate revenue from sales of CrowdTorch and CrowdCompass products included in our consolidated results of operations were $1.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2012. Since we acquired TicketMob upon the close of business on December 31, 2012, we did not recognize revenue in the year ended December 31, 2012 related to that product line.

 

We generate the majority of our revenue from North America with revenue from outside North America accounting for 7% and 9% of total revenue for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively. We expect that the proportion of total revenue from outside of North America will continue to grow in the future.

 

Cost of Revenue

 

     Year ended December 31,     Period-to-period  change  
     2011     2012    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Cost of revenue

   $ 16,660         27   $ 20,573         25   $ 3,913         23

 

Cost of revenue increased during the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to the prior year primarily due to an increase in amortization of capitalized software and acquired technology of $1.2 million. Increases in technology costs of $1.8 million, customer service costs of $0.5 million and a $0.5 million increase in overhead further contributed to the increase.

 

Operating Expenses

 

     Year ended December 31,     Period-to-period  change  
     2011     2012    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Operating expenses:

               

Sales and marketing

   $ 29,305         48   $ 35,873         43   $ 6,568         22

Research and development

     4,172         7     7,605         9     3,433         82

General and administrative

     8,422         14     11,523         14     3,101         37
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

Total operating expenses

   $ 41,899         69   $ 55,001         66   $ 13,102         31
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

Sales and Marketing

 

Sales and marketing expenses increased primarily due to increased head count and expansion of our marketing efforts. Total head count of our sales and marketing personnel increased by 38% from December 31, 2011 to December 31, 2012, to support revenue growth and new product lines. This increase contributed $3.6 million of additional expenses in 2012. Costs related to expanded marketing efforts contributed an

 

53


Table of Contents

additional $1.7 million to the year-over-year difference. Finally, sales and marketing-related stock-based compensation increased by $0.5 million due to greater head count and the increase in the grant date fair value of our common stock underlying options granted in the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the prior year.

 

Research and Development

 

Research and development expenses increased primarily due to increased head count within our software development group as we continue to add features and functionality to our platform and integrate new product lines. Total head count within research and development increased by 45% from December 31, 2011 to December 31, 2012, which increased personnel and related expenses in 2012 by $2.7 million. Finally, research and development-related stock-based compensation increased by $0.2 million due to greater head count and the increase in the grant date fair value of our common stock underlying options granted in the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the prior year.

 

General and Administrative

 

General and administrative expenses increased primarily due to increased head count for administrative operations, particularly related to increased preparation in 2012 for our IPO and becoming a public company. Total head count of our general and administrative operations increased by 75% from December 31, 2011 to December 31, 2012, which contributed $1.8 million of increased personnel and related expenses in 2012 and $0.7 million in legal fees primarily associated with acquisitions. Finally, general and administrative-related stock-based compensation increased by $0.5 million due to greater head count and the increase in the grant date fair value of our common stock underlying options granted in the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the prior year.

 

Interest Income

 

     Year ended December 31,     Period-to-period change  
     2011     2012    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Interest income

   $ 270           $ 811         1   $ 541         200

 

Interest income increased for the year ended December 31, 2012 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2011 due to higher interest rates, comparatively longer deposit periods, and the increased cash and cash equivalents balances we held throughout the year ended December 31, 2012 in India as compared to the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

Provision for Income Taxes

 

     Year ended December 31,     Period-to-period change  
     2011     2012    
     Amount      Percentage
of revenue
    Amount      Percentage
of revenue
      Amount          Percentage    
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Provision for income taxes

   $ 2,749         4   $ 4,406         5   $ 1,657         60

 

Income tax expense for the year ended December 31, 2012 increased $1.7 million, or 60%, compared to the year ended December 31, 2011. The increase principally resulted from an increase in pre-tax book income from 2011 to 2012, an increase in non-deductible stock-based compensation expense offset by a lower foreign currency remeasurement loss and the inclusion of a research and development credit in 2012.

 

54


Table of Contents

Quarterly Results of Operations

 

The following tables set forth selected unaudited quarterly consolidated statement of operations data for each of the quarters indicated as well as the percentage of total revenue for each line item shown. The unaudited consolidated financial statements for each of these quarters have been derived from and prepared on the same basis as the audited consolidated financial statements included in this prospectus and, in the opinion of management, include all adjustments necessary for the fair presentation of the consolidated results of operations for these periods. You should read this information together with our audited consolidated financial statements, interim unaudited consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. These quarterly operating results are not necessarily indicative of the results for any future period.

 

    Sept.  30,
2011
    Dec.  31,
2011
    Mar.  31,
2012
    Jun.  30,
2012
    Sept.  30,
2012
    Dec.  31,
2012
    Mar.  31,
2013
    Jun.  30,
2013
    Sept.  30,
2013
 
    (in thousands)  

Revenue

  $ 15,620      $ 17,301      $ 18,250      $ 19,779      $ 21,836      $ 23,609      $ 24,360      $ 26,935      $ 29,145   

Cost of revenue

    4,415        4,663        4,625        4,628        5,395        5,925        6,003        7,172        8,412   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

    11,205        12,638        13,625        15,151        16,441        17,684        18,357        19,763        20,733   

Operating expenses:

                 

Sales and marketing

    7,877        8,022        8,136        8,420        9,192        10,125        11,519        12,131        11,552   

Research and development

    955        1,366        1,423        1,886        2,082        2,214        2,502        2,789        2,813   

General and administrative

    2,541        2,868        2,135        3,553        2,269        3,566        4,647        6,154        6,092   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    11,373        12,256        11,694        13,859        13,543        15,905        18,668        21,074        20,457   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

    (168     382        1,931        1,292        2,898        1,779        (311     (1,311     276   

Interest income

    43        169        268        203        199        141        259        123        295   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations before income tax expense

    (125     551        2,199        1,495        3,097        1,920        (52     (1,188     571   

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

    (148     367        1,329        982        1,696        399        (362     1,099        1,400   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ 23      $ 184      $ 870      $ 513      $ 1,401      $ 1,521      $ 310      $ (2,287   $ (829
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

    Sept.  30,
2011
    Dec.  31,
2011
    Mar.  31,
2012
    Jun.  30,
2012
    Sept.  30,
2012
    Dec.  31,
2012
    Mar.  31,
2013
    Jun.  30,
2013
    Sept. 30,
2013
 
    (as a percentage of revenue)  

Revenue

    100     100     100     100     100     100     100     100     100

Cost of revenue

    28        27        25        23        25        25        25        27        29   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

    72        73        75        77        75        75        75        73        71   

Operating expenses:

                 

Sales and marketing

    51        46        44        43        42        43        47        45        40   

Research and development

    6        8        8        10        10        9        10        10        10   

General and administrative

    16        17        12        18        10        15        19        23        20   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

    73        71        64        71        62        67        76        78        70   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

    (1     2        11        6        13        8        (1     (5     1   

Interest income

    0        1        1        1        1        0        1        0        1   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations before income tax expense

    (1     3        12        7        14        8        0        (5     2   

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

    (1     2        7        5        8        2        (1     4        5   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

    0     1     5     2     6     6     1     (9 )%      (3 )% 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

Quarterly Trends and Seasonality

 

Our overall operating results fluctuate from quarter to quarter as a result of a variety of factors, some of which are outside our control. We have experienced rapid growth in recent years, as well as other major corporate developments. For instance, since the beginning of 2011, we completed the first major venture capital investment in our business since 2001, repurchased a substantial number of shares from existing investors, entered into new international markets, made three acquisitions, substantially increased our customer and user bases and completed our initial public offering in August 2013. These changes have resulted in substantial

 

55


Table of Contents

growth in our revenue and corresponding increases in operating expenses to support our growth. Our growth has led to uneven overall operating results due to changes in our investment in sales and marketing and technology and development from quarter to quarter. Our historical results should not be considered a reliable indicator of our future results of operations.

 

Our quarterly revenue has increased from $15.6 million in the quarter ended September 30, 2011 to $29.1 million in the quarter ended September 30, 2013. Our increase in quarterly revenue was mainly due to increased headcount and increased sales efforts resulting in additional customers and new contracts, as well as high renewals of existing contracts. Additionally, the Company’s acquisitions during 2012 provided increased revenue.

 

In the third quarter of 2011, we received an investment of $135.0 million from venture capital investors, and we subsequently repurchased shares of our outstanding common stock for $135.5 million. Separately, we also made substantial investments in our technology and operations. On August 14, 2013, we closed our IPO in which we sold and issued 6,440,000 shares of common stock resulting in net proceeds of approximately $122.1 million.

 

Our revenue also tends to be seasonal in nature, with the first and fourth quarters of each calendar year historically representing the largest percentage of our total revenue for the year. Many event and meeting planners make new purchasing decisions at the start of the calendar year when budget planning takes place. Many advertisers spend the largest portion of their advertising budgets during the fourth quarter, in preparation for the holiday season. However, since the majority of our revenue is deferred over the life of a multi-year subscription or advertising contract, the seasonality of the sales cycle is somewhat less pronounced in our revenue results.

 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

 

Sources of Liquidity

 

To date, we have financed our operations primarily through private placements, our initial public offering of capital stock, and cash from operating activities. On August 14, 2013, we closed our IPO in which we sold and issued 6,440,000 shares of common stock resulting in net proceeds to us of approximately $122.1 million after underwriters’ discounts and commissions and offering-related expenses.

 

Throughout the year ended December 31, 2011 until March 20, 2012, we maintained a bank line of credit of $2.0 million. We did not draw on our line of credit during either of the years ended December 31, 2011 or 2012, and the line of credit was closed on March 31, 2012.

 

Working Capital and Cash Flows

 

As of September 30, 2013, we had $144.5 million of cash and cash equivalents, excluding $0.7 million of restricted cash and $13.3 million of short-term investments, and net working capital of $113.6 million. The following table summarizes our cash flows for the periods indicated:

 

     For the year ended
December 31,
    Nine months ended
September 30,
 
           2011                 2012                 2012                 2013        
     (In thousands)  

Net cash provided by (used in):

        

Operating activities

   $ 14,610      $ 23,581      $ 25,748      $ 18,898   

Investing activities

     (11,667     (22,019     (12,324     (12,014

Financing activities

     (1,976     (2,862     (2,817     121,358   

 

Our cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments at September 30, 2013 were held for working capital purposes. We do not enter into investments for trading or speculative purposes. Our policy is to invest any cash

 

56


Table of Contents

in excess of our immediate requirements in investments designed to preserve the principal balance and maintain liquidity. Accordingly, our cash and cash equivalents and short-term investments are invested primarily in demand deposit accounts, certificates of deposit and money market funds that are currently providing only a minimal return.

 

As of September 30, 2013, $5.8 million of our total cash and cash equivalents were held in India and $0.8 million were held in the United Kingdom. Our short-term investments of $13.3 million were held in India. These balances are available for general corporate purposes.

 

Operating Activities

 

Net cash provided by operating activities is significantly influenced by the amount of cash we invest in personnel and infrastructure to support the anticipated growth of our business, the increase in the number of customers, recurring dollar retention rates and the amount and timing of customer payments. Cash provided by operations in the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 is primarily attributable to net income (loss) and the change in accounts receivable, both of which are driven by an increasing customer base and increased sales of our platform subscriptions and marketing services. Our cash flows from operating activities are generally reflective of our ability to invoice annual subscription fees upfront with net 30 payment terms. Our days sales outstanding, or DSO, is a primary driver in cash flows from operating activities for a given period. We experience seasonality in our accounts receivable. The first and fourth quarters historically include a higher level of cash collections, which is a result of higher levels of invoicing in the fourth quarter. Additionally, we generally invoice our large hotel customers of the Cvent Supplier Network in the fourth quarter, as a result generating higher accounts receivable at year-end and subsequently higher cash collections during the first quarter of the following year. We calculate our DSO on a twelve-month rolling basis using billings for the period divided by accounts receivable and adjusted for the number of days in the period.

 

Net cash provided by operating activities was $18.9 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2013, which was driven by the net loss during the period, with offsets totaling $10.0 million for depreciation and amortization and stock-based compensation. Also contributing to net cash provided by operating activities was a decrease in the accounts receivable. This change contributed $13.6 million during the period and was consistent with our historical cash collection cycle. These decreases were offset by increases in prepaid expenses of $4.7 million and deferred revenue of $2.8 million during the period. Our DSO as of September 30, 2013 was 42.

 

Net cash provided by operating activities was $25.7 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2012, which was driven by net income during the period, with adjustments totaling $7.7 million for depreciation and amortization and stock-based compensation. Also contributing to net cash provided by operating activities was a decrease in the accounts receivable. This change contributed $6.7 million during the period and was consistent with our historical cash collection cycle. The increase in our accounts payable contributed an additional $10.7 million of cash during the period, consistent with the growth of our business. These increases were partially offset by decreases in cash from prepaid expenses of $1.2 million and deferred revenue of $0.9 million. Our DSO as of September 30, 2012 was 42.

 

Net cash provided by operating activities was $23.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2012, which was primarily driven by net income, as adjusted for depreciation and amortization and stock-based compensation, which combined contributed $15.0 million to cash from operating activities. Changes in our deferred revenue contributed an additional $13.6 million during the period, which reflected the growth of our business and our practice of invoicing for subscriptions annually at the beginning of the subscription period. Additionally, changes in our accounts payable contributed $4.5 million during the period, reflecting the growth of our business. This amount was partially offset by a $9.6 million increase in accounts receivable during the period, which also grew largely due to the increased scale of our business. Our DSO as of December 31, 2012 was 43, which was generally consistent with our DSO as of December 31, 2011.

 

57


Table of Contents

Net cash provided by operating activities was $14.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, which was primarily driven by changes in our deferred revenue of $7.9 million during the period, which reflected the continued growth of our business and our practice of invoicing for subscriptions annually at the beginning of the subscription period. Additionally, changes in our accounts payable contributed $3.4 million during the period, reflecting the growth of our business. This amount was partially offset by a $3.4 million increase in accounts receivable during the period and the $1.4 million increase in prepaids and other assets, which also grew largely due to the increased scale of our business. Net loss, as adjusted for depreciation and amortization and stock-based compensation, contributed an additional $7.7 million to cash from operating activities. Our DSO as of December 31, 2011 was 41.

 

Investing Activities

 

Our investing activities have consisted primarily of purchases of equipment and software developed for internal use, and short-term investments, as well as business acquisitions in 2012. We expect our capital expenditures and our investment activity to continue to increase as our business grows.

 

Net cash used in investing activities was $12.0 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2013. The use of cash was the result of the purchase of $4.0 million of short term investments during the period. Additionally our investment in property and equipment totaled $7.8 million, including software developed for internal use to accommodate the growth of our business.

 

Net cash used in investing activities was $12.3 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2012. The amount consisted of investments in property and equipment of $6.0 million, including software developed for internal use to accommodate the growth of our business, cash payments of $7.2 million related to two acquisitions in the period, and partially offset by sales, net of purchases, of short-term investments of $1.4 million.

 

Net cash used in investing activities was $22.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The amount consisted primarily of $12.5 million of cash consideration paid, net of cash received, for acquisitions of Seed Labs LLC (now known as CrowdTorch), CrowdCompass Inc. and TicketMob LLC. In addition, we made investments in property and equipment of $8.1 million, including software developed for internal use to accommodate the growth of our business.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2011, net cash used in investing activities was $11.7 million. This amount was the result of our $2.7 million in investments in property and equipment to accommodate the growth of our business and $2.7 million in software developed for internal use. We also purchased of $6.3 million, net, of short-term investments during the period.

 

Financing Activities

 

For the nine months ended September 30, 2013 net cash from financing activities provided $121.4 million in cash during the period. The primary reason for the increase was $122.1 million in net proceeds provided in connection with the closing of our IPO. We also received $0.5 million in cash from the exercises of stock options and repurchased non-employee warrants for $1.3 million.

 

For the nine months ended September 30, 2012 we received $1.1 million from the exercise of stock options and repurchased shares from a former employee pursuant to the exercise of a call option using $4.0 million in cash.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2012, net cash used in financing activities was $2.9 million, consisting primarily of $4.0 million used to repurchase restricted common stock from a former employee for which we held a right of repurchase that had not lapsed at the time of termination of employment. This was offset by proceeds received from option and warrant exercises of $1.1 million.

 

58


Table of Contents

For the year ended December 31, 2011, net cash used in financing activities was $2.0 million, nearly all of which related to a financing and related repurchase of existing shares of our common stock. In July 2011, the affiliated funds of three venture capital investment firms purchased shares of our Series A Preferred Stock for a total purchase price of $135.9 million. We incurred net costs for that transaction of $0.8 million. Also during July 2011, we repurchased shares of our outstanding common stock for a total price of $135.5 million. Finally, earlier in 2011, we redeemed certain of our then-outstanding Series B-1 and Series B-2 Preferred Stock for a total of $1.5 million.

 

The net proceeds of this offering will be classified as cash received from financing activities. In addition, if and to the extent that employees exercise additional stock options either in connection with or following this offering, the proceeds of those exercises would be classified as cash from financing activities.

 

Contractual Obligations

 

Set forth in the following table is information concerning our known contractual obligations as of December 31, 2012 that are fixed and determinable.

 

Contractual Obligations

   Payment due by period  
   Total      Less than 1
Year
     1-3 years      3-5 years      More than 5
years
 
     (in thousands)  

Operating lease obligations(1)

   $ 5,770       $ 3,377       $ 2,103       $ 257       $ 33   

Minimum purchase commitments

     250         250                           
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 6,020       $ 3,627       $ 2,103       $ 257       $ 33   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)   We lease our office facilities in Virginia, Texas, California, Oregon and India under operating leases that are scheduled to expire at various times through 2018.

 

In addition, as of December 31, 2012, the Company had contingent payments that may become due in connection with the acquisitions of Seed Labs LLC, CrowdCompass, Inc. and TicketMob LLC that are described in the section titled “Acquisitions.”

 

In April 2013, the Company signed two new office leases in India that will replace the existing leases when they expire. Please refer to Note 14 in the notes to the consolidated financial statements on page F-32 for further details.

 

In October 2013, the Company signed a new lease for office space in McLean, VA that will replace the existing lease for the Company’s corporate headquarters when it expires in 2014. Please refer to Note 9 in the notes to the unaudited consolidated financial statements on page F-47 for further details.

 

Unbilled Contract Value

 

We have typically entered into annual and multiple-year subscription contracts for our software solutions and our marketing solutions. For multiple-year agreements, we typically invoice the amount for the first year of the contract at signing followed by subsequent annual invoices at the anniversary of each year. Since we bill most of our customers at the beginning of each contract year, there can be amounts that we have not yet been contractually able to invoice. Until such time as these amounts are invoiced, they are not recorded in revenue, deferred revenue or elsewhere in our consolidated financial statements, and are considered by us to be unbilled contract value. As of December 31, 2012 and September 30, 2013, our deferred revenue was $51.6 million and $48.8 million, respectively, which amount does not include unbilled contract value for subscriptions and marketing solution contracts not yet billed of approximately $62.0 million and $72.9 million, respectively. We expect that the amount of unbilled contract value relative to the total value of our contracts will change from year

 

59


Table of Contents

to year for several reasons, including the amount of cash collected early in the contract term, the specific timing and duration of customer agreements, varying invoicing cycles of agreements, the specific timing of customer renewal, changes in customer financial circumstances and foreign currency fluctuations.

 

Customer Retention

 

We believe that our ability to retain our customers and expand their use of our platform over time is an indicator of the stability of our revenue base and the long-term value of our customer relationships. We assess our performance in this area using a metric we refer to as our recurring dollar retention rate. Our recurring dollar retention rate for our platform subscriptions averaged 89% for the four quarters of 2010, 93% for the four quarters of 2011 and 97% for the four quarters of 2012. Our recurring dollar retention rate for our marketing solutions averaged 114% for the four quarters of 2011 and 115% for the four quarters of 2012. Our recurring dollar retention rate for our marketing solutions in 2010 is not a meaningful metric as we did not begin to generate revenue for our marketing solutions until midway through 2009 and, therefore, had a materially smaller population of 2009 customers against which to measure recurring dollar retention rate. We calculate our recurring dollar retention rate by dividing (a) Retained Revenue by (b) Retention Base Revenue. We define Retention Base Revenue as recurring revenue by product from all customers in the prior period; and Retained Revenue as recurring revenue by product from the same group of customers in the current period, including any additional sales to those customers during the current period. We do not include non-renewable revenue such as overage fees for registrations and other miscellaneous services in this calculation. Such non-renewable revenue represented 6%, 5% and 5% of our total revenue in each of the years ended December 31, 2010, 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

Acquisitions

 

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we acquired three separate businesses, which were neither individually or collectively significant to our financial position and result of operations as of and for the year ended December 31, 2012.

 

In January 2012, in order to enter the mobile event application space, we acquired all of the outstanding unit interests in Seed Labs LLC in exchange for $1.4 million in cash, net, and 116,925 shares of our common stock valued at $0.9 million at the time of the acquisition. In addition, the sellers are entitled to earn up to an additional $2.1 million in part based upon the achievement of certain sales-based targets and the continued employment of certain key employees of Seed Labs LLC, which will be recognized as compensation expense when earned. As of September 30, 2013, we have paid approximately $280,000 of these additional payments to certain key employees. For financial reporting purposes, we allocated $2.4 million to the assets acquired and goodwill of Seed Labs LLC. We subsequently rebranded Seed Labs as our CrowdTorch mobile application functionality.

 

In June 2012, in order to expand our mobile event applications offerings, we acquired all of the outstanding capital stock in CrowdCompass, Inc. in exchange for $5.8 million in cash, net. In addition, the sellers are entitled to earn up to an additional $3.8 million based upon the continued employment of certain key employees of CrowdCompass, Inc, which will be recognized as compensation expense when earned. As of September 30, 2013, we have paid approximately $1.4 million of these additional payments to certain key employees. For financial reporting purposes, we allocated $6.0 million to the assets acquired, liabilities assumed and goodwill of CrowdCompass, Inc.

 

In December 2012, in order to expand our consumer-facing event ticketing and registration offerings, we acquired all of the outstanding unit interests in TicketMob LLC in exchange for $5.2 million in cash, net. In addition, the sellers are entitled to earn up to an additional $14.6 million in part based upon the achievement of certain revenue-based targets and the continued employment of certain key employees of TicketMob LLC, which will be recognized as compensation when earned. As of September 30, 2013, no amounts have been earned or paid under these agreements. For financial reporting purposes, we allocated $5.9 million to the assets acquired, liabilities assumed and goodwill of TicketMob LLC.

 

60


Table of Contents

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

 

As of September 30, 2013, we did not have any off-balance sheet arrangements, as defined in Item 303(a)(4)(ii) of SEC Regulation S-K, such as the use of unconsolidated subsidiaries, structured finance, special purpose entities or variable interest entities.

 

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

 

Our financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus are prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States. The preparation of these financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenue, cost of revenue, operating expenses, other income and expenses, provision for income taxes and related disclosures. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances. Changes in accounting estimates are reasonably likely to occur from period to period. Accordingly, actual results could differ significantly from our estimates. We evaluate our estimates and assumptions on an ongoing basis. To the extent that there are material differences between our estimates and our actual results, our future financial statement presentation, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows will be affected.

 

We believe the assumptions and estimates associated with the following accounting policies have the greatest potential impact on our consolidated financial statements.

 

Revenue Recognition and Deferred Revenue

 

We derive our revenue from two primary sources: platform subscription-based and marketing solutions. These services are generally provided under annual and multi-year contracts and revenue is generally recognized on a straight-line basis over the life of the contract. We recognize revenue when all of the following conditions are met:

 

  (i)   persuasive evidence exists of an arrangement with the customer reflecting the terms and conditions under which the products or services will be provided;

 

  (ii)   delivery to customers has occurred or services have been rendered;

 

  (iii)   the fee is fixed or determinable; and

 

  (iv)   collection of the fees is reasonably assured.

 

We consider a signed agreement or other similar documentation to be persuasive evidence of an arrangement. Collectability is assessed based on a number of factors, including transaction history and the creditworthiness of a customer. If it is determined that collection is not reasonably assured, revenue is not recognized until collection becomes reasonably assured, which is generally upon receipt of cash.

 

Platform Subscription Revenue

 

We generate the majority of our revenue through software-as-a-service, or SaaS, subscriptions to our event management platform, pricing for which is subject to the features and functionality selected. No features or functionality within the subscription-based services have stand alone value from one another and, therefore, the entire subscription fee is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the subscription arrangement.

 

Our SaaS subscriptions may include functionality that enables customers to manage the registration of participants attending the customer’s event or events. In some cases, the negotiated fee for the subscription is based on a maximum number of event registrations permitted over the subscription term. At any time during the subscription term, customers may elect to purchase blocks of additional registrations which are referred to as up-sells. The fees associated with the up-sells are added to the original subscription fee and the revenue is recognized over the remaining subscription period. In other more limited cases, a customer may purchase additional registrations on a pay-as-you-go basis which are referred to as overages. The revenue for overages is

 

61


Table of Contents

recognized as each additional registration is used by the customer. No portion of the subscription fee is refundable regardless of the actual number of registrations that occur. Other subscription-based solutions include the sale of mobile event apps as well as survey solutions, both of which are contracted through annual or multi-year agreements.

 

Our subscription agreements do not provide customers with the right to take possession of the underlying software at any time.

 

Marketing Solutions

 

Marketing solutions revenue is generated through the delivery of various forms of advertising sold through annual or multi-year advertising contracts. Such solutions include prominent display of a customer’s venue within the Cvent Supplier Network, the Cvent Destination Guide or in various electronic newsletters. Pricing for the advertisements is based on the targeted geography, number of advertisements and prominence of the ad placement.

 

We enter into arrangements with multiple deliverables that generally include various marketing solutions that may be sold individually or bundled together and delivered over various periods of time. In such situations, we apply the provisions of Financial Accounting Standards Board, or FASB, Accounting Standards Codification, or ASC, No. 605-25, Revenue Recognition—Multiple Element Arrangements to account for the various elements within the marketing solution agreements delivered over the platform. Under such guidance, in order to treat deliverables in a multiple-deliverable arrangement as separate units of accounting, the deliverables must have stand-alone value upon delivery. If the deliverables have stand-alone value upon delivery, we account for each deliverable separately and revenue is recognized ratably over the contractual period that the related advertising deliverable is provided. Annual marketing solutions on the Cvent Supplier Network are often sold separately, and, as such, all have stand-alone value.

 

Some one-time marketing solutions, which can run for a month, several months, or a year, are primarily sold in a package. In determining whether the marketing solutions sold in packages have stand-alone value, we consider the availability of the services from other vendors, the nature of the solutions, and the contractual dependence of the solutions to the rest of the package. We have concluded that all of the marketing solutions in the packages included in multiple-deliverable arrangements executed have stand-alone value.

 

Revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables are divided into separate units of accounting and the arrangement consideration is allocated to all deliverables based on the relative selling price method. In such circumstances, we use the selling price hierarchy of: (i) vendor specific objective evidence of fair value, or VSOE, if available, (ii) third-party evidence of selling price, or TPE, and (iii) best estimate of selling price. VSOE is limited to the price charged when the same element is sold separately by us. Due to the unique nature of some multiple deliverable revenue arrangements, we may not be able to establish selling prices based on historical stand-alone sales using VSOE or TPE; therefore we may use our best estimate to establish selling prices for these arrangements. We establish the best estimates within a range of selling prices considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, factors such as size of transaction, customer demand and price lists.

 

Deferred Revenue

 

Deferred revenue consists of billings or payments received in advance of revenue recognition from our platform subscription services or marketing solutions that are subsequently recognized when the revenue recognition criteria are met. We generally invoice our customers in advance in annual or quarterly installments.

 

Business Combinations

 

We are required to allocate the purchase price of acquired companies to the identifiable tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date based upon their estimated fair values.

 

62


Table of Contents

Goodwill as of the acquisition date represents the excess of the purchase consideration of an acquired business over the fair value of the underlying net tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed. This allocation and valuation require management to make significant estimates and assumptions, especially with respect to long-lived and intangible assets.

 

Critical estimates in valuing intangible assets include but are not limited to estimates about: future expected cash flows from customer contracts, customer lists, distribution agreements, proprietary technology and non-competition agreements; the acquired company’s brand awareness and market position, assumptions about the period of time the brand will continue to be used in our product portfolio; as well as expected costs to develop the in-process research and development into commercially viable products and estimated cash flows from the projects when completed, and discount rates. Our estimates of fair value are based upon assumptions we believe to be reasonable, but which are inherently uncertain and unpredictable. Assumptions may be incomplete or inaccurate, and unanticipated events and circumstances may occur.

 

In addition, uncertain tax positions and tax-related valuation allowances assumed in connection with a business combination are initially estimated as of the acquisition date. We continue to evaluate these items quarterly and record any adjustments to the preliminary estimates to goodwill provided that we are within the measurement period. Subsequent to the measurement period, changes to these uncertain tax positions and tax related valuation allowances will affect our provision for income taxes in the consolidated statements of operations.

 

Other estimates associated with the accounting for these acquisitions may change as additional information becomes available regarding the assets acquired and liabilities assumed.

 

Goodwill

 

Goodwill represents the excess of: (i) the aggregate of the fair value of consideration transferred in a business combination, over (ii) the fair value of assets acquired, net of liabilities assumed. Goodwill is not amortized, but is subject to annual impairment tests. Goodwill is reviewed for impairment at least annually and is tested at the reporting unit level using a two-step approach. Under the first step, the fair value of the reporting unit is compared with its carrying value (including goodwill). If the fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying value, an indication of goodwill impairment exists for the reporting unit and step two is required to measure the amount of the impairment, if any. Under step two, an impairment loss is recognized for any excess of the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s goodwill over the implied fair value of that goodwill. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined by allocating the fair value of the reporting unit in a manner similar to a purchase price allocation and the residual fair value after this allocation is the implied fair value of the reporting unit goodwill. Fair value of the reporting unit is determined using a discounted cash flow analysis. If the carrying value of goodwill exceeds the implied fair value, an impairment charge would be recorded to operating expenses in the period the determination is made. If the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying value, step two does not need to be performed.

 

We perform our annual impairment review of goodwill on November 30 and when a triggering event occurs between annual impairment tests.

 

Stock-Based Compensation

 

We account for stock-based compensation in accordance with the authoritative guidance on stock compensation. Under the fair value recognition provisions of this guidance, stock-based compensation is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is recognized as expense using the straight-line attribution method over the requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period of the respective award, net of estimated forfeitures. The estimated forfeitures are based on historical employee turnover rates and expectations for future turnover.

 

63


Table of Contents

Determining the fair value of stock-based awards at the grant date requires judgment. We use the Black-Scholes option-pricing model to determine the fair value of stock options. The determination of the grant date fair value of options using an option-pricing model is affected by our common stock fair value, which was estimated without the benefit of a public market for our common stock prior to our initial public offering in August 2013, as well as assumptions regarding a number of other complex and subjective variables. These variables include the fair value of our common stock, the expected term of the options, our expected stock price volatility, risk-free interest rates, and expected dividends, which are estimated as follows:

 

   

Fair value of our common stock. Because our stock is not publicly traded, we must estimate the fair value of common stock, as discussed in “—Common Stock Valuations.”

 

   

Expected term. The expected term represents the period that our stock-based awards are expected to be outstanding. As we do not have sufficient historical experience for determining the expected term of the stock option awards granted, we have based our expected term on the simplified method available under GAAP.

 

   

Expected volatility. As we do not have a trading history for our common stock, the expected stock price volatility for our common stock was estimated by taking the average historic price volatility for industry peers (which includes several of the same comparable companies as used in our various valuation estimates) based on daily price observations over a period equivalent to the expected term of the stock option grants. We did not rely on implied volatilities of traded options in our industry peers’ common stock because the volume of activity was relatively low. We intend to continue to consistently apply this process using the same or similar public companies until a sufficient amount of historical information regarding the volatility of our own common stock share price becomes available.

 

   

Risk-free rate. The risk-free interest rate is based on the yields of U.S. Treasury securities with maturities similar to the expected term of the options for each option group.

 

   

Dividend yield. We have never declared or paid any cash dividends and do not presently plan to pay cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Consequently, we used an expected dividend yield of zero.

 

If any of the assumptions used in the Black-Scholes model changes significantly, stock-based compensation for future awards may differ materially compared with the awards granted previously.

 

The following table presents the weighted-average assumptions used to estimate the fair value of options granted during each of the periods indicated below:

 

     Year ended December 31,     Nine months ended September 30,  
       2011         2012           2012             2013      

Dividend yield

     0.00     0.00     0.00     0.00

Expected volatility

     54.0     54.3     54.36     53.86

Expected term (in years)

     6.38        6.49        6.47        6.43   

Risk-free rate

     2.47     0.97     0.97     1.37

 

As of September 30, 2013, we had $6.8 million of unrecognized stock-based compensation expense, net of estimated forfeitures, that is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 2.34 years.

 

Pre-IPO Common Stock Valuations

 

Prior to our initial public offering in August 2013, we were a private company with no active public market for our common stock. During that period, the fair value of the common stock underlying our stock options was determined by our board of directors, which intended all options granted to be exercisable at a price per share not less than the per share fair value of our common stock underlying those options on the date of grant. The valuations of our common stock were determined in accordance with the guidelines outlined in the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Practice Aid, Valuation of Privately-Held-Company Equity Securities

 

64


Table of Contents

Issued as Compensation and Internal Revenue Service Revenue Ruling 59-60. The assumptions we used in the valuation model were based on future expectations combined with management judgment. In the absence of a public trading market, our board of directors with input from management exercised significant judgment and considered numerous objective and subjective factors to determine the fair value of our common stock as of the date of each option grant, including the following factors:

 

   

contemporaneous independent valuations performed at periodic intervals by an unrelated third-party valuation specialist;

 

   

the nature of our business and its history since inception;

 

   

the economic outlook in general and the condition and outlook of our specific industry;

 

   

the book value of our stock and the financial condition of our business;

 

   

our operating and financial performance and forecast;

 

   

the dividend-paying capacity of our business;

 

   

whether or not we have goodwill or other intangible values;

 

   

recent sales of our common stock;

 

   

the prices, rights and privileges of our preferred stock relative to the common stock;

 

   

the hiring of key personnel;

 

   

present value of estimated future cash flows;

 

   

the likelihood of achieving a liquidity event for the shares of common stock underlying these stock options, such as an initial public offering or sale of our company, given prevailing market condition and the nature and history of our business;

 

   

illiquidity of stock-based awards involving securities in a private company;

 

   

the market performance of a relatively consistent set of comparable publicly traded technology companies; and

 

   

the U.S. and global capital market conditions.

 

We granted stock options with the following exercise prices from January 1, 2012 through August 8, 2013, the date of our IPO:

 

Grant Date

   Total Shares of Common
Stock Underlying
Options Granted
     Fair Value Per Share of
Common Stock at Time
of Grant
     Option Exercise Price
Per Share
 

March 19, 2012

     45,750       $ 8.00       $ 5.96   

June 11, 2012

     194,625         8.00         5.96   

July 24, 2012

     75,750         8.00         8.00   

October 15, 2012

     80,500         9.00         8.00   

January 8, 2013

     183,470         9.40         9.00   

May 28, 2013

     644,901         11.80         11.80   

June 17, 2013

     195,590         12.00         12.00   

 

No single event caused the valuation of our common stock to increase during the periods indicated in the foregoing table. Instead, a combination of factors, described in greater detail in the individual valuation discussions below, led to the changes in the fair value of the underlying common stock as determined by our board of directors. Primarily, the general increase was attributable to business developments. Specifically, our revenue was increasing during this period both due to a combination of organic growth and financially then-insignificant acquisitions of complementary businesses and technologies. In addition to the increase as a result of business developments, the increase was a result of our progress towards an initial public offering, including preliminary discussions with prospective underwriters and an organizational meeting in December 2012.

 

65


Table of Contents

To assist our board of directors with the determination of the exercise price for our stock options and the fair value of the common stock underlying the options, we obtained third-party valuations of our common stock as of December 1, 2011, July 16, 2012, October 31, 2012, December 31, 2012 and March 31, 2013. The independent valuations performed by unrelated third-party valuation specialists were just one factor used by our board of directors to assist with the valuation of the common stock and in determining the exercise price for options granted, and our management and board of directors have assumed full responsibility for the estimates. Our unrelated third-party valuation specialists provided us with their estimation of fair value and the allocation of that fair value to our common stock at periodic intervals.

 

Pre-IPO Valuation Methodology Prior to October 31, 2012

 

Prior to October 31, 2012, in determining the fair value of our common stock at the time of grant in order to further determine the exercise price, our board of directors considered an income approach to determine the equity value of our business. We determined that a market approach was less relevant to determining our valuation as there was a wide range of multiples associated with transactions in the cloud industry depending on size of the company, profitability, anticipated growth and other factors. Additionally, there were no public or private companies identified that exactly matched the services that we provide. As such, we largely relied on the market approach to confirm that our conclusion of value applying the income approach was in the general range for multiples in our industry.

 

The income approach is based on the premise that the value of a company is its ability to generate earnings and cash flow. Within the income approach, there are multiple methods including the capitalization of earnings method and the discounted free cash flow method. We utilized the discounted free cash flow method, which estimates the fair value of a company based on the present value of the company’s future estimated free cash flows and the terminal value of the company beyond the forecast period. These future values are discounted to their present values to reflect the risks inherent in the company achieving these estimated cash flows. The discount rates used in our valuation were based primarily on benchmark venture capital studies of discount rates for other companies in our stage of development, considered along with industry based weighted average cost of capital rates. Other significant inputs of the income approach (in addition to our estimated future cash flows themselves) include but are not limited to the long-term growth rate assumed in the terminal value.

 

We relied on the discounted free cash flow method of the income approach as the best indication of the value of our business because it incorporates the specific characteristics of our company most directly and disregards to a certain degree erratic swings that may occur in market transactions.

 

After consideration of these approaches, we determined the enterprise value for our business and added in current cash and cash for vested, in-the-money convertible securities to achieve the adjusted equity value. The adjusted equity value per share was allocated to our then-outstanding common stock and then-outstanding preferred stock on an as-converted to common basis, as our then-outstanding series preferred stock did not have a liquidation preference that would result in different or a priority distribution from common stock in any liquidity event such as a merger, sale or initial public offering. We then determined the adjusted equity value per share as of the date of valuation by dividing the total adjusted equity value by the number of shares outstanding on an as-converted to common stock basis. We further applied an additional marketability discount to reflect the lack of a public market or imminent liquidity event for our common stock to determine the fair value per share.

 

Pre-IPO Valuation Methodology After and Including December 31, 2012

 

After and including December 31, 2012 until the pricing of our IPO, in determining the fair value of our common stock at the time of grant in order to further determine the exercise price, our board of directors considered two valuation approaches to determine the equity value of our business, an income approach and a market approach.

 

66


Table of Contents

Within the income approach, we again utilized the discounted free cash flow method. The discount rates used in our valuation were developed using a weighted average cost of capital that was entirely based on our cost of equity as determined through a capital asset pricing model. The resulting weighted average cost of capital was further risk adjusted based on our size and long-term growth prospects. Other significant inputs of the income approach (in addition to our estimated future cash flows themselves) include but are not limited to the long-term growth rate assumed in the terminal value.

 

Within the market approach, we applied both a guideline public company method, which considered the trading multiples for comparable publicly-traded companies (several of which were included in our various valuation estimates), and a comparative transactions approach, which considered the multiples of publicly available information about acquisitions of public and private companies that are similarly situated to us. We selected comparable publicly traded companies by analyzing various factors, including, but not limited to, industry similarity, financial risk, company size, geographic diversification, profitability, the availability of adequate financial data, and whether or not they had an actively traded stock. The market multiples are based on key metrics implied by the enterprise or acquisition values of comparable publicly traded companies. We primarily utilized the trailing twelve months and projected twelve months revenue multiples from our comparable publicly traded peers in the market approach. These observed multiples were averaged and then applied to our historical twelve months and projected revenue to arrive at an indication of value. Other significant inputs of the market approach include our historical and projected operating metrics.

 

After consideration of all of these approaches, we determined to use the hybrid method to determine our equity value, which is a hybrid of both the probability-weighted expected return model, or PWERM, and option pricing method, or OPM. This method includes estimating the probability weighted value across multiple scenarios, while using an OPM to estimate the allocation of value within one or more of those scenarios. We believed the hybrid model was more appropriate than an explicit PWERM for these valuation determinations as we had greater expectations at this time about the near-term prospects of a liquidity event such as an initial public offering. The fair value per share was allocated to our then-outstanding common stock and then-outstanding preferred stock on an as-converted to common basis, as our then-outstanding series preferred stock did not have a liquidation preference that would result in different or a priority distribution from common stock in any liquidity event such as a merger, sale or initial public offering.

 

Specific Factors Considered at Each Grant Date

 

Significant factors considered by our board of directors in determining the exercise price and the fair value of the underlying common stock for our stock-based awards are as follows:

 

March 2012. We granted options for the purchase of 45,750 shares of common stock on March 19, 2012. Our board of directors set an exercise price of $5.96 per share for these options.

 

In March 2012, the overall economic outlook remained uncertain, with some economists foreseeing significantly weaker prospects for the U.S. economy in late 2011 and early 2012. The U.S. economy was showing signs of increased spending, but the pace of such growth was uncertain for most businesses in early 2012. Although we successfully completed a venture capital financing in July 2011 at $7.80 per share of Series A Preferred Stock, the major U.S. stock market indices dropped precipitously shortly after such date and had not yet recovered as of the end of 2012.

 

Our board of directors considered a third-party valuation prepared as of December 1, 2011, market conditions, especially for companies in the enterprise application software industry, our operating performance, operating risk in our business, and anticipated time to a liquidity event when it determined the fair value of our common stock at the date of grant. After consideration of all of these factors, our board of directors determined that our business had an adjusted equity value of $287.9 million, or $7.44 per share as of March 19, 2012. Our board of directors further applied a 20% marketability discount to that amount and determined that the fair value of our common stock was $5.96 per share as of March 19, 2012.

 

67


Table of Contents

In connection with the preparation of our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012 and in anticipation of a potential initial public offering, we reassessed for financial reporting purposes the estimate of fair value per share of the March 2012 grants. Various factors were considered. For example, in early 2013 prior to issuing our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012, the economic conditions for all of 2012 were fully observable. Viewed retrospectively, the market conditions that negatively affected our projected cash flow growth included in our valuation estimates were likely too conservative at that time, although seemingly appropriate at the original determination. Based on this revised understanding of the expected growth of the business, we re-evaluated projected cash flows used in our third-party valuation specialist’s report as of December 1, 2011. We also further evaluated the fair value of our common stock based on linear interpolation from a fair value of $7.80 per share, which was the most recent arms-length transaction in our capital stock, to an estimated fair value of $9.00 as of October 15, 2012 based on our reassessment of grants on that date, the last grant in 2012. While there can be no certainty of our estimate given the lack of a public market for our shares at the time of the reassessment, we believe that the reassessed fair value that considered this additional information was appropriate in concluding that the estimated per-share value of the underlying common shares for options granted in March 2012 was $8.00 per share for financial reporting purposes.

 

June 2012. We granted options for the purchase of 194,625 shares of common stock on June 11, 2012. Our board of directors set an exercise price of $5.96 per share for these options.

 

In June 2012, the overall economic outlook was generally unchanged from the outlook in March 2012. We experienced sequential revenue growth during the three months ended March 31, 2012 as compared to the preceding quarter.

 

Our board of directors again considered a third-party valuation prepared as of December 1, 2011, as well as intervening market conditions, especially for companies in the enterprise application software industry, our operating performance, operating risk in our business, and anticipated time to a liquidity event when it determined the fair value of our common stock at the date of grant. After consideration of all of these factors, our board of directors again determined that our business had an adjusted equity value of $287.9 million, or $7.44 per share as of June 11, 2012. Our board of directors further applied a 20% marketability discount to that amount and determined that the fair value of our common stock was $5.96 per share as of June 11, 2012.

 

In connection with the preparation of our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012 and in anticipation of a potential initial public offering, we reassessed for financial reporting purposes the estimate of fair value per share of the June 2012 grants. Various factors were considered. For example, in early 2013 prior to issuing our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012, the economic conditions for the whole of 2012 were fully observable. Viewed retrospectively, the market conditions that negatively affected our projected cash flow growth included in our valuation estimates were likely too conservative at that time, although seemingly appropriate at the original determination. Based on this revised understanding of the expected growth of the business, we re-evaluated projected cash flows used in our third-party valuation specialist’s report as of December 1, 2011. We also considered the proximity to our determination of the estimated fair value of our common stock as of March 2012 as well as the third-party valuation prepared as of July 16, 2012. While there can be no certainty of our estimate given the lack of a public market for our shares at the time of the reassessment, we believe that the reassessed fair value that considered this additional information was appropriate in concluding that the estimated per-share value of the underlying common shares for options granted on June 11, 2012 was $8.00 per share for financial reporting purposes.

 

July 2012. We granted options for the purchase of 75,750 shares of common stock on July 24, 2012. Our board of directors set an exercise price of $8.00 per share for these options.

 

In July 2012, the overall economic outlook was again somewhat more positive as compared to March 2012 and generally consistent with June 2012. The public capital markets continued to be very active at this time for initial public offerings in the technology space, but an expected liquidity event for our business was not then imminent. In addition, we completed the acquisition of CrowdCompass, our mobile application product, in June 2012.

 

68


Table of Contents

Our board of directors considered a third-party valuation prepared as of July 16, 2012, market conditions, especially for companies in the enterprise application software industry, our operating performance, operating risk in our business, and anticipated time to a liquidity event when it determined the fair value of our common stock at the date of grant. After consideration of all of these factors, our board of directors determined that our business had an adjusted equity value of $387.0 million, or $10.00 per share as of July 24, 2012. Our board of directors further applied a 20% marketability discount to that amount and determined that the fair value of our common stock was $8.00 per share as of July 24, 2012.

 

In connection with the preparation of our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012 and in anticipation of a potential initial public offering, we reassessed for financial reporting purposes the estimate of fair value per share of the July 2012 grants. Various factors were considered. For example, in early 2013 prior to issuing our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012, the economic conditions for the whole of 2012 were fully observable. Viewed retrospectively, the market conditions that negatively affected our projected cash flow growth included in our valuation estimates in July 2012 were likely reasonable. As such, we concluded that the estimated per-share value of the underlying common shares for options granted on July 2012 remained unchanged at $8.00 per share for financial reporting purposes.

 

October 2012. We granted options for the purchase of 80,500 shares of common stock on October 15, 2012. Our board of directors set an exercise price of $8.00 per share for these options.

 

In October 2012, the overall economic outlook was generally consistent with the outlook in July 2012. The public capital markets continued to be very active at this time for public offerings in the technology space but had slowed somewhat compared to earlier in the year. We were actively seeking to hire a chief financial officer at this time in anticipation of our initial public offering, and we had held certain preliminary discussions with potential underwriters of our IPO.

 

Our board of directors again considered the third-party valuation prepared as of July 16, 2012, market conditions, especially for companies in the enterprise application software industry, our operating performance, operating risk in our business, and anticipated time to a liquidity event when it determined the fair value of our common stock at the date of grant. After consideration of all of these factors, our board of directors again determined that our business had an adjusted equity value of $387.0 million, or $10.00 per share as of October 15, 2012. Our board of directors further applied a 20% marketability discount to that amount and determined that the fair value of our common stock was $8.00 per share as of October 15, 2012.

 

In connection with the preparation of our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012 and in anticipation of a potential initial public offering, we reassessed for financial reporting purposes the estimate of fair value per share of the October 2012 grants. Various factors were considered. For example, in early 2013 prior to issuing our financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2012, the economic conditions for the whole of 2012 were fully observable. Viewed retrospectively, the market conditions that negatively affected our projected cash flow growth included in our valuation estimates in October 2012 were likely too conservative at that time, although seemingly appropriate at the original determination. Based on this revised understanding of the expected growth of the business, we re-evaluated projected cash flows used in our third-party valuation specialist’s report as of July 16, 2012. We also considered the proximity to our determination of the estimated fair value of our common stock as of June 2012, as well as to the third-party valuation reports prepared as of October 31, 2012 and December 31, 2012 and the increased proximity to our organizational meeting for our IPO, which occurred in December 2012. While there can be no certainty of our estimate given the lack of a public market for our shares at the time of the reassessment, we believe that the reassessed fair value that considered this additional information was appropriate in concluding that the estimated per-share value of the underlying common shares for options granted on October 2012 was $9.00 per share for financial reporting purposes.

 

January 2013. We granted options for the purchase of 183,470 shares of common stock on January 8, 2013. Our board of directors set an exercise price of $9.00 per share for these options.

 

69


Table of Contents

In January 2013, the overall economic outlook was somewhat uncertain. We experienced additional sequential revenue growth during the three months ended June 30, 2012 as compared to the preceding quarter. Since October 2012, we acquired TicketMob, an event ticketing provider, and we also held meetings with prospective underwriters, selected underwriters and held the initial organizational meeting for our initial public offering.

 

Our board of directors considered a third-party valuation prepared as of October 31, 2012, market conditions, especially for companies in the enterprise application software industry, our operating performance, operating risk in our business, and anticipated time to a liquidity event when it determined the fair value of our common stock at the date of grant. As of the grant date, we estimated the probability of an initial public offering on September 30, 2013 at 33.3%, an initial public offering on December 31, 2014 at 33.3%, and a merger or sale of our company in five years at 33.3%. A discount rate of 29.1% was applied, based on the industry cost of capital for newly public companies in the technology industry. After consideration of all of these factors, our board of directors determined that our business had an adjusted equity value of $406.0 million, or $11.24 per share as of January 8, 2013. Our board of directors further applied a marketability discount to that amount and determined that the fair value of our common stock was $9.00 per share as of January 8, 2013.

 

In connection with the preparation of our financial statements for the three months ended March 31, 2013 and in anticipation of a potential initial public offering, we reassessed for financial reporting purposes the estimate of fair value per share of the January 2013 grants. Various factors were considered. For example, prior to issuing our financial statements for the three months ended March 31, 2013, the economic conditions for the whole of the quarter were fully observable. We also considered the increased proximity and likelihood of our IPO as well as the results of our third-party valuation report prepared as of December 31, 2012, which was not completed prior to the date of the January 2013 grant of options. While there can be no certainty of our estimate given the lack of a public market for our shares at the time of the reassessment, we believe that the reassessed fair value that considered this additional information was appropriate in concluding that the estimated per-share value of the underlying common shares for options granted on January 2013 was $9.40 per share for financial reporting purposes.

 

May 2013. We granted options for the purchase of 644,901 shares of common stock on May 28, 2013. Our board of directors set an exercise price of $11.80 per share for these options.

 

In May 2013, the overall economic outlook had improved since late 2012. We experienced additional sequential revenue growth during the three months ended March 31, 2013 as compared to the preceding quarter. Since January 2013, we continued to prepare for our initial public offering, including confidentially submitting a draft registration statement in April 2013. Our board of directors considered a third-party valuation prepared as of March 31, 2013, market conditions, especially for companies in the enterprise application software industry, our operating performance, operating risk in our business, and the anticipated time to a liquidity event when it determined the fair value of our common stock at the date of grant. As of March 31, 2013, we estimated the probability of an initial public offering on September 30, 2013 at 60%, an initial public offering on December 31, 2014 at 20%, and a merger or sale of our company in five years at 20%. A discount rate of 23.5% was applied, based on the comparable cost of capital for newly public companies in the technology industry. After consideration of all of these factors, our board of directors determined that our business had an adjusted equity value of $458 million, or $12.76 per share as of March 31, 2013. Our board of directors further applied a marketability discount to that amount and determined that the fair value of our common stock was $10.80 per share as of March 31, 2013. Our board of directors then considered intervening material events, including the increased likelihood of our initial public offering and the continued growth of our business since March 31, 2013 until the grant date and ultimately determined a fair value of our common stock of $11.80 as of May 28, 2013.

 

June 2013. We granted options for the purchase of 195,590 shares of common stock on June 17, 2013. Our board of directors set an exercise price of $12.00 per share for these options.

 

70


Table of Contents

In June 2013, as it did in May 2013, the overall economic outlook remained upbeat compared to late 2012. We continued to prepare for our initial public offering. Our board of directors considered the prior valuation assessment in May 2013 and the valuation report prepared as of March 31, 2013, as well as market conditions, especially for companies in the enterprise application software industry, our operating performance, operating risk in our business, and the anticipated time to a liquidity event when it determined the fair value of our common stock at the date of grant. Our board of directors then considered intervening material events, including the increased likelihood of our initial public offering and the continued growth of our business since May 2013 until the grant date and ultimately determined a fair value of our common stock of $12.00 as of June 17, 2013.

 

Determination of Estimated IPO Price. In July 2013, we determined the estimated public offering price per share of our IPO to be between $17.00 and $19.00 per share. The assumptions supporting the estimated initial public offering price range represented management’s best estimates and discussions between us and the underwriters, but involve complex and subjective judgments.

 

In particular, the estimated price range took into account the recent performance and valuation of comparable public companies. The estimated price range was affected by, among other things, the size of the offering, the recent upward trends in the financial markets since January 2013 and the increased likelihood and imminence of our initial public offering. For example, comparable public SaaS-based companies experienced a dramatic increase in market value in June and July of 2013. The price range reflected our discussions with the underwriters and the factors above and was not determined using the methodology used by management to value our common stock as of March 31, 2013. The estimated price range necessarily assumed that an initial public offering will ultimately occur, and that a public market for our common stock would be created in the coming months, and it therefore excluded any marketability or illiquidity discount for our common stock. Because the price range was determined through discussions with the underwriters and was not determined using the methodology that management used to value our common stock as of March 31, 2013, we are not able to quantify the amount that any particular factor contributed to the determination of the estimated price range.

 

Use of Comparable Public Companies in Pre-IPO Estimates

 

We considered groups of comparable public companies in our assessments of volatility and in our valuation estimates prior to our IPO. We also considered comparable public companies in the determination of the estimated price range of our IPO. These assessments and estimates considered many of the same comparable companies, which were primarily SaaS-based companies.

 

Volatility Assessments. Our volatility assessments were based on a group of comparable companies that included many of the same comparable companies used in our valuation estimates after March 31, 2013. In addition, due to the nature of inherent differences that exist in any estimate, we also considered the volatilities of other similar companies in our broader industry to identify any significant inconsistencies or variations in our volatility indications selected. After calculating the historical volatility for each of the comparable companies, we selected the median volatility across all of these companies as our volatility indication to be used in valuing our common stock. Had we included all of the comparable companies included in our valuation estimates in the determination of volatility indication, volatility would not have varied significantly from the comparable companies used in our assessment.

 

Valuation Estimates After March 31, 2013. Our valuation assessments after March 31, 2013, were based on a group of comparable companies that included many of the same comparable companies used in our volatility assessments. In addition, our valuation estimates considered additional relevant companies in determining our estimated valuation indications. Our valuation approach included both a guideline public company method and a comparative transactions approach to arrive at the selected indication of our estimated fair value. In addition, the ultimate determination of our estimate of fair value as of valuation dates after March 31, 2013 included other factors considered by our board of directors to ultimately arrive at a selected fair value indication. Given that the ultimate determination of our fair value indication was based on a variety of factors, as noted above, we do not

 

71


Table of Contents

believe that the inclusion of all of the comparable companies used in the volatility assessment or in the comparable company group used in the estimated offering price range described below would have had a material effect on our determination of estimated fair value, given the other factors considered by our board of directors in selecting fair value indications.

 

Estimated Offering Price Range. The estimated offering price range of our IPO was based on a group of comparable companies that included several of the same comparable companies that were included in both our volatility assessments and our valuation estimates after March 31, 2013. In addition, the estimated IPO price range was based on an expanded set of guideline companies to reflect an increase in our general prominence as a SaaS-based offering as we become a public company. We do not believe that the inclusion of all of the comparable companies used in determining the estimated IPO price range would have had a material effect on the valuation estimates noted above, as the average stock prices for both groups of comparable companies used in our valuation estimates and the estimated IPO price range increased by approximately the same percentages from January 2013 through mid-July 2013.

 

Post-IPO Common Stock Value Determinations

 

Following our IPO, we established a policy of using the closing sale price per share of our common stock as quoted on the New York Stock Exchange on the date of grant for purposes of determining the exercise price per share of our options to purchase common stock. In November 2013, our Board refined this policy such that the grant date of any equity award shall be the next 15th day of the month after the date the award is approved, or if not a business day, the next succeeding business day.

 

Accounting for Income Taxes

 

We account for income taxes under the asset and liability method as required by ASC 740, Income Taxes, which requires the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for the expected future tax consequences of events that are included in the financial statements. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the differences between the financial statements and tax basis of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. The effect of a change in tax rates on deferred tax assets and liabilities is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date.

 

We record net deferred tax assets to the extent we believe these assets will more likely than not be realized. In making such a determination, we consider all available positive and negative evidence, including future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, projected future taxable income, tax-planning strategies, and results of recent operations. In the event we were to determine that we would be able to realize our deferred income tax assets in the future excess of their net recorded amount, we would make an adjustment to the deferred tax asset valuation allowance, which would reduce the provision for income taxes.

 

We are subject to income taxes in the U.S. and other foreign jurisdictions. Significant judgment is required in evaluating uncertain tax positions. We record uncertain tax positions in accordance with ASC 740-10 on the basis of a two-step process whereby (i) we determine whether it is more likely than not that the tax positions will be sustained based on the technical merits of the position and (ii) those tax positions that meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, we recognize the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50% likely to be realized upon ultimate settlement with the related tax authority.

 

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

Market risk represents the risk of loss that may impact our financial position due to adverse changes in financial market prices and rates. Our market risk exposure is primarily a result of fluctuations in foreign currency rates, although we also have some exposure due to potential changes in inflation or interest rates. We do not hold financial instruments for trading purposes.

 

72


Table of Contents

Foreign Currency Risk

 

Foreign currency exchange rates are subject to fluctuation and may cause us to recognize transaction gains and losses in our statement of operations. A portion of our business is conducted through our subsidiary in India whose functional currency is the U.S. Dollar. To the extent that transactions by our subsidiary in India are denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar, we bear the risk that fluctuations in the exchange rates of the U.S. Dollar in relation to other currencies could increase our costs and expenses. Realized foreign currency transaction losses are included in net income (loss) and were immaterial and $0.2 million in the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively, and $0.1 million and $0.9 million in the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013, respectively.

 

As of September 30, 2013, we have not entered into any hedging transactions in an effort to reduce our exposure to foreign currency exchange risk. While we may decide to enter into hedging transactions in the future, the availability and effectiveness of these hedging transactions may be limited and we may not be able to successfully hedge our exposure.

 

Inflation Risk

 

Inflationary factors, such as increases in our operating expenses, may adversely affect our results of operations, as our customers typically purchase services from us on a subscription basis over a multi-year period. Although we do not believe that inflation has had a material impact on our financial position or results of operations to date, an increase in the rate of inflation in the future may have an adverse effect on our levels of operating expenses as a percentage of revenue if we are unable to increase the prices for our subscription-based solutions to keep pace with these increased expenses.

 

Interest Rate Risk

 

We are exposed to market risk related to changes in interest rates. Our cash equivalents primarily consist of money market funds backed by United States Treasury Bills and certificates of deposit. Our short-term investments primarily consist of bank certificates of deposit. As of September 30, 2013, we had $144.5 million of cash and cash equivalents, excluding $0.7 million of restricted cash and $13.3 million of short-term investments. The carrying amount of our cash equivalents and short-term investments reasonably approximates fair value, due to the short maturities of these instruments. The primary objectives of our investment activities are the preservation of capital, the fulfillment of liquidity needs and the fiduciary control of cash and investments. We do not enter into investments for trading or speculative purposes. Our investments are exposed to market risk due to a fluctuation in interest rates, which may affect our interest income and the fair market value of our investments. Due to the short-term nature of our investment portfolio and our tendency to hold investments to maturity, however, we do not believe an immediate increase or decrease in interest rates of as much as 3% would have a material effect on the fair market value of our portfolio. We therefore do not expect our operating results or cash flows to be materially affected by a sudden change in market interest rates.

 

We do not believe our cash equivalents or short-term investments have significant risk of default or illiquidity. While we believe our cash equivalents or short-term investments do not contain excessive risk, we cannot provide absolute assurance that in the future our investments will not be subject to adverse changes in market value. In addition, we maintain significant amounts of cash and cash equivalents at one or more financial institutions that are in excess of federally insured limits. We cannot be assured that we will not experience losses on these deposits.

 

73


Table of Contents

BUSINESS

 

Our Mission

 

Our mission is to transform the events and meetings industry. Our software platform disrupts the traditional processes for the event planners who organize events and the venues that host them, creating more value for the entire events and meetings ecosystem.

 

Overview

 

We are a leading cloud-based enterprise event management platform. We provide solutions for both sides of the events and meetings value chain: (i) event and meeting planners, and (ii) hotels and venues. Our integrated, cloud-based solution addresses the entire event lifecycle by allowing event and meeting planners to organize, market and manage their meetings, conferences, tradeshows and other events. Our online marketplace connects event planners and venues through our vertical search engine that accesses our proprietary database of detailed hotel and venue information. The combination of these solutions creates an integrated platform that allows us to generate revenue from both sides of the events and meetings value chain.

 

Events and meetings reach across every industry vertical, from consumer products to energy to healthcare. A 2013 independent study conducted by Frost & Sullivan, which was commissioned by us, estimated that the global market for events and meetings management, including such costs as accommodations, transportation and other support, was approximately $565 billion in 2012. Of that amount, Frost & Sullivan estimated that the global event management software market was $5.6 billion in 2012, which we view as an immediately addressable opportunity. The same study estimated that the global market for non-software event and meeting management was $22 billion in 2012, which included the additional labor of planning, managing and executing events and meetings using manual processes that we believe can be made more efficient by our platform.

 

For the event and meeting planner side of the value chain, which includes enterprises such as corporations, associations, not-for-profits, government agencies and universities, events and meetings are an integral way to build and strengthen relationships with customers, prospects, employees and partners. Enterprise events and meetings include external events, such as conferences, tradeshows, and customer summits, as well as internal functions, such as sales meetings, training seminars and team-building events. During the nine months ended September 30, 2013, our Fortune 1000 event and meeting planner customers managed an average of 540 events and meetings on our platform. According to a 2013 study conducted by Frost & Sullivan, enterprises spend an average of 1.1% of their revenue on events and meetings.

 

Planning and running an event can be a highly complex, inefficient and time-consuming task when managed using traditional manual processes and disparate point software solutions. We address these challenges by providing planners an integrated platform with solutions that unify the full lifecycle of an event. Meeting planners use our solution to identify the appropriate venue, secure a competitive proposal from hotels, manage budgets, market the event, send invitations, send follow-up reminders, utilize pre-event surveys, establish a social media presence for the event, process registrations, manage fee collections, build an event-specific mobile app, manage event logistics such as travel and lodging, manage on-going communication with attendees, survey and engage with attendees, and analyze event results and survey feedback following the function. Just as expense management software has become a ubiquitous tool for enterprises to automate traditionally manual and complex processes, we believe that a similar opportunity for automation and improvement exists in our industry. Unlike expense management software that primarily generates cost savings, our solution also provides our customers with the opportunity to increase their revenue. A Frost & Sullivan study conducted in March 2013 highlighted that event management solutions help planners at small and medium-sized enterprises, on average, increase event attendance by 20%. We believe our platform reduces expenses for our planner customers, and also helps our hotel customers drive incremental revenue.

 

74


Table of Contents

For the hotel and venue side of the value chain, group events and meetings are a vital source of revenue and profit. At certain types of hotels, group events and meetings can constitute approximately one-third of total revenue. Group meeting business is often a large hotel’s most profitable segment as these groups typically contract not only for significant sleeping room blocks, but also for meeting space, catering and audio visual equipment. Meeting attendees tend to be a captive audience at the hotel and can generate substantial incremental revenue.

 

Our online marketplace, the Cvent Supplier Network, or CSN, connects tens of thousands of planners seeking the best venue for their events and meetings with more than 200,000 venues featured in our proprietary database. We believe that our CSN contains the world’s largest, most accurate database of detailed meeting venue information with listings of hotels, conference centers, convention centers, resorts, museums, country clubs, wineries, castles, restaurants and other special event venues in more than 175 countries that can be searched and filtered based on approximately 200 characteristics and data fields. The Cvent Supplier Network has become a leading solution for event and meeting planners who are researching potential locations and venues for their events, as well as for hotels and venues that are seeking to increase their group business revenue. The number of event requests for proposal, or RFPs, submitted through our CSN has increased considerably from approximately 12,000 in 2008 to approximately 1.1 million in 2012 and to more than 947,000 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013. We believe we have achieved critical mass and are benefiting from substantial network effects by simultaneously increasing the volume of RFPs transmitted from planners to venues, expanding our proprietary venue database and growing the number of hotel personnel trained on and using our system.

 

Our dual role as a provider to both event planners and venues allows us to generate revenue from both sides of the value chain. Event and meeting planners enter into annual and multi-year subscription contracts to utilize our cloud-based event and meeting management software solutions. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 6,700 event and meeting planner customers, including Aimia Proprietary Loyalty (formerly Carlson Marketing), Corporate Executive Board, Edwards Lifesciences, Incisive Media, Maritz Travel Company, Merck KGaA, Visa, Walmart and Wellpoint Health Networks. Hotels and venues enter into annual and multi-year contracts with us for marketing solutions that increase the prominence of their properties in our CSN. As of September 30, 2013, more than 5,600 hotels and venues have purchased marketing solutions from us, including brands such as Hilton, Hyatt, IHG (InterContinental Hotels Group), Marriott and Starwood.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2012, our revenue was $83.5 million, representing year-over-year revenue growth of 37%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2013, our revenue was $80.4 million, a 34% increase over the same period in 2012. Our enterprise-focused, cloud-based platform for event and meeting planners has historically constituted the majority of our revenue and represented 70% of our total revenue for the year ended December 31, 2012 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2013. For the year ended December 31, 2012, we generated net income of $4.3 million, representing a margin of 5%, and adjusted EBITDA) of $20.3 million, representing a margin of 24%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2013, we generated a net loss of $2.8 million and adjusted EBITDA of $12.7 million, representing a margin of 16%.

 

Industry Background

 

The hospitality and travel industry serve three types of customers: individual business travelers, leisure travelers, and group events and meetings. In the 1990s, American Express began offering travel services and subsequently transformed the way business travelers book hotel rooms and air travel. In the 2000s, online travel agencies revolutionized the industry for leisure travelers. We believe that we are driving a similar revolution today in the way group events and meetings are planned, booked and managed, both by the event planners and the hotels and venues that host these events.

 

75


Table of Contents

Key Issues and Industry Trends Affecting Event and Meeting Planners

 

Highly Complex Planning Process that Has Historically Lacked an Integrated Software Solution. Planning and running a conference, large group meeting or event is a highly complex, tedious and often manual process. Event planners must coordinate with numerous internal constituencies, including marketing, sales, finance and travel services personnel, as well as external constituencies, including the event venue, service providers and potential attendees. Many departments within large enterprises, including finance, sales, marketing, expense management and human resources have taken advantage of comprehensive, integrated software solutions to automate their workflows, business processes and data collection requirements. Event and meeting planners, however, have historically lacked an integrated software platform to manage and automate their activities. In order to secure event venue space and manage the logistics of an event, planners have often used a highly inefficient combination of general internet search engines, event magazines, telephone calls, spreadsheets, emails and internally developed systems.

 

To address the entire event lifecycle, event and meeting planners could require more than ten disparate point solutions to identify the appropriate venue, secure a competitive proposal from hotels, manage budgets, market the event, send invitations, send follow-up reminders, conduct pre-event surveys, establish a social media presence, process registrations, manage fee collection, provide an event-specific mobile app, manage event logistics such as travel and lodging, manage on-going communication with the attendees, survey and engage attendees and analyze event results and survey feedback following the function. Some meeting planners have attempted to address these processes with internally developed software. However, these internally developed tools and disparate point solutions typically do not address the entire lifecycle and typically lack integration, functionality and the ability to seamlessly share data. This means that many organizations struggle to effectively plan, manage, measure and improve their events, which may result in underperformance related to expectations.

 

Continued Importance of Events and Meetings. Events and meetings are among the most high-profile and high-impact marketing initiatives available to an enterprise. Mission critical events such as product launches and user conferences provide enterprises with a valuable opportunity to maximize their marketing and sales potential by having as many as hundreds, or even thousands, of customers, partners and employees all in one location. We believe that events and meetings represent approximately one quarter of an organization’s marketing budget. As a result, we believe that Chief Marketing Officers and other C-level executives are increasingly focused on events and meetings and seeking solutions to ensure they are effective and successful.

 

Need for More Visibility Into Event and Meeting Expenses and Return on Investment. It has now become commonplace for large corporations to utilize software that tracks corporate spend for employee travel, lodging and expenses, but, historically, companies have lacked a cloud-based solution to monitor and manage appropriate spending levels for events and meetings. Unlike some other functions within an enterprise, planning for events is often not centralized in one department, and, in many cases, meeting planners are not required to seek advance approval to book a meeting or conference. This is a very large area of unbridled spending for an organization as, according to Frost & Sullivan, mid-market organizations host on average more than 15 events and meetings each year, costing an aggregate average of $103,000 annually, while large enterprises host on average more than 200 events and meetings each year, costing an aggregate average of $21 million annually. With growing event and meeting budgets, enterprises are starting to adopt meetings management software to help them understand the aggregate spend, make the event process more efficient and leverage that data in vendor negotiations. Many event and meeting planners, as well as others within their organizations, seek more transparency regarding the true costs of an event and to justify the return on investment for their events, while simultaneously ensuring that the events are effectively designed, planned and managed to meet targeted objectives. For example, certain event planners in more regulated environments, such as pharmaceutical sales, are also facing increased regulatory reporting and accountability requirements that are not easily manageable with manual processes.

 

Increasing Number of Channels to Engage with Attendees Before, During and After an Event. With the recent emergence of more diverse communication channels, event planners face a wide variety of options to reach their desired audience, including email, online advertising, text messaging, and social media platforms,

 

76


Table of Contents

such as Twitter, Facebook and LinkedIn. Event planners are looking to market their event in advance, increase engagement during the event, share event-related information in real time, build year-round online communities and more easily connect with attendees after the event to receive valuable feedback essential to future event planning. However, many event planners may struggle to efficiently present a consistent message across the numerous channels through which they are interacting with attendees. To standardize the message, planners may want a comprehensive cross-channel solution to engage with attendees before, during and after the event.

 

Events are Increasingly Mobile. Attendees use their mobile devices in everyday life to communicate and consume content, and increasingly expect to be able to connect in the same way with other attendees, speakers, exhibitors and sponsors at the events they attend. Mobile event apps allow planners to reduce printing costs, send out real-time event information to attendees and create additional sponsorship opportunities. Moving forward, we believe planners will seek a holistic platform that integrates their event and meeting mobile apps with their event management solutions.

 

Key Issues and Industry Trends Affecting Hotels and Venues

 

Fiercely Competitive Hospitality Landscape. Hotels generate revenue from three primary types of business: transient consumers, business travelers and group events and meetings. The global hospitality industry has become more competitive, and the group events and meetings segment has become increasingly important to the ultimate success or failure of many hotels. Frost & Sullivan estimates that group events and meetings represented $103 billion of revenue in 2012 globally for hotels. As a result, hotels spent an estimated aggregate of $3.9 billion on marketing and advertising to win that business. The same study also concluded that, at certain types of hotels, group events and meetings can constitute approximately one-third of hotel revenue. Group revenue often constitute a large hotel’s most profitable segment because, in addition to the on-site sleeping rooms, groups often pay fees for the meeting space, as well as banquet food and beverage, and event attendees are hotel guests that are highly likely to utilize the hotel’s restaurants, shops and other paid amenities. Given the highly profitable nature of group events and meetings, the competition among hotels for event business continues to escalate. Increasing competition in the group events and meeting segment is being driven by:

 

   

Hotel brands seeking to host group events. As of September 30, 2013, there were approximately 320 hotel brands that have an aggregate of more than 44,000 affiliated properties around the globe. Based on our industry contacts and conversations with our hotel clients, we believe many brands see the group events and meetings business as an attractive economic opportunity and are increasingly seeking to expand in this area.

 

   

Increased competition from boutique and independently-owned hotels and other venues. The number of boutique and independently-owned specialty hotels has increased, and some are targeting group business. A number of large special event venues, such as museums, sports stadiums and universities, and other, smaller venues, such as wineries, country clubs and restaurants, are also seeking to host group events when their facilities are not being used for their primary purpose.

 

   

Decreased margins in other segments. Online travel agencies have caused hotels to experience a significant decrease in room night margins for business and leisure travelers. To compensate for this decline, we believe hotels are now focusing more on attracting higher margin segments, such as group business.

 

Hotel Budgets for Group Marketing Shifting from Less Effective Mass Market Channels to Digital Mediums. Worldwide ad spending continues to shift from traditional mass market mediums, such as television, print and radio, to digital online and mobile channels. Historically, hotels have taken a less targeted approach in marketing to event and meeting planners with a focus on advertising in monthly trade magazines, sending sales staff to trade shows throughout the year, spending significant time cold calling and sending mass mailings. However, there appears to be a shift in how advertising dollars are spent as a January 2013 report by eMarketer estimates that worldwide digital ad spending was $103 billion in 2012, or approximately 20% of total ad

 

77


Table of Contents

spending, and projects digital ad spending to increase to $163 billion in 2016, representing approximately 26% of total ad spending. Hotels are beginning to realize the power of online advertising, as approximately 36% of hotels surveyed by Frost & Sullivan said they planned to increase their online advertising spend next year.

 

Hotels Have Under-Invested in Group Segment Sales Relative to their Revenue Contribution. A 2013 Frost & Sullivan study highlights that while group events and meetings can account for approximately one-third of revenue for certain types of hotels, these properties end up spending an average of 13% of their marketing budget to actively solicit events and meetings business. Hotels frequently find it challenging to identify who is responsible for planning events and meetings within most organizations and effectively market to them. This is because enterprise event and meeting planners can often be found in a range of departments, including marketing, sales, procurement or corporate, and they often have a wide range of non-standardized job titles. The ability to accurately target event planners when they are ready to transact presents a significant value proposition to hotels and venues. Given the right marketing solutions to identify and engage event planners more accurately, we expect venues’ marketing spending mix to increase in favor of the group events segment.

 

Harnessing Technology to Automate Operations and Improve Performance. We believe hotels and venues in the aggregate annually incur millions of dollars of costs responding to RFPs. Inbound inquiries and bids from event and meeting planners come to hotels in multiple formats, including emails, phone calls and PDF, Word or Excel files. The process for responding to these requests for price quotes is also typically managed using a variety of media channels such as word processing applications, spreadsheets, scanned documents and faxes. This can result in a highly inefficient and non-standardized RFP process. Hotels that host a high-volume of events and meetings can benefit from software for their group business segments that enhances sales and marketing activities, automates and improves the RFP process, and captures data that can provide actionable insights and increase the conversion of group sales leads. By automating certain repetitive tasks such as responding to event proposal requests, hotels can redeploy existing personnel to higher value sales and marketing activities.

 

The Cvent Solution

 

Solutions for Event and Meeting Planners. We offer planners a robust platform that addresses the entire lifecycle of their events and meetings, including budgeting, planning, venue sourcing, marketing, management and measurement of meetings. We offer six major product categories: event management software, strategic meetings management software, mobile event apps, pre- and post-event web surveys, ticketing software and the Cvent Supplier Network. Our cloud-based platform allows event and meeting planners to:

 

   

Increase Event and Meeting Attendance. Our integrated event marketing solution enables event and meeting planners to create sophisticated, multi-channel marketing campaigns to drive higher attendance. Our contact management functionality allows planners to simplify and automate the process of collecting and maintaining accurate contact information for all attendees and prospects by integrating data from existing marketing and customer relationship management databases and allowing prospective attendees to provide their most up-to-date contact information during the event registration process. Using Cvent, event marketers can deploy a multi-faceted marketing strategy utilizing customized event websites, advanced email marketing and social media channels to engage with potential attendees. Once planners attract prospective attendees to their event registration website, they are able to utilize advanced registration features such as early bird discounts, coupon codes and dynamic registration paths to present unique offerings to different attendee segments. By offering integrated contact management, email marketing, social media marketing and event registration solutions, we believe that we enable event and meeting planners to drive higher attendance at their events in a cost-effective manner.

 

   

Increase Efficiency through Automation. Our solutions automate and streamline the labor-intensive process of organizing, marketing and managing events and meetings. For example, our CSN venue-sourcing tool enables event and meeting planners to quickly narrow down the list of venues that are suitable for their event, send customized RFPs and compare the bids side-by-side, allowing them to

 

78


Table of Contents
 

more rapidly identify, contact and negotiate with potential venues. According to Frost & Sullivan, many planners said it takes them five days or longer to execute, plan and manage events and meetings, inclusive of finding an appropriate venue and receiving pricing and availability information. In comparison, our solution enables planners to find a venue that exactly meets their needs within minutes and in many cases receive a response from hotels in less than one day. Our event management solution also automates and integrates a number of traditional, manual processes for planners, and seamlessly shares data as planners are able to process online registrations and payments, collect attendee information and preferences, create custom schedules for attendees to see speakers and exhibits, and automatically update attendees with schedule changes via an event-specific mobile app.

 

   

Reduce Costs. Our solutions automate many tasks for event and meeting planners creating the potential for increased efficiency and cost savings. They also enable procurement professionals to define sophisticated thresholds and controls to restrict meeting planners from making unauthorized or out-of-policy expenditures. The Cvent Supplier Network provides planners with a comprehensive database to research more potential venues and allows them to submit the details of their event in a customized RFP to multiple venues at once, creating a blind-bidding process that helps the planner receive more competitive bids, which we believe reduces the overall costs of the venue. Also, we deliver our software solutions to our customers through a cloud-based delivery model that reduces implementation time and costs associated with traditional on-premises software and requires limited to no involvement from our clients’ technical teams.

 

   

Enhance Returns on Investment from Events and Meetings. Our solutions enable planners to regularly reach out to potential attendees through social media and surveys, build more accurate customer profiles and databases, customize event communications and send automated event reminders. Our software allows event planners to capture and analyze a wide variety of attendee metrics, such as overall attendance, attendance at specific events, comments and testimonials regarding the events and attendee feedback from web surveys taken both during and after the event. We believe our highly targeted marketing meaningfully increases event attendance by reaching the desired attendees. Thus, our solutions enable higher event attendance together with incremental cost savings, thereby helping enterprises significantly increase the returns on investment from their events.

 

Solutions for Hotels and Venues. Through the Cvent Supplier Network, we have created a proprietary online marketplace to connect hotels and venues with enterprise event and meeting planners. Our CSN allows hotels and venues to:

 

   

Increase Revenue in the Group Events and Meetings Segment. Our CSN is an effective solution to help hotels increase the number of in-bound sales leads and amount of revenue from enterprise event and meeting planners.

 

   

More Accurately Target Meeting Planners through Online Marketing. Through our online marketing solutions, hotels and venues are able to target ready-to-transact event and meeting planners in a more cost efficient manner than many other marketing channels. Our solutions also make it easier for hotels and venues to market to hard-to-identify relevant planner personnel within organizations, which results in an increase in the number of sales leads and converted group bookings.

 

   

Enhance Employee Productivity and Efficiency. Through our CSN, we offer hotels and venues tools to automate and standardize the process by which they receive and respond to RFPs from event and meeting planners. During the nine months ended September 30, 2013, more than 947,000 RFPs were transmitted using our standardized format and many of the responses could easily be pre-populated by hotels and venues, enabling their employees to respond quickly and accurately.

 

   

Better Analyze Operational Results. Hotels and venues can closely track the volume of potential and actual business that they receive through our CSN, allowing them to more effectively measure the return on marketing investments. Managers can also improve the performance and productivity of their sales representatives by monitoring responsiveness to RFPs and tracking successful bids.

 

79


Table of Contents

Our Competitive Strengths

 

We believe that the following competitive strengths differentiate us from our competitors:

 

End-to-End, Cloud-Based Software Platform. We offer an integrated cloud-based software platform that addresses the entire lifecycle of events and meetings, including budgeting, venue sourcing, event marketing, attendee registration and management, and analytics. Our comprehensive solution helps event and meeting planners seamlessly plan and execute their events, improve the experience for meeting attendees, and capture more actionable data and feedback to help improve future events. This approach also helps our customers reduce implementation time and cost. We believe that our ability to offer a full suite of event and meeting management solutions on a single integrated platform is a key competitive differentiator for us when compared to some of our competitors that typically offer only point solutions.

 

Massive Online Marketplace. We believe that the Cvent Supplier Network is an important resource for event and meeting planners as well as hotels and venues due to its:

 

   

Depth and Breadth of Venue Profiles. Our proprietary network includes detailed meeting profile information on more than 200,000 hotels and other venues, substantially more than the number of venues listed by any of our competitors. Our CSN allows planners to conduct searches and filters based on approximately 200 characteristics and data fields per hotel profile. For example, planners can narrow their search based on a variety of factors such as the number of hotel sleeping rooms or meeting rooms, largest or second largest meeting room size, meeting room ceiling heights, meeting room capacity based on set-up, hotel amenities, available promotions and distance from the airport. Some of this data is generated by the hotels and some is researched by our extensive team, which creates a data set that would not typically be found on any websites or networks other than our own. Our team of account managers and customer-facing staff maintain relationships and work with the venues to keep their information up to date and to enhance the Cvent Supplier Network solution. The size and accuracy of our database is of critical importance to planners.

 

   

RFP Volume. The RFPs sent through the Cvent Supplier Network during the nine months ended September 30, 2013, represented an estimated total of 15.6 million hotel room nights requested and 42.4 million attendee days. For hotel partners that manage the largest number of properties, we believe that our CSN is an important external source for group business leads.

 

   

Integration with Hotels. As of September 30, 2013, more than 139,000 hotel and venue employee users have accounts within our system to respond to RFPs. The level of adoption and back-end IT system integration we experience with our hotel partners is a demonstration of our scale.

 

Powerful Network Effects Across the Value Chain. By bringing together both sides of the value chain, our CSN creates significant network effects.

 

   

Event and meeting planners use our CSN, generally at no cost, to search for venues, request price quotes and proposals from hotels and venues and compare proposals to identify the venue that best meets their needs and requirements. As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 57,000 active CSN event and meeting planner users compared to the approximately 50,000 active CSN event and meeting planner users as of December 31, 2012. According to Frost & Sullivan, for mid-market clients, planners have been able to reduce event venue pricing by up to 15% by using event management software. The Cvent Supplier Network also provides substantial time savings benefits as planners receive fast responses from hotels, in many cases, in less than 24 hours. By offering an efficient, user-friendly marketplace, we attract a high volume of users from both the planner and venue sides of the event lifecycle.

 

   

Hotels and event venues are listed, free-of-charge, in our CSN and can receive and respond to event proposal requests from meeting planners. The level of volume that is processed through our system makes us an essential resource for connecting meeting planners with hotels and other venues. In part

 

80


Table of Contents
 

due to the extensive scope of our marketplace, many hotels have integrated our CSN into their core back-end technical systems. To date, more than 10,000 hotels have also integrated their customer relationship management software systems with our platform, giving us a large scale.

 

As the volume of RFPs delivered to hotels and venues through the Cvent Supplier Network increases, we become even more important to hotels and venues. As more hotels and venues realize the potential of our CSN, the number of listings in our CSN will continue to grow, making it more valuable to event and meeting planners. Greater usage by more event planners increases the volume of RFPs delivered to hotels and venues, thereby increasing the value we deliver to those hotels and venues.

 

LOGO

 

Relationships with Extensive Number of Event and Meeting Planners. Unlike personnel in traditional, clearly defined departments, event and meeting planners can often be found in a number of different corporate departments, such as marketing, sales, travel, human resources, training and development and operations. Many professionals, ranging from marketing managers to sales representatives to executive assistants, are asked to manage and organize events and meetings on an ad hoc basis and dedicate only a portion of their time to meeting planning. It requires significant grassroots marketing acumen to locate event and meeting planners within organizations, but we have worked diligently to create a large, internal, proprietary database of individuals who we believe engage in event and meeting planning activities within their organizations. With the size and scale of our database, as well as our 157,000 aggregate prospect interactions with planners during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 alone, we believe that we are highly effective at proactively and systematically identifying and building relationships with event and meeting planners.

 

Recurring Revenue Model. Our subscription-based model for our event and meeting planner platform along with our annual or multi-year marketing solutions results in strong visibility and predictability of future revenue, enhancing our ability to effectively manage our business. We typically engage meeting planners in annual or multi-year contracts, ranging from two to five years in length. These contracts generally include subscription fees for licensed modules and registration fees with tiered pricing based on the number of event registrants in a year. We also execute annual or multi-year contracts with hotels, event venues and service providers for sponsored marketing solutions in the Cvent Supplier Network.

 

Strategic Capabilities Center in India. As of September 30, 2013, we employed approximately 750 personnel in India. Our Indian operations help us accomplish three important business objectives: (i) near-continuous technical development and customer service, (ii) worldwide geographic reach for marketing efforts and (iii) building and maintaining our proprietary databases. Combining the resources of our U.S. and India

 

81


Table of Contents

operations, we are able to continue technical development and customer support throughout the normal business hours of each region. In addition, our India office houses the majority of our marketing personnel for the Asia-Pacific, Europe, Middle East and Africa regions. Finally, we leverage our India-based personnel to build our extensive event planner contact database and to research and maintain more than 200,000 venues on our CSN. These operations allow us to benefit from the labor and infrastructure cost advantages of the region and to accomplish many critical business tasks in an efficient and cost effective manner.

 

Strong Corporate Culture that Defines Us. Our corporate culture drives and defines us. A number of our senior managers, including seven of the nine executive officers and key employees identified in the “Management” section of this prospectus, have been employed with us since 2000. Their collective experience with our industry and our company help us to effectively navigate the challenges of our business and industry and maintain continuity of our values and culture. We also seek to hire highly talented, enthusiastic employees that will help us foster a positive workplace environment. We offer substantial training opportunities for those employees, including a global exchange program for our U.S. and India-based employees no matter their age or tenure with us. As a result of our efforts, we were named one of the Washington Business Journal’s “Best Places to Work” in the Washington, D.C. metropolitan area for four of the past five years.

 

Our Growth Strategy

 

Key elements of our growth strategy include:

 

Aggressively Pursue New Customers. We believe that there is substantial opportunity to expand our business as adoption of technology platforms to manage events and meetings increases. A 2013 Frost & Sullivan study estimated that 68% of organizations in the mid-market have never licensed event management software, and the majority of mid-market organizations’ events are still planned using manual processes. Likewise, their report also shows that 63% of large enterprises do not have a complete strategic meetings management program in place.

 

Up-Sell and Cross-Sell Existing Event Planner Customers. In recent years, we have expanded our platform by adding new solutions based on continuous customer feedback and requirements. As of September 30, 2013, only 14% of our paying event and meeting planner customers paid us to use more than one of our solutions We believe that there is substantial opportunity within our existing base of 6,700 event and meeting planner customers to cross-sell additional products such as mobile event apps and other add-on functionality, including budgeting features, and enhanced integration with other platforms. Additionally, we believe that we can sell either new subscriptions or additional functionality to our 67,000 event and meeting planner users that freely access CSN, some of which also have a paid subscription to our other event and meeting planner solutions. As we expand our product capabilities to include emerging technologies such as event-specific mobile apps, we expect event and meeting planners will perceive and derive even greater value from our platform and expand their use in the future. We also believe that as we enhance the functionality of our platform through initiatives such as expanded integration with social media tools, our paying customers will not only renew their existing subscriptions but purchase additional functionality as well.

 

Up-Sell and Cross-Sell Existing Hotel Customers. In addition to the annual or multi-year marketing solutions available to increase their visibility in search results on our CSN, hotels and venues can reach an even greater number of meeting planners through other offerings that are a part of our platform. We continue to add specialized marketing placements and create new marketing inventory that hotels or venues can purchase. For example, venues can pay fees to be featured prominently in the Cvent Destination Guide, which is an online resource for planners in the early stages of researching and comparing cities for upcoming meetings. The Cvent Destination Guide received an average of 340,000 page views per month during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and covers 1,000 profiled destinations around the world through more than 11,000 pages of internally developed content to provide planners with destination-specific information and key statistics. Hotels and venues that secure a placement on their market’s Destination Guide benefit from capturing meeting planners’ attention at the beginning stages of their sourcing process.

 

82


Table of Contents

Grow Our Revenue Outside North America. Our strategic focus on global expansion has increased our non-North American revenue from approximately 7% of our revenue for the year ended December 31, 2011 to approximately 9% of revenue for the year ended December 31, 2012 and 10% of revenue for the nine months ended September 30, 2013. Listings outside North America currently account for 58% of the total venues in our CSN, spanning more than 175 countries. As we increase the volume of international meeting RFPs on our CSN, we expect our international revenue to increase correspondingly. To support our international expansion efforts and to increase global sales for all of our solutions, we opened our first European sales office in London in May 2013 and ultimately plan to expand our sales force in Europe. We also plan to introduce select European and Asian language planner interfaces in the near future to strengthen our penetration within European event and meeting planner markets.

 

Further Monetize the Cvent Supplier Network by Creating Value for Hotels and Venues. We intend to leverage our business model to further monetize the Cvent Supplier Network, while adding more value to event and meeting planners and hotels globally. We can increase the value we provide to hotels by offering enhanced marketing solutions and analytics that enable them to better target event and meeting planners and increase their group meeting sales. We also expect to provide hotels and venues with additional marketing models beyond our current offerings, including more targeted options.

 

Expand Our Direct Sales Force and Channel Partners. We intend to expand our direct sales force to augment our current marketing efforts. We believe this will improve our sales coverage and effectiveness, enabling us to acquire new clients. We are also investing significantly in our channel partners. For example, in addition to our existing channel partners, we recently developed a partnership with Concur, which we expect will enable us to better reach their business travel, corporate card and travel and expense clients. We have strategic relationships with many other travel management companies and partners. We will continue to pursue additional strategic relationships wherever it enhances the value proposition for our customers.

 

Enhance Our Mobile Applications and Social Media Offerings. Events, by their nature, are highly interactive and social experiences for attendees and, we believe, very likely to benefit from new technologies and communication mediums such as social networking and mobile applications. A 2013 Frost & Sullivan study noted that, to date, 59% of planners for small and medium-sized enterprises have never used a mobile app for any of their events. We believe, however, that more recently, event attendees have come to expect large events to have a dedicated, native mobile application that allows for interaction among speakers and attendees, provides information to event participants and keeps them up to date on schedule changes. We currently offer a platform that enables event and meeting planners to create and deploy mobile applications for both corporate and large consumer events. We have already made significant investments in the area of social media to enhance the social experience for attendees. We believe that these products and enhancements position us well to capitalize on the growing mobile trend.

 

Continue to Add New Solutions to Our Platform. Investing in research and development is an integral part of our long-term growth strategy and has been a key factor in solidifying our position as a leading cloud-based enterprise event management platform. For example, since 2008, we developed the Cvent Supplier Network, our Strategic Meetings Management solution and the Cvent Destination Guide. We also use customer feedback to regularly implement enhancements and updates to our solutions to further strengthen and fortify our platform and improve the event experience for both planners and attendees.

 

83


Table of Contents

Our Platform

 

Our cloud-based platform consists of six major products: event management software, strategic meetings management software, or SMM, mobile event apps, web surveys, ticketing software and the Cvent Supplier Network, a marketplace that connects more than 200,000 venues with high-quality, ready-to-transact event and meeting planners.

 

LOGO

 

Event Management

 

We provide event and meeting planners with a complete solution to increase attendance and decrease the cost of managing events by stream-lining the event planning process. By automating and simplifying the event planning and management processes, our software enables planners to focus time and resources on strategic decisions rather than repetitive, time-consuming tasks. We enable easy navigation of the entire event planning process by providing a complete platform of products.

 

Our comprehensive solution includes the following key functionalities:

 

   

Online Event Registration. Our event management solution shifts the responsibility from the planner to the attendee by empowering the attendee to register and manage all of their own details online, thereby reducing the burden on the event planner. Attendees can register using email invitations, websites, mobile devices, or onsite at an event. Planners can configure the registration experience to include pre-populated contact information fields, pre- and post-event survey questions, a group registration option, session selection, housing and travel booking, and payment processing in over 100 currencies.

 

   

Event Marketing. Our solution provides robust e-marketing tools that allow planners to efficiently integrate their event marketing and communication process with registration to provide a personalized experience for attendees. It enables extensive creative control for a user without software programming experience, while also supporting established branding initiatives. We also provide integrated marketing functionality, such as event website creation, automated follow up to unresponsive invitees or abandoned registrations, targeted messaging to different invitee segments, email optimization tools, data collection from non-attendees, guest referral tools, integration with major social media and tracking reports.

 

   

Budgeting and Project Management. Our solution includes a project management suite that allows for assignment and tracking of key event planning tasks. Our budgeting toolset allows for tracking of budget, actual costs, and savings. This built-in reporting tracks event spending by vendor, category, business unit, or region, giving the planner key trend intelligence to promote greater savings.

 

84


Table of Contents
   

Event Logistics and Integrations. Our solution includes tools for table and seating management, name badge and certificate creation, resource and space allocation, speaker management, appointment scheduling, continuing education credit tracking, onsite registration and check-in functionality. Our platform integrates with commonly-used, mission critical software such as Salesforce.com, Eloqua, WebEx and Concur, and can be customized to integrate with other existing enterprise or accounting systems.

 

   

Measurement and Reporting. Our platform measures all aspects of the event management process. Users can generate standard or custom reports, view event dashboards and schedule live reports to be sent to key stakeholders across departments. We believe this enables efficient evaluation of return on investment and enhanced ability to closely audit meeting-related activities to ensure regulatory compliance and control expenses.

 

   

Training and Support. We provide comprehensive training and support to our event management subscription customers, which is available through phone, email and the internet during the subscription period. We also maintain an on-line knowledge database and utilize extensive video training that is available on-demand to our customers during the subscription period.

 

In addition to the foregoing functionalities of our Event Management platform, all of our event and meeting planner users that are licensed pursuant to subscriptions to our Event Management platform have the ability to access our CSN product, which is further described in “—Cvent Supplier Network.”

 

Strategic Meetings Management (SMM)

 

We offer our SMM solution for large enterprise customers who hold hundreds or thousands of events and meetings annually, many of which are hosted at off-site locations such as hotels and other venues. In addition to all of the services offered to our event management customers, our SMM platform also helps corporations manage their internal meetings programs more efficiently and manage previously untracked meeting expenditures.

 

With our platform, enterprises gain control over the entire event planning process by managing logistics, budgeting, sourcing, registration, housing, travel and reporting in a single application. As organizations strive to optimize spend across the enterprise, these consolidated processes help corporate travel, meeting and procurement managers gain more visibility into meeting expenditures and have historically enabled cost savings of 15% or more, as compared to companies that host events without a strategic meetings management program. Through our SMM solution, corporate travel, procurement and finance departments have the ability to review the meetings process to ensure compliance with established meeting and expense policies, while still granting creative control over the event to their planners.

 

Mobile Event Apps

 

With the proliferation of smartphones and tablets, we believe mobile applications, or apps, will be used more often at events. We offer planners the ability to generate and customize native apps for both business and consumer events on multiple operating systems, including Android and iOS. Our apps are often used by planners and attendees to: provide schedule and location information; facilitate interaction among attendees, speakers and exhibitors; conduct real-time messaging to build relationships and disseminate information; access rich media content such as video, pictures and internet radio; connect with integrated social media tools such as Facebook, Twitter and LinkedIn; and deliver advertising.

 

Web Surveys

 

Our web survey solution enables our customers to streamline the way they collect information both pre- and post-event. More than 1,200 enterprises and over 10,000 active users utilize our solution to solicit feedback from

 

85


Table of Contents

employees, measure customer satisfaction, capture sales leads and test new product ideas. We consider an event planner to be “active” if such user accessed their account within the 12 months preceding the date of measurement. Event management customers can also collect attendee feedback using our survey capabilities, which provides powerful analytics and insights useful for future events.

 

Ticketing

 

We offer a ticketing and venue management platform that helps venues, promoters and artists improve the efficiency of their operations, increase ticket sales and better engage with their customers. Our easy-to-use platform includes tools to generate website ticket sales, branded emails, print-at-home tickets, and box office and ticket scanning capabilities. Our ticketing solution also integrates with mobile and social media platforms, enabling social buying, sharing, rewarding, tracking, auto-tweeting and auto-publishing.

 

Cvent Supplier Network

 

The Cvent Supplier Network connects event and meeting planners to a comprehensive and searchable global marketplace of more than 200,000 hotels and other event venues. With more than 947,000 RFPs submitted through our system during the nine months ended September 30, 2013, we believe that we operate the world’s largest network dedicated to hotels and unique venues that host events and meetings. Event and meeting planners can access our CSN website at no cost and can quickly search for venues based on very granular, meeting space-specific search criteria, while hotels and venues have the ability to receive and respond to RFPs in a far more efficient manner than RFPs sent through non-automated, non-standardized channels. We have proactively identified and created profiles for every hotel and venue in our database, at no cost to the facility. However, venues can increase their visibility among our users by purchasing annual or multi-year marketing packages, and hotels from major chains and brands around the world currently leverage such opportunities in our CSN to varying degrees.

 

Based on the number of rooms and participant days requested pursuant to unique RFPs transmitted through our CSN during 2013, we estimate that planners sought to source approximately $4.9 billion of business to hotels and venues through the CSN during the nine months ended September 30, 2013, as compared to $4.7 billion in 2012, $3.2 billion in 2011, $2.4 billion in 2010, $613 million in 2009 and $47 million in 2008. This estimate is premised on (i) the average daily hotel room rate of all awarded proposals to RFPs transmitted through our CSN for such year and (ii) a five-year average daily food and beverage rate where applicable. This food and beverage average assumes any RFPs with meeting space consist of a morning break, afternoon break, and lunch. This estimate is premised on RFPs transmitted by planners in each year including those that were never responded to, and may not reflect the actual transactions that ultimately took place, which we generally expect are lower in total dollar value than the estimate above. While we do not earn revenue from our role in facilitating the introduction of the parties to these transactions through the transmission of the RFPs, we believe that the total estimated value of unique RFPs provides an indication of the scale of our network in recent periods.

 

In addition to hotel listings from major chains, including Marriott, Starwood, Hilton and Hyatt, the Cvent Supplier Network also contains profiles for some of the world’s most celebrated and distinguished venues, such as London’s Natural History Museum, Wembley Stadium, The Louvre, Musée d’Orsay, Yankee Stadium, Radio City Music Hall, Fenway Park, Madison Square Garden and Beijing’s National Museum of China. While not all of the venues listed on our network have necessarily hosted an event that was sourced through our CSN or managed events using our event planner solutions, all of these venues are listed within our CSN database as potential locations for event and meeting planners to consider.

 

Aside from the standard listings and annual marketing packages available via the Cvent Supplier Network, hotels and venues can take advantage of additional advertising inventory and models. For example, venues can pay fees to be prominently featured in the Cvent Destination Guide, which is an online resource for planners researching potential destinations for upcoming meetings. The Cvent Destination Guide features 1,000

 

86


Table of Contents

destinations around the world to provide planners with useful, destination-specific information and key statistics. Hotels and venues that secure a placement on their market’s Cvent Destination Guide benefit from increased visibility among an audience of planners and the ability to create additional brand awareness.

 

The CSN is available with the same functionality to users of our paid subscription event and meeting planner platform solutions as well as to event and meeting planners that simply visit the CSN site and establish a free user account.

 

Our Event and Meeting Planner Customers

 

As of September 30, 2013, we had more than 6,700 event and meeting planner customers. We also had 67,000 active user event and meeting planners that freely access CSN, some of which also have a paid subscription to our other event and meeting planner solutions. We consider an event planner user to be “active” if such user accessed their account within 12 months preceding the date of measurement. Their industry profile spans across clients in the retail, consumer products, travel and leisure, technology, telecommunications, financial services, healthcare and automotive verticals, as well as trade associations, government agencies and universities. In each of the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 and the nine months ended September 30, 2013, no event and meeting planner customer represented more than 1% of our revenue for that year. The following table sets forth a list of selected clients as of September 30, 2013 by customer segment:

 

Corporate

Aimia Proprietary Loyalty (formerly Carlson Marketing)

   Merck KGaA

Corporate Executive Board

   Visa

Edwards Lifesciences

   Walmart

Incisive Media

   Wellpoint Health Networks

Maritz Travel Company

  

Association

  

Education

AARP

   Bucknell University

Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE)

   New York University

National Comprehensive Cancer Network (NCCN)

   Penn State University
   Pepperdine University

 

Our Hotel and Venue Customers

 

As of September 30, 2013, more than 5,600 hotels and venues purchased annual or multi-year marketing solutions from us. In each of the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 and for the nine months ended September 30, 2013, no hotel or venue customer represented more than 1% of our revenue for that year. The following table sets forth a list of selected hotel and venue customers as of September 30, 2013:

 

Carlson Rezidor Hotel Group

Fairmont Hotels

Hilton

Hyatt

IHG (InterContinental Hotels Group)

  

Kimpton Hotels

Marriott

Millennium Hotels

Starwood

 

In addition to the paid relationships with hotels and venues, over 10,000 individual hotel properties, including two major U.S. hotel chains, have integrated our software into their back-end IT systems.

 

87


Table of Contents

Sales and Marketing

 

We sell our platform primarily through our direct sales team. The sales and marketing departments are two of our largest divisions by head count. We also work with more than 300 affinity and chapter partners that typically endorse our services worldwide, including leading global travel management and event planning associations.

 

We have been refining our grassroots approach to sales and marketing for more than a decade, with a focus on generating high quality sales leads to secure new business. For example, during the nine months ended September 30, 2013, we conducted more than 157,000 aggregate prospect interactions, including more than 830 large group luncheons and in-person events to meet and educate prospects about our products, as well as more than 1,800 online group demonstrations for potential and existing customers. We also employ a variety of other sales and marketing initiatives, including sponsoring and participating in user conferences, trade shows and industry events; online advertising; managing our own blogs relevant to the industry; hosting webinars; public relations efforts; and social networking. While we believe all of these methods are effective for generating sales leads and attracting new business, we continue to explore other ways to reach customers and prospects, including video marketing, creative social media initiatives and content marketing.

 

Partnerships and Industry Associations

 

We have established partnerships with a number of major travel solutions providers, conference and event managers, and expense management companies, including HelmsBriscoe, ConferenceDirect and Concur. Through these partnerships, we refer their products to our existing customers and receive referrals of their existing customers.

 

We also partner with many leading associations in both the meetings and hospitality industries including Meeting Professionals International (MPI), Association of Corporate Travel Executives (ACTE) and Destination Marketing Association International (DMAI). We have built and maintained strong relationships with these organizations and work closely with them to co-market to meeting planners and hoteliers through a variety of initiatives, including attending and speaking at industry events and hosting educational forums and thought leadership sessions for their members. In most cases, these, and other industry partners, including hundreds of chapter organizations, are our customers and use our solution, giving us strong market and brand credibility.

 

Our Technology

 

We deliver our solutions using a cloud-based software-as-a-service model that we developed. This affords our clients quick, easy and near global reach of our solutions. Our cloud-based delivery model also limits involvement from our clients’ technical teams, and reduces implementation time and costs. We have developed a multi-tenant architecture and a secure, scalable and highly available technology platform that provides a high degree of customization to allow each customer to configure the business process workflow, branding and user interface to best meet their individual needs.

 

The architecture, design, deployment and management of our cloud-based platform are focused on the following:

 

Multi-Tenant Architecture. Our multi-tenant architecture enables all customers to be on the same version of our solutions. When we improve existing functionality, all customers receive the benefit of the new version at the same time.

 

Secure, Scalable and Highly Available Technology Platform. Our clients often rely on our solutions for their most important and largest events and meetings. To meet their demanding expectations, we designed a technology platform that is secure, scalable and highly available. We regularly review the key facets of our platform, making regular improvements and enhancements to keep pace with growth and technology evolution.

 

88


Table of Contents

We maintain a comprehensive security program designed to protect our systems and our clients’ data. We also select service providers who adhere to best practices and industry standards, such as Statement on Standards for Attestation Engagements No. 16, or SSAE 16, whenever possible. Writing secure code is an integral part of our software development methodology, as well. We augment this practice with regular application and network security testing and periodic manual, third-party application and network penetration testing.

 

We designed our software and systems to handle substantial growth in users and data without requiring significant re-engineering. For example, our Event Management system processed over three times as many registrations in 2012 as compared to 2007, and it managed the additional scale without having to significantly alter our investment in hardware as a percentage of revenue.

 

We primarily host our solutions from a third-party data center in Ashburn, Virginia. Within the data center, our network, server and storage infrastructure is highly redundant and fault-tolerant, and is continuously monitored by both automated systems, as well as a dedicated operations team. We also have a standby data center that is available in case the primary data center is not functioning for any reason.

 

Integrated Real-Time Analytics Capabilities. Our platform’s analytics and reporting capabilities allow clients to derive powerful, real-time insights. Hundreds of standard reports along with a robust, proprietary custom reporting engine allow clients to more easily recognize shifts in attendee sentiment, identify potential issues and make well-informed decisions. This insight enables better event organization and enhances future event return on investment. Our integrated analytics and reporting capabilities also allow our clients to more efficiently and accurately audit their event and meeting spending. By providing these features, we enable our customers to control their budgets and ensure their compliance with regulations in their respective industries.

 

Mobile and Ticketing Offerings

 

Our mobile and ticketing products are hosted on leading infrastructure-as-a-service platforms. These third-party services allow us to rapidly scale computing resources up or down as demanded. This flexibility is advantageous due to the highly variable usage of mobile event applications and online ticket sales, allowing us to minimize capital expenditures.

 

With respect to mobile offerings, we generally focus on native mobile event apps, primarily for iOS and Android devices. This strategy allows us to create apps for clients that function effectively, even in environments with weak, saturated or non-existent Internet connectivity. We designed our mobile application platform to facilitate rapid creation of mobile event apps, while still allowing a high degree of individual app customization.

 

Product Development

 

Our research and development effort is focused both on developing new software and on improving our existing products. Our engineering team works closely with customers and event attendees to identify their current and future needs. We believe that innovation and timely development of new features and products is essential to meeting the needs of our end-customer and improving our competitive position. We supplement our own research and development effort with technologies and products that we license from third parties. We test our products thoroughly to certify and ensure interoperability with third-party hardware and software products. Our U.S. and India personnel develop our products on a nearly continual basis, five days a week.

 

Our research and development expenses totaled $4.2 million and $7.6 million, representing 7% and 9% of our revenue, for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively, and $5.4 million and $8.1 million in the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013, representing 9% and 10% of our total revenue, respectively. We plan to continue to significantly invest resources for our research and development efforts.

 

89


Table of Contents

Competition

 

We operate in an intensely competitive market that is characterized by constant change and innovation. Our competition includes:

 

   

existing manual, paper and spreadsheet-based systems that corporate personnel employ to organize events by themselves in a fragmented manner. For example, a significant number of planners process registrations by asking attendees to fill out PDF forms and aggregate that information manually using various office tools. They also frequently lack the ability to process registration payments online. Venue searches and bookings are often processed either by phone or email, while tracking of budget and expense is done on an ad-hoc basis through spreadsheets;

 

   

event and meeting management firms such as The Active Network, primarily through its StarCite business that it acquired in 2012;

 

   

online event registration vendors focused primarily on consumer ticketing such as Eventbrite; and

 

   

small and large companies that offer point solutions that compete with some of the features present in our platform, such as registration management, travel management, venue bookings, web survey providers, email marketers and mobile app developers.

 

We believe that we generally compete favorably with our competitors because of the features and performance of our various offerings, the ease of integration of our solutions with the technological infrastructures of both event planners as well as the venues and the incremental return on investment that our platform offers to our customers.

 

Customer Support

 

Our customer support organization is available to our event management subscription customers 24 hours per day, seven days per week and can be contacted via phone, email and the internet during the subscription period. We also provide similar support for CSN, mobile and survey customers during regular business days. As of September 30, 2013, we had 290 employees dedicated to customer support and professional services in our locations in the United States and India. We also maintain an online knowledge database and utilize extensive video training that is available on-demand to our customers during the subscription period.

 

Intellectual Property

 

Our ability to protect our intellectual property, including our technology, is and will be an important factor in the success and continued growth of our business. We primarily protect our intellectual property through trade secrets, copyrights, trademarks and contracts.

 

Some of our technology relies upon third-party licensed intellectual property incorporated into our software solutions. We are not materially dependent upon these third-party providers.

 

We own U.S. registered trademarks for CVENT, CVENT.COM, REACH THE RESPONSE, CROWDCOMPASS and CROWDTORCH. We have pending trademark applications for CVENT, CROWDCOMPASS and CROWDTORCH in the European Union, Canada, Australia and China. In addition, TicketMob LLC, our subsidiary, owns U.S. registered trademarks for TICKETMOB, LAUGHSTUB, TUNESTUB and ELECTROSTUB. We also have one patent application pending in the United States.

 

We have also established business procedures designed to maintain the confidentiality of our proprietary information, including the use of confidentiality agreements and assignment-of-inventions agreements with employees, independent contractors, consultants and companies with which we conduct business.

 

For important additional information related to our intellectual property position, please review the information set forth in “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Our Business and Industry.”

 

90


Table of Contents

Regulation

 

Although we do not believe that significant existing laws or government regulations adversely impact us, our business could be affected by different interpretations or applications of existing laws or regulations, future laws or regulations or actions by domestic or foreign regulatory agencies. Failure to comply with these and other laws and regulations may result in, among other consequences, administrative enforcement actions and fines, class action lawsuits and civil and criminal liability.

 

Many jurisdictions impose an obligation on any entity that holds personally identifiable information to adopt appropriate security to protect such data against unauthorized access, misuse, destruction, or modification. Many jurisdictions have enacted laws requiring holders of personal information to take certain actions in response to data breach incidents, such as providing prompt notification of the breach to affected individuals and government authorities. We have implemented and maintain physical, technical and administrative safeguards intended to protect all personal data and have processes in place to assist us in complying with applicable laws and regulations regarding the protection of this data and properly responding to any security incidents. We have adopted a system security plan and security breach incident response plans to address our compliance with these laws.

 

For important information related to government regulation of our business, please review the information set forth in “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Our Business and Industry.”

 

Geographic Areas

 

For information with respect to our geographic markets, see note 13 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

Employees

 

As of September 30, 2013, we had approximately 1,400 full-time employees. Of that total, approximately 750 were based in Gurgaon, India; 547 were based in McLean, Virginia; and the remaining were in our various offices in Texas, California, Washington and Oregon. By department, 667 were in sales and marketing (of which 198 were dedicated to development of our proprietary databases), 270 in product development, 75 in technology operations, and 134 in general and administrative. None of our employees is represented by a labor organization or is a party to any collective bargaining arrangement. We have never had a work stoppage, and we consider our relationship with our employees to be good.

 

We are proud to offer a global exchange program for our employees, and we encourage our employees from all of our offices to take advantage of this opportunity to work overseas with their counterparts. Under the exchange program, several employees from our U.S. offices spent between four and eight weeks each working in our India office, and a number of our employees from our India office participated in a similar exchange in our U.S. offices. We believe this program offers our employees the opportunity for exciting international travel while also providing valuable work experience, notwithstanding their age or tenure with the company. We further believe that this program helps us to foster efficient communication between offices and strengthens and unifies our corporate culture.

 

Facilities

 

We currently lease approximately 66,106 square feet of space for our corporate headquarters in McLean, Virginia under a lease agreement that expires in July 2014. We also lease approximately 70,000 square feet of space for our Gurgaon, India office under a lease agreement that expires in April 2018. Both of these offices are used for administrative, marketing, support and development operations. In connection with our sales efforts, we also lease office space in Austin, Texas; Portland, Oregon; Los Angeles, California; and London, England.

 

91


Table of Contents

In October 2013, we signed a new lease for office space in McLean, VA that will replace our corporate headquarters when that lease expires in 2014. The new lease is for a fixed 11-year term with options for two additional renewal terms of five years each. The new lease will cover approximately 129,000 square feet of office space. We expect to occupy our new headquarters beginning in August 2014, subject to completion of upgrades and other agreed pre-occupancy preparation.

 

We believe that our current facilities and planned expansion facilities will be adequate for the foreseeable future; however, we will continue to seek additional space as needed to satisfy our growth.

 

Legal Proceedings

 

From time to time, we may become involved in legal proceedings in the ordinary course of our business. We are not presently a party to any legal proceedings that, if determined adversely to us, would individually or in the aggregate have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition or cash flows.

 

92


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT

 

Executive Officers and Directors

 

The following table sets forth information concerning our directors and executive officers including their ages as of December 31, 2013:

 

Name

   Age     

Position(s)

Executive Officers:

     

Rajeev “Reggie” K. Aggarwal

     44       President, Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors, Class I Director

Peter L. Childs

     50       Chief Financial Officer

Charles V. Ghoorah

     44       Executive Vice President of Sales and Marketing

David Quattrone

     40       Chief Technology Officer

Lawrence J. Samuelson

     44       Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary

Dwayne J. Sye

     39       Chief Information Officer

Non-Employee Directors:

     

Sanju K. Bansal(1)(2)

     48       Class II Director

Tony Florence(1)(3)

     45       Class III Director

Jeffrey Lieberman(2)(3)

     39       Class III Director

Kevin T. Parker(2)(3)

     54       Class I Director

Other Key Employees:

     

Manjula R. Aggarwal

  

   Senior Vice President of Client Services

Brian Ludwig

  

   Senior Vice President of Sales

Bharet Malhotra

  

   Senior Vice President of Sales

 

(1)   Member of the nominating and governance committee.
(2)   Member of the compensation committee.
(3)   Member of the audit committee.

 

Executive Officers

 

Reggie K. Aggarwal is the founder of our company and has served as our President, Chief Executive Officer and the Chairman of our board of directors since our inception in 1999. Mr. Aggarwal received a bachelor of science degree from the University of Virginia, a juris doctor degree from Washington and Lee University and a master of laws degree from Georgetown University. The board of directors believes that Mr. Aggarwal’s knowledge of our company as our founder allows him to make valuable contributions to the board of directors.

 

Peter L. Childs is our Chief Financial Officer. Prior to joining Cvent in November 2012, Mr. Childs was the Chief Accounting Officer and Controller at Towers Watson & Co., a human capital and financial management consulting firm from 1999 to 2012. Prior to joining Towers Watson, Mr. Childs served as the vice president of finance and treasurer at HCR Manor Care. Mr. Childs received a bachelor of science degree from Brigham Young University and a master of business administration degree from George Washington University.

 

Charles V. Ghoorah is a co-founder of our company. From 1999 to 2002, he served as our Senior Vice President of Sales and Marketing, and from 2003 to present, he has served as our Executive Vice President of Sales and Marketing. Prior to joining Cvent, Mr. Ghoorah was an associate with Hale & Dorr, an associate director with the Advisory Board Company and an attorney with Williams & Connolly. Mr. Ghoorah received bachelor of arts, master of arts and juris doctor degrees from Duke University.

 

93


Table of Contents

David Quattrone is a co-founder of our company. From 1999 to 2002, he served as the Director of Product Development; from 2003 to 2008, he served as the Vice President of Product Development; and from 2008 to present, he has served as the Chief Technology Officer. Prior to joining Cvent, Mr. Quattrone worked at First Consulting Group, E.J. Bell Systems and co-founded Network Resources Group. Mr. Quattrone received bachelor of science degrees in electrical engineering and economics from the University of Pennsylvania and a master of business administration degree from the University of Maryland.

 

Lawrence J. Samuelson became our Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary in June 2013. Prior to joining Cvent, from 2011 through 2013, Mr. Samuelson served as the Vice President, Deputy General Counsel and Corporate Secretary of NeuStar, Inc., an information services and analytics company. From 2009 through 2010, Mr. Samuelson was the Assistant General Counsel and Assistant Secretary of DynCorp International, Inc., a government contractor. From 2008 through 2009, he served as the Deputy General Counsel of Enterra Solutions, LLC, a SaaS start-up. He was also an associate at Fried Frank Harris Shriver and Jacobson. Mr. Samuelson received a bachelor of arts degree from Tufts University, a master of international affairs from Columbia University and a juris doctor degree from Boston University.

 

Dwayne J. Sye is a co-founder of our company. From 1999 to 2002, he served as the Director of Technology; from 2003 to 2008, he served as the Vice President of Technology; and from 2008 to present, he has served as the Chief Information Officer. Prior to joining Cvent, Mr. Sye was a consultant with MicroStrategy and Ernst & Young. Mr. Sye received a bachelor of science degree in engineering from the University of Pennsylvania.

 

Non-Employee Directors

 

Sanju K. Bansal has served as a director of our company since November 1999. Mr. Bansal has served as chief executive officer of Hunch Analytics since November 2013. Prior to founding Hunch Analytics, Mr. Bansal served in various executive leadership positions with MicroStrategy Incorporated from 1990 to 2013. He held the titles of executive vice president from 1993 to 2013 and chief operating officer from 1994 to 2012, and served as a member of MicroStrategy Incorporated’s board of directors from 1997 to 2013. Mr. Bansal served as the vice chairman of the MicroStrategy Incorporated board of directors from November 2000 to November 2013. Prior to joining MicroStrategy, Mr. Bansal was a consultant at Booz Allen Hamilton, a worldwide technical and management consulting firm, from 1987 to 1990. Mr. Bansal serves as a member of the board of directors of The Advisory Board Company, a research services company listed on the Nasdaq Global Select Market. He received a bachelor of science degree in electrical engineering from the Massachusetts Institute of Technology and a master of science in computer science degree from the Johns Hopkins University. The board of directors believes that Mr. Bansal’s experience in working with entrepreneurial companies and his particular familiarity with technology companies allow him to make valuable contributions to the board of directors.

 

Tony Florence has served as a director of our company since July 2011. Mr. Florence is a General Partner of the venture capital firm New Enterprise Associates, or NEA, which he joined in 2008. He co-leads NEA’s Venture Growth Equity investment practice as well as the firm’s Consumer Internet effort. Mr. Florence currently serves as a director of several private companies. Prior to joining NEA, Mr. Florence was a Managing Director at Morgan Stanley and was Head of Technology Banking in New York, and was also a member of the North American Management Committee for investment banking. Mr. Florence received a bachelor of arts degree in economics and a master of business administration degree from Dartmouth College. The board of directors believes that Mr. Florence’s broad investment experience in the technology industry allows him to make valuable contributions to the board of directors.

 

Jeffrey Lieberman has served as a member of our board of directors since July 2011. Mr. Lieberman is a Managing Director of the venture capital firm Insight Venture Management, LLC, or Insight, where he has been employed since June 1998. Prior to joining Insight, Mr. Lieberman was a management consultant at the New York office of McKinsey & Company, where he focused on strategic and operating issues in the financial services, technology and consumer products industries. Mr. Lieberman currently serves as a director of

 

94


Table of Contents

Shutterstock, Inc., a public company, and as a director of several private companies. Mr. Lieberman holds a bachelor of applied science degree in systems engineering and a bachelor of arts degree in economics from the University of Pennsylvania. The board of directors believes that Mr. Lieberman’s broad investment experience in the technology industry allows him to make valuable contributions to the board of directors.

 

Kevin T. Parker has been a director since July 2013. Mr. Parker is a co-Founder and managing principal of Bridge Growth Partners. Bridge Growth Partners, LLC is a structured growth-oriented private equity firm that focuses on investments in the technology and financial services sectors. Mr. Parker served as President and Chief Executive Officer of Deltek, Inc., a provider of enterprise software applications, from June 2005 to December 2012 and as Chairman of the board of directors of Deltek from April 2006 to December 2012. As Deltek’s Chief Executive Officer, Mr. Parker was named Ernst & Young Entrepreneur of the Year 2012 in the software services category in Greater Washington, D.C. Prior to joining Deltek, Mr. Parker served as Co-President of PeopleSoft, Inc., an enterprise application software company, from October 2004 to December 2004, as Executive Vice President of Finance and Administration and Chief Financial Officer of PeopleSoft from January 2002 to October 2004, and as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of PeopleSoft from October 2000 to December 2001. Prior to joining PeopleSoft, Mr. Parker served as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer from 1999 to 2000 at Aspect Communications Corporation, a customer relationship management software company. Mr. Parker currently serves as Chairman of the board of directors of Polycom, Inc., a publicly-traded provider of unified communications and collaboration solutions for voice and video collaboration. Mr. Parker holds a bachelor of science degree in accounting from Clarkson University and sits on its board of trustees. The board of directors believes that Mr. Parker’s experience as an audit committee financial expert and a recognized technology industry leader with significant senior management and operational experience allows him to make valuable contributions to the board of directors.

 

Other Key Employees

 

Manjula R. Aggarwal has been with our company since 2000. From 2000 to 2001, she served as the Senior Manager of Client Services; from 2001 to 2004, she served as the Director of Client Services; from 2004 to 2007, she served as the Vice President of Client Services; and from 2007 to present she has served as the Senior Vice President of Client Services. Prior to joining Cvent, Ms. Aggarwal worked as a manager for Ernst & Young Consulting Services. Ms. Aggarwal received a bachelor of science from Virginia Polytechnic Institute and State University and a master of science degree from George Mason University. Ms. Aggarwal is the sister of our President and Chief Executive Officer, Mr. Aggarwal.

 

Brian Ludwig has been with our company since 2000. From 2000 to 2005, he served as a Sales Executive; from 2005 to 2007, he served as a Director of Sales; from 2007 to 2012, he served as a Vice President of Sales; and he currently serves as a Senior Vice President of Sales. Mr. Ludwig oversees the sales for our event and mobile divisions. Prior to joining Cvent, Mr. Ludwig worked as a sales director for Lutron Electronics, Inc. Mr. Ludwig received a bachelor of business administration degree from Emory University and a master of business administration degree from the University of Maryland.

 

Bharet Malhotra has been with our company since 2000. From 2000 to 2005, he served as a Sales Executive; from 2005 to 2007, he served as a Director of Sales; from 2007 to 2012, he served as a Vice President of Sales; and he currently serves as a Senior Vice President of Sales. Mr. Malhotra oversees the sales for our CSN division, account management and ticketing divisions. Prior to joining Cvent, Mr. Malhotra worked as a manager for WorldCom and as an investment banker for Salomon Smith Barney. Mr. Malhotra received a bachelor of science degree from Duke University.

 

Board Composition

 

Pursuant to a Voting Agreement dated July 15, 2011, among us and certain holders of our common and preferred stock, Messrs. Florence and Lieberman were appointed to our board of directors by certain of our stockholders. Mr. Florence was designated by NEA and its affiliates, and Mr. Lieberman was designated by Insight and its affiliates. Such Voting Agreement terminated upon the completion of our IPO.

 

95


Table of Contents

Our directors are divided into three classes serving staggered three-year terms. Class I, Class II and Class III directors will serve until our annual meetings of stockholders in 2014, 2015 and 2016, respectively. Upon expiration of the term of a class of directors, directors in that class will be eligible to be elected for a new three-year term at the annual meeting of stockholders in the year in which their term expires. As a result of this classification of directors, it generally takes at least two annual meetings of stockholders for stockholders to effect a change in a majority of the members of our board of directors.

 

Our board of directors currently consists of five members. Two are Class I directors and will serve until our annual meeting of stockholders in 2014. One is a Class II director and will serve until our annual meeting of stockholders in 2015. Two are Class III directors and will serve until our annual meeting of stockholders in 2016.

 

Director Independence

 

Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange. Under the rules of the New York Stock Exchange, independent directors must comprise a majority of a listed company’s board of directors within a specified period after completion of our IPO. In addition, the rules of the New York Stock Exchange require that, subject to specified exceptions, each member of a listed company’s audit, compensation and nominating and governance committees be independent. Audit committee members must also satisfy the independence criteria set forth in Rule 10A-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. Under the rules of the New York Stock Exchange, a director will only qualify as an “independent director” if, in the opinion of that company’s board of directors, that person does not have a relationship that would interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the responsibilities of a director.

 

In order to be considered to be independent for purposes of Rule 10A-3, a member of an audit committee of a listed company may not, other than in his or her capacity as a member of the audit committee, the board of directors, or any other board committee: (1) accept, directly or indirectly, any consulting, advisory, or other compensatory fee from the listed company or any of its subsidiaries; or (2) be an affiliated person of the listed company or any of its subsidiaries.

 

Our board of directors undertook a review of its composition, the composition of its committees and the independence of each director. Based upon information requested from and provided by each director concerning his background, employment and affiliations, including family relationships, our board of directors has determined that Messrs. Bansal, Florence, Lieberman and Parker, representing four of our five directors, do not have any relationships that would interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the responsibilities of a director and that each of these directors is “independent” as that term is defined under the rules of the New York Stock Exchange. In making these determinations, our board of directors considered the relationships that each non-employee director has with our company and all other facts and circumstances our board of directors deemed relevant in determining their independence, including the beneficial ownership of our capital stock by each non-employee director.

 

Board Committees

 

Our board of directors has established an audit committee, a compensation committee and a nominating and governance committee.

 

Audit Committee

 

Our audit committee consists of Messrs. Florence, Lieberman and Parker, with Mr. Parker serving as chairman. In accordance with our audit committee charter, our audit committee shall: oversee our corporate accounting and financial reporting processes and our internal controls over financial reporting; evaluate the independent public accounting firm’s qualifications, independence and performance; engage and provide for the compensation of the independent public accounting firm; approve the retention of the independent public

 

96


Table of Contents

accounting firm to perform any proposed permissible non-audit services; review our consolidated financial statements; review our critical accounting policies and estimates and internal controls over financial reporting; and discuss with management and the independent registered public accounting firm the results of the annual audit and the reviews of our quarterly consolidated financial statements. We believe that our audit committee members meet the requirements for financial literacy under the current requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the New York Stock Exchange as well as SEC rules and regulations. In addition, the board of directors has determined that Mr. Parker is qualified as an audit committee financial expert within the meaning of SEC regulations. We have made this determination based on information received by our board of directors, including questionnaires provided by the members of our audit committee.

 

Compensation Committee

 

Our compensation committee consists of Messrs. Bansal, Lieberman and Parker, with Mr. Lieberman serving as chair. In accordance with our compensation committee charter, our compensation committee shall review and recommend policies relating to compensation and benefits of our officers and employees, including reviewing and approving corporate goals and objectives relevant to compensation of the Chief Executive Officer and other senior officers, evaluating the performance of these officers in light of those goals and objectives and setting compensation of these officers based on such evaluations. The compensation committee will also administer the issuance of stock options and other awards under our equity-based incentive plans. We believe that the composition of our compensation committee meets the requirements for independence under, and the functioning of our compensation committee complies with, any applicable requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the New York Stock Exchange and SEC rules and regulations. We intend to comply with future requirements to the extent they become applicable to us. Our board of directors had not established a compensation committee prior to July 2013, and as such all members of our board of directors participated in a number of the deliberations concerning 2013 executive officer compensation prior to such date. In December 2013, the Compensation Committee approved the 2013 cash bonuses earned by the executive officers named herein.

 

Nominating and Governance Committee

 

Our nominating and governance committee consists of Messrs. Bansal and Florence with Mr. Bansal serving as chairman. In accordance with our nominating and governance committee charter, our nominating and governance committee shall: recommend to the board of directors nominees for election as directors, and meet as necessary to review director candidates and nominees for election as directors; recommend members for each committee of the board; oversee corporate governance standards and compliance with applicable listing and regulatory requirements; develop and recommend to the board governance principles applicable to the company; and oversee the evaluation of the board and its committees. We believe that the composition of our nominating and governance committee meets the requirements for independence under, and the functioning of our compensation committee complies with, any applicable requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the New York Stock Exchange and SEC rules and regulations. We intend to comply with future requirements to the extent they become applicable to us.

 

Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

 

Our board of directors has adopted a code of business conduct and ethics, which establishes the standards of ethical conduct applicable to all directors, officers and employees of our company. The code addresses, among other things, conflicts of interest, compliance with disclosure controls and procedures and internal controls over financial reporting, corporate opportunities and confidentiality requirements.

 

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

 

None of the members of our compensation committee is an executive officer or employee of our company. None of our executive officers serves as a member of the board of directors or compensation committee of any entity that has one or more executive officers serving on our board of directors or compensation committee.

 

97


Table of Contents

Director Compensation

 

None of our non-employee directors was compensated for service on the board of directors prior to July 2013. In July 2013, we adopted a non-employee director compensation policy that became effective upon the closing of our IPO in August 2013. Under that policy:

 

   

Initial Equity Award. Each person who first becomes a non-employee director will be granted an award of restricted stock with a target value of $100,000.

 

   

Annual Equity Award. Each non-employee director may be granted an award of equity on the date of the annual meeting of stockholders.

 

   

Annual Cash Retainer. Each non-employee director will receive an annual cash retainer of $35,000.

 

   

Audit Committee Chairperson Retainer Fee. Any non-employee director serving as the chairperson of the audit committee will receive an annual cash retainer of $25,000.

 

   

Committee Member Fee. Each non-employee director serving as a member of the audit, compensation or nominating and governance committee will receive an annual cash retainer of $5,000.

 

For the purposes of this policy, none of Messrs. Bansal, Florence or Lieberman shall be deemed to be a non-employee director, until they no longer directly or indirectly beneficially own 5% or more of the outstanding shares of our capital stock. Accordingly, none of these three directors will be compensated for service on the board of directors unless and until their beneficial ownership falls below this percentage level.

 

We also reimburse director expenses for attending meetings of the board of directors.

 

The following table sets forth information regarding the compensation earned for service on our board of directors during the year ended December 31, 2013 by our directors who were not also our employees. Reggie K. Aggarwal, our President and Chief Executive Officer, is also a director but does not receive any additional compensation for his services as a director. Mr. Aggarwal’s compensation as an executive officer is set forth elsewhere in this prospectus at “Executive Compensation—Summary Compensation Table.”

 

Name

   Fees Earned or
Paid in Cash ($)
     Stock Awards
($)(1)
     All Other
Compensation

($)
     Total
($)
 

Sanju K. Bansal

                               

Tony Florence

                               

Jeffrey Lieberman

                               

Kevin T. Parker

   $ 24,728       $ 100,000               $ 124,728   

 

  (1)   The amounts reported represent the aggregate fair value of the stock awarded to the named executive officer at the date of grant calculated in accordance with FASB Accounting Standards Codification Topic 718. Such grant-date fair value does not take into account any estimated forfeitures related to service-vesting conditions. The assumptions used in calculating the grant date fair value of the awards reported in this column are set forth in note 6 to our unaudited interim financial statements included in this prospectus.

 

The table below shows the aggregate number of option and stock awards outstanding for each of our non-employee directors as of December 31, 2013:

 

Name

   Shares Subject
to Option
     Stock Awards
Subject to  Restriction
 

Sanju K. Bansal

               

Tony Florence

               

Jeffrey Lieberman

               

Kevin T. Parker

             5,555 (1) 

 

  (1)   All restricted stock units held subject to forfeiture until July 5, 2014 pursuant to a restricted stock award granted on October 18, 2013.

 

98


Table of Contents

Limitations on Director and Officer Liability and Indemnification

 

Our certificate of incorporation limits the liability of our directors to the maximum extent permitted by Delaware law. Delaware law provides that directors of a corporation will not be personally liable for monetary damages for breach of their fiduciary duties as directors, except liability for:

 

   

any breach of their duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders;

 

   

acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law;

 

   

unlawful payments of dividends or unlawful stock repurchases or redemptions; or

 

   

any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit.

 

Our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws provide that we are required to indemnify our directors and officers, in each case to the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law. Any repeal of or modification to our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws may not adversely affect any right or protection of a director or officer for or with respect to any acts or omissions of such director or officer occurring prior to such amendment or repeal. Our bylaws also provide that we shall advance expenses incurred by a director or officer in advance of the final disposition of any action or proceeding, and permit us to secure insurance on behalf of any officer, director, employee or other agent for any liability arising out of his or her actions in connection with their services to us, regardless of whether our bylaws permit such indemnification.

 

We have entered into separate indemnification agreements with our directors and executive officers, in addition to the indemnification provided for in our bylaws. These agreements, among other things, provide that we will indemnify our directors and executive officers for certain expenses (including attorneys’ fees), judgments, fines, penalties and settlement amounts incurred by a director or executive officer in any action or proceeding arising out of such person’s services as one of our directors or executive officers, or any other company or enterprise to which the person provides services at our request. We believe that these provisions and agreements are necessary to attract and retain qualified persons as directors and executive officers.

 

The limitation of liability and indemnification provisions contained in our certificate of incorporation and our bylaws may discourage stockholders from bringing a lawsuit against our directors for breach of their fiduciary duty. They may also reduce the likelihood of derivative litigation against our directors and officers, even though an action, if successful, might benefit us and other stockholders. Further, a stockholder’s investment may be adversely affected to the extent that we pay the costs of settlement and damage awards against directors and officers as required by these indemnification provisions. There is no pending litigation or proceeding involving one of our directors or executive officers as to which indemnification is required or permitted, and we are not aware of any threatened litigation or proceeding that may result in a claim for indemnification.

 

99


Table of Contents

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

 

Summary Compensation Table

 

The following table sets forth summary information concerning compensation for the following persons: (i) all persons serving as our principal executive officer during 2013 and (ii) up to two of the most highly compensated of our other executive officers who received compensation during 2013 of at least $100,000 and who were executive officers on December 31, 2013. We refer to these persons as our “named executive officers” elsewhere in this prospectus. The following table includes all compensation earned by the named executive officers for the respective periods, regardless of whether such amounts were actually paid during the period.

 

Name and Principal Position

  Year     Salary
($)
    Bonus
($)
    Option
Awards

($)
    Non-Equity
Incentive  Plan
Compensation
($)
    All Other
Compensation
($)
    Total
($)
 

Reggie K. Aggarwal

    2013      $ 384,097      $ 101,871                           $ 485,968   

President and Chief Executive Officer

    2012        365,796        97,020                             462,816   

Charles V. Ghoorah

    2013        237,048        46,305             $ 155,161 (2)             438,514   

Executive Vice President of Sales and Marketing

    2012        225,750        44,100               148,815 (2)             418,665   

Peter L. Childs

    2013        320,011        83,500      $ 823,752 (1)                    1,227,263   

Chief Financial Officer

    2012 (3)             

 

  (1)   The amounts reported represent the aggregate fair value of the stock options awarded to the named executive officer at the date of grant calculated in accordance with FASB Accounting Standards Codification Topic 718. Such grant-date fair value does not take into account any estimated forfeitures related to service-vesting conditions. The assumptions used in calculating the grant date fair value of the stock options reported in this column are set forth in note 6 to our unaudited interim financial statements included in this prospectus.
  (2)   Amounts represent annual performance incentive payments, or prorated portions, awarded by our board of directors.
  (3)   Mr. Childs was not a named executive officer in 2012 and his compensation information was not otherwise disclosed during that period.

 

Outstanding Equity Awards at December 31, 2013

 

The following table shows outstanding option awards held by the named executive officers as of December 31, 2013. No named executive officer held unvested stock awards as of December 31, 2013.

 

     Option Awards  
     Number of Securities
Underlying Unexercised
Options (#)
    Option
Exercise
Price($)
     Option
Expiration
Date
 

Name

   Exercisable     Unexercisable       

Reggie K. Aggarwal

            212,125 (1)    $ 1.80         03/11/2021   

Charles V. Ghoorah

     80,436 (2)      92,935 (2)      1.80         03/11/2021   

Peter L. Childs

            162,500 (3)      9.00         01/8/2023   

 

  (1)   This option award has been amended to include an early exercise feature. In June 2012, Reggie K. Aggarwal effected the early exercise feature. As a result, Mr. Aggarwal owns the shares represented by this option, subject to our right of repurchase. This right of repurchase lapsed as to 212,126 shares on February 1, 2013. The right of repurchase will lapse as to an additional 106,063 shares and 106,062 shares of February 1, 2014 and 2015, respectively, in each case subject to Mr. Aggarwal’s continued service as of each such date.
  (2)   46,468 of the shares subject to this option shall vest on February 1, 2014 and 46,467 of the shares subject to this option shall vest February 1, 2015, in each case subject to Mr. Ghoorah’s continued service as of each such date.
  (3)   121,875 of the shares subject to this option shall vest on November 5, 2015 and 40,625 of the shares subject to this option shall on vest November 5, 2016, in each case subject to Mr. Childs’s continued service as of each such date.

 

100


Table of Contents

Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-In-Control

 

Potential Payments upon Change-In-Control

 

We believe that it is important to protect our named executive officers in the event of a change in control transaction involving our company, as a result of which such officers might have their employment terminated. In addition, we believe that the interests of management should be aligned with those of our stockholders as much as possible, and we believe that providing protection upon a change in control is an appropriate counter to any disincentive such officers might otherwise perceive in regard to transactions that may be in the best interest of our stockholders. As a result of these considerations by our board of directors, our option agreements with our named executive officers provide for certain vesting benefits in connection with a change in control of our company.

 

We are parties to option agreements with each of our named executive officers that provide for certain vesting benefits in connection with a change in control of our company. The key terms of our arrangements upon a change in control for these named executive officers are as follows:

 

Name

   Value of Options
Accelerated Upon a Change-
in-Control
    Value of Options Accelerated
Upon a Change-in-Control and
Termination of Employment
within Six Months Thereafter
 

Reggie K. Aggarwal

   $ 2,568,065 (1)(2)    $ 2,568,065 (1)(2) 

Charles V. Ghoorah

   $ 1,125,109 (1)(2)    $ 1,125,109 (1)(2) 

Peter L. Childs

   $ (3)    $ 4,450,875 (1)(3) 

 

  (1)   Amounts included in the table for stock option acceleration are calculated as the difference between an assumed fair market value of $36.39 per share of our common stock, the closing price of our common stock as reported by the New York Stock Exchange on December 31, 2013, and the exercise price of the option, multiplied by the number of accelerated shares.
  (2)   Messrs. Aggarwal and Ghoorah are both subject to agreements whereby 35% of the then-unvested shares of stock subject to their respective options granted on March 11, 2011, each with an exercise price of $1.80 per share, accelerate upon a change in control. Assuming a change of control on December 31, 2013, the unvested shares subject to acceleration were as follows:

 

Name

   Unvested Shares Subject to
Option Accelerated
 

Reggie K. Aggarwal

     74,243   

Charles V. Ghoorah

     32,527   

 

  (3)   Mr. Childs is subject to an agreement whereby he shall receive the greater of $387,500 or acceleration of 100% of the then-unvested 162,500 shares of stock subject to his option, which has an exercise price of $9.00 per share, upon a change in control whereby he is also terminated within six months of such occurrence. Termination for the purposes of this provision of Mr. Childs’s agreement includes a material diminution in his duties, salary or in connection with a liquidation of the company.

 

For purposes of these agreements, “change-in-control” means a change in ownership of our company that occurs on the date that any one person, or more than one person acting as a group, acquires, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions, ownership of our capital stock that, together with our capital stock held by such person, or more than one person acting as a group, constitutes more than 50% of the total voting power of our capital stock, except that any change in ownership of our capital stock as a result of a private placement of our capital stock that is approved by our board of directors will not be considered a change in control unless our board of directors affirmatively determines that such private placement shall be considered a change in control.

 

Potential Payments upon Termination

 

Mr. Childs is subject to an agreement whereby a pre-determined amount of unvested shares of stock subject to his option, which has an exercise price of $9.00 per share, accelerates in connection with his termination. If we terminate him (unless termination in due to cause beyond a reasonable doubt, or “cause”), the vesting schedule

 

101


Table of Contents

associated with his 162,500 shares subject stock options will change such that 50% of the shares subject to the option shall have been deemed to have vested on November 5, 2014. As of December 31, 2013, if Mr. Childs was terminated without cause, he would not receive additional acceleration of any shares.

 

Benefit Plans

 

2013 Equity Incentive Plan

 

On July 5, 2013, our board of directors adopted a 2013 Equity Incentive Plan (or the “2013 Plan”), and, on July 25, 2013, our stockholders approved it. The 2013 Plan was effective upon the effective date of our IPO, August 8, 2013. The 2013 Plan provides for the grant of incentive stock options, within the meaning of Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code, to our employees and any parent and subsidiary corporations’ employees, and for the grant of non-statutory stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, stock appreciation rights, performance units and performance shares to our employees, directors and consultants and our parent and subsidiary corporations’ employees and consultants.

 

Authorized Shares. A total of 4,923,771 shares of our common stock were reserved for issuance pursuant to the 2013 Plan as of September 30, 2013, of which 48,315 awards are issued and outstanding. In addition, the shares to be reserved for issuance under the 2013 Plan also include shares returned to the 1999 Plan as the result of expiration or termination of awards (provided that the maximum number of shares that may be added to the 2013 Plan pursuant as a result of the unissued shares under the 1999 Plan is 4,600,000 shares). The number of shares available for issuance under the 2013 Plan will also include an annual increase on the first day of each fiscal year beginning in 2014, equal to the least of:

 

   

4,000,000 shares;

 

   

5% of the outstanding shares of our common stock as of the last day of our immediately preceding year; or

 

   

such other amount as our board of directors may determine.

 

On January 1, 2014, the shares available for issuance increased 2,010,384 pursuant to the automatic share reserve increase provision under the 2013 Plan.

 

Plan Administration. Our board of directors or the compensation committee of our board of directors administers the 2013 Plan. Subject to the provisions of the 2013 Plan, the administrator has the power to determine the terms of the awards, including the exercise price, the number of shares subject to each such award, the exercisability of the awards, and the form of consideration, if any, payable upon exercise. The administrator also has the authority to amend existing awards to reduce their exercise price, to allow participants the opportunity to transfer outstanding awards to a financial institution or other person or entity selected by the administrator and to institute an exchange program by which outstanding awards may be surrendered in exchange for awards with a higher or lower exercise price.

 

Stock Options. The exercise price of options granted under the 2013 Plan must at least be equal to the fair market value of our common stock on the date of grant. The term of an incentive stock option may not exceed ten years, except that with respect to any employee who owns more than 10% of the voting power of all classes of our outstanding stock, the term must not exceed five years and the exercise price must equal at least 110% of the fair market value of our common stock on the grant date. Subject to the provisions of the 2013 Plan, the administrator determines the term of all other options. After the termination of service of an employee, director or consultant, he or she may exercise his or her option for the period of time stated in his or her option agreement. Generally, if termination is due to death or disability, the option will remain exercisable for twelve months. In all other cases, the option will generally remain exercisable for three months following the termination of service. However, in no event may an option be exercised later than the expiration of its term.

 

102


Table of Contents

Stock Appreciation Rights. Stock appreciation rights may be granted under the 2013 Plan. Stock appreciation rights allow the recipient to receive the appreciation in the fair market value of shares of our common stock between the exercise date and the date of grant. Subject to the provisions of the 2013 Plan, the administrator determines the terms of stock appreciation rights, including when such rights become exercisable and whether to pay any increased appreciation in cash or with shares of our common stock, or a combination thereof, except that the per share exercise price for the shares to be issued pursuant to the exercise of a stock appreciation right will be no less than 100% of the fair market value per share on the date of grant.

 

Restricted Stock. Restricted stock may be granted under the 2013 Plan. Restricted stock awards are grants of shares of our common stock that vest in accordance with terms and conditions established by the administrator. The administrator will determine the number of shares of restricted stock granted to any employee, director, or consultant. The administrator may impose whatever conditions to vesting it determines to be appropriate (for example, the administrator may set restrictions based on the achievement of specific performance goals or continued service to us); provided, however, that the administrator, in its sole discretion, may accelerate the time at which any restrictions will lapse or be removed. Shares of restricted stock that do not vest are subject to our right of repurchase or forfeiture.

 

Restricted Stock Units. Restricted stock units may be granted under the 2013 Plan. Restricted stock units are bookkeeping entries representing an amount equal to the fair market value of one share of our common stock. The administrator determines the terms and conditions of restricted stock units, including the vesting criteria (which may include accomplishing specified performance criteria or continued service to us) and the form and timing of payment. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the administrator, in its sole discretion, may accelerate the time at which any restrictions will lapse or be removed.

 

Performance Units and Performance Shares. Performance units and performance shares may be granted under the 2013 Plan. Performance units and performance shares are awards that will result in a payment to a participant only if performance goals established by the administrator are achieved or the awards otherwise vest. The administrator will establish organizational or individual performance goals in its discretion, which, depending on the extent to which they are met, will determine the number and/or the value of performance units and performance shares to be paid out to participants. After the grant of a performance unit or performance share, the administrator, in its sole discretion, may reduce or waive any performance criteria or other vesting provisions for such performance units or performance shares. Performance units shall have an initial dollar value established by the administrator prior to the grant date. Performance shares shall have an initial value equal to the fair market value of our common stock on the grant date. The administrator, in its sole discretion, may pay earned performance units or performance shares in the form of cash, in shares or in some combination thereof.

 

Outside Directors. The 2013 Plan provides that all non-employee directors are eligible to receive all types of awards (except for incentive stock options) under the 2013 Plan.

 

Non-Transferability of Awards. Unless the administrator provides otherwise, the 2013 Plan generally does not allow for the transfer of awards and only the recipient of an award may exercise an award during his or her lifetime.

 

Certain Adjustments. In the event of certain changes in our capitalization, to prevent diminution or enlargement of the benefits or potential benefits available under the 2013 Plan, the administrator will adjust the number and class of shares that may be delivered under the Plan and/or the number, class and price of shares covered by each outstanding award, and the numerical share limits set forth in the 2013 Plan. In the event of our proposed liquidation or dissolution, the administrator will notify participants as soon as practicable and all awards will terminate immediately prior to the consummation of such proposed transaction.

 

Merger or Change in Control. The 2013 Plan provides that in the event of a merger or change in control, as defined under the 2013 Plan, each outstanding award will be treated as the administrator determines, except that if a successor corporation or its parent or subsidiary does not assume or substitute an equivalent award for any

 

103


Table of Contents

outstanding award, then such award will fully vest, all restrictions on such award will lapse, all performance goals or other vesting criteria applicable to such award will be deemed achieved at 100% of target levels and such award will become fully exercisable, if applicable, for a specified period prior to the transaction. The award will then terminate upon the expiration of the specified period of time. If the service of an outside director is terminated on or following a change in control, other than pursuant to a voluntary resignation, his or her options, restricted stock units and stock appreciation rights, if any, will vest fully and become immediately exercisable, all restrictions on his or her restricted stock will lapse, all performance goals or other vesting requirements for his or her performance shares and units will be deemed achieved at 100% of target levels, and all other terms and conditions will be deemed met.

 

Amendment, Termination. Our board of directors has the authority to amend, suspend or terminate the 2013 Plan provided such action does not impair the existing rights of any participant. The 2013 Plan will automatically terminate in 2023, unless we terminate it sooner.

 

Stock Incentive Plan

 

Our board of directors adopted our 1999 Plan in August 1999, and our stockholders approved it in March 2000. Our 1999 Plan was most recently amended in July 2011.

 

Prior to our initial public offering, our 1999 Stock Plan provided for the grant of incentive stock options, within the meaning of Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code, to our employees and any parent and subsidiary corporations’ employees, and for the grant of nonstatutory stock options and restricted stock and stock appreciation rights to our employees, directors and consultants and any parent and subsidiary corporations’ employees and consultants.

 

Authorized Shares. On August 8, 2013, the date of effectiveness of the registration statement for our initial public offering, we ceased using the 1999 Stock Plan to grant new equity awards, and we began using our 2013 Equity Incentive Plan for grants of new equity awards. Accordingly, as of September 30, 2013, no shares were available for future grant under the 1999 Stock Plan. However, our 1999 Stock Plan will continue to govern the terms and conditions of outstanding awards granted thereunder. As of September 30, 2013, we reserved a total of 3,593,756 shares of our common stock for issuance pursuant to outstanding, unexercised options previously granted under the 1999 Stock Plan.

 

Plan Administration. Our board of directors currently administers our 1999 Plan. Subject to the provisions of our 1999 Plan, the administrator has the power to interpret and administer our 1999 Plan and any agreement thereunder and to determine the terms of awards (including the recipients), the number of shares subject to each award, the exercise price (if any), the fair market value of a share of our common stock, the vesting schedule applicable to the awards together with any vesting acceleration and the terms of the award agreement for use under our 1999 Plan. The administrator may, at any time, authorize the issuance of new awards for the surrender and cancellation of any outstanding award with the consent of a participant.

 

Options. The exercise price per share of incentive stock options must equal at least 100% of the fair market value per share of our common stock on the date of grant, and the term of an incentive stock option may not exceed ten years. An incentive stock option held by a participant who owns more than 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of our stock, or any parent or subsidiary corporations, may not have a term in excess of five years and must have an exercise price of at least 110% of the fair market value per share of our common stock on the date of grant. The administrator will determine the methods of payment of the exercise price of an option, which may include cash or other consideration specified in the participant’s option agreement. The administrator may also offer to buy out an award previously granted for cash or shares.

 

Restricted Stock. Restricted stock may be granted under our 1999 Plan. Restricted stock awards are grants of shares of our common stock that are subject to various restrictions, including restrictions on transferability and forfeiture provisions. Shares of restricted stock will vest, and the restrictions on such shares will lapse, in accordance with terms and conditions established by the administrator.

 

104


Table of Contents

Transferability of Awards. Our 1999 Plan generally does not allow for the transfer of awards, and only the recipient of an award may exercise such an award during his or her lifetime.

 

Certain Adjustment. In the event of certain changes in our capitalization, the number of shares reserved under our 1999 Plan, the exercise prices of and the number of shares subject to outstanding options, and the purchase price of and the numbers of shares subject to outstanding awards will be proportionately adjusted, subject to any required action by our board of directors.

 

Amendment, Termination. Our board of directors may amend our 1999 Plan at any time, provided that such amendment does not impair the rights under outstanding awards without the award holder’s written consent, except to the extent that such amendment is required or desirable so that any award intended to qualify as an incentive stock option complies with the Code or any rule or regulation promulgated or proposed thereunder. Our 1999 Plan was terminated on August 8, 2013, and no further awards may be granted thereunder. All outstanding awards will continue to be governed by their existing terms.

 

105


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PERSON TRANSACTIONS

 

Policies and Procedures for Transactions with Related Persons

 

In connection with our initial public offering, our board of directors adopted a related person transaction policy setting forth the policies and procedures for the review and approval or ratification of related person transactions. Related persons include any executive officer, director or a holder of more than five percent of our common stock, including any of their immediate family members and any entity owned or controlled by such persons. Related person transactions refers to any transaction, arrangement or relationship, or any series of similar transactions, arrangements or relationships in which we were or are to be a participant, the amount involved exceeds $120,000, and a related person had or will have a direct or indirect material interest, including, without limitation, purchases of goods or services by or from the related person or entities in which the related person has a material interest, indebtedness, guarantees of indebtedness, and employment by us of a related person, in each case subject to certain exceptions set forth in Item 404 of Regulation S-K under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

The policy provides that in any related person transaction, our audit committee and board of directors shall consider all of the available material facts and circumstances of the transaction, including: the direct and indirect interests of the related persons; in the event the related person is a director (or immediate family member of a director or an entity with which a director is affiliated), the impact that the transaction will have on a director’s independence; the risks, costs and benefits of the transaction to us; and whether any alternative transactions or sources for comparable services or products are available. After considering all such facts and circumstances, our audit committee and board of directors shall determine whether approval or ratification of the related person transaction is in our best interests. For example, if our audit committee determines that the proposed terms of a related person transaction are reasonable and at least as favorable as could have been obtained from unrelated third parties, it will recommend to our board of directors that such transaction be approved or ratified. In addition, once we become a public company, if a related person transaction will compromise the independence of one of our directors, our audit committee may recommend that our board of directors reject the transaction if it could affect our ability to comply with securities laws and regulations or New York Stock Exchange listing requirements. The policies and procedures described in the foregoing for reviewing and approving related person transactions are not expected to be in writing. However, the charter for our audit committee provides that one of the committee’s responsibilities is to review and approve in advance any proposed related person transactions.

 

Each transaction described in “Transactions and Relationships with Directors, Officers and 5% Stockholders” was entered into prior to the adoption of our audit committee charter and the foregoing policy. Accordingly, each was approved by disinterested members of our board of directors after making a determination that the transaction was executed on terms no less favorable than those we could have obtained from unrelated third parties unless otherwise indicated.

 

106


Table of Contents

Transactions and Relationships with Directors, Officers and 5% Stockholders

 

The following is a summary of related person transactions since January 1, 2011.

 

Sale of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock

 

In July 2011, we sold an aggregate of 17,418,807 shares of our Series A convertible preferred stock at a price of $7.80 per share for an aggregate price of approximately $135.9 million. At the time of such transaction, none of the members of our board of directors were affiliated with these purchasers. In connection with this transaction, certain purchasers of these shares obtained the right to appoint individuals to our board of directors. Accordingly, following the transaction, approximately 92% of the shares were sold to entities that became affiliated with members of our board of directors and holders of more than five percent of our voting securities. The following table summarizes these sales.

 

Purchaser

   Shares of Series  A
Convertible Preferred
Stock Purchased
     Aggregate
Purchase  Price
 

Entities affiliated with Insight Venture Management, LLC(1)

     8,709,403       $ 67,933,336   

Entities affiliated with New Enterprise Associates, Inc.(2)

     7,299,146       $ 56,933,337   

 

  (1)   Consists of 5,705,024 shares purchased by Insight Venture Partners VII, L.P., 2,511,472 shares purchased by Insight Venture Partners (Cayman) VII, L.P., 360,860 shares purchased by Insight Venture Partners (Delaware) VII, L.P. and 132,047 shares purchased by Insight Venture Partners VII (Co-Investors), L.P. Entities affiliated with Insight Venture Management, LLC are holders of more than five percent of our voting securities, and Jeffrey Lieberman, a Managing Director of Insight Venture Management, LLC, is a member of our board of directors.
  (2)   Consists of 7,296,582 shares purchased by New Enterprise Associates 13, L.P. and 2,564 shares purchased by NEA Ventures 2011, L.P. Entities affiliated with New Enterprise Associates, Inc. are holders of more than five percent of our voting securities, and Tony Florence, a General Partner of New Enterprise Associates, Inc., is a member of our board of directors.

 

Stock Repurchase Agreements

 

As a condition to the July 2011 sale of our Series A Convertible Preferred Stock to certain investors, we entered into Stock Repurchase Agreements with each of our executive officers as well as certain other members of our management team. Prior to their expiration on July 15, 2013, these stock repurchase agreements provided us the right to repurchase a portion of our securities held by our executive officers at $7.80 per share upon termination of their employment with cause or upon resignation without good reason, in each case as defined in the stock repurchase agreements. None of the executive officers listed herein was terminated or resigned prior to July 15, 2013, as such no payments were made to our executive officers pursuant to these Stock Repurchase Agreements.

 

Investors’ Rights Agreement

 

We entered into a second amended and restated investors’ rights agreement with certain stockholders in July 2011. This second amended and restated investors’ rights agreement, among other things, grants certain of our stockholders specified registration rights with respect to shares of our common stock and indemnifies each holder as further described in “Description of Capital Stock-Registration Rights.”

 

Voting Agreement

 

We entered into a voting agreement with certain stockholders in July 2011. The voting agreement, among other things, provided for the voting of shares with respect to the constituency of our board of directors and provided for the voting of shares with respect to specified transactions approved by our board of directors and the requisite supermajority of holders of our outstanding stock. The voting agreement terminated upon completion of our initial public offering in August 2013.

 

107


Table of Contents

Stockholders’ Agreement

 

We entered into a third amended and restated stockholders’ agreement with certain stockholders in July 2011. The third amended and restated stockholders’ agreement, among other things granted us rights of first refusal with respect to certain proposed transfers of our securities by stockholders and granted certain stockholders rights of first refusal and co-sale with respect to certain proposed transfers of our securities by stockholders. The third amended and restated stockholders’ agreement terminated upon completion of our initial public offering in August 2013.

 

Stock Repurchases

 

In July 2011, we repurchased shares of our common stock from the following related persons at a purchase price of $7.80 per share:

 

   

2,724,609 shares from Reggie K. Aggarwal, our chief executive officer, for gross proceeds to Mr. Aggarwal of $21.3 million;

 

   

718,374 shares from Charles V. Ghoorah, our executive vice president of sales and marketing, for gross proceeds to Mr. Ghoorah of $5.6 million;

 

   

526,118 shares from David Quattrone, our chief technology officer, for gross proceeds to Mr. Quattrone of $4.1 million;

 

   

526,018 shares from Thomas Kramer, our then-chief financial officer, for gross proceeds to Mr. Kramer of $4.1 million;

 

   

473,425 shares from Dwayne J. Sye, our chief information officer, for gross proceeds to Mr. Sye of $3.7 million;

 

   

700,830 shares directly from Sanju K. Bansal, one of our directors, for gross proceeds to Mr. Bansal of $5.5 million; and

 

   

432,141 shares held by entities affiliated with MicroStrategy Incorporated, or MicroStrategy, for gross proceeds of $3.4 million. At the time of the transaction, Mr. Bansal was the vice chairman, executive vice president, chief operating officer and secretary of MicroStrategy and was the beneficial owner of less than 5% of the outstanding Class A Common Stock of MicroStrategy. MicroStrategy originally acquired such shares in 2000 in exchange for licenses to MicroStrategy software provided to us.

 

Non-Employee Director Compensation Policy

 

We have entered into compensation arrangements with certain of our non-employee directors. See “Management—Director Compensation.”

 

Indemnification Agreements

 

We have entered into an indemnification agreement with each of our directors and officers. The indemnification agreements and our certificate of incorporation and bylaws require us to indemnify our directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by Delaware law. See “Management—Limitations on Director and Officer Liability and Indemnification.”

 

108


Table of Contents

PRINCIPAL AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS

 

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the beneficial ownership of our common stock as of January 10, 2014, referred to in the table below as the “Beneficial Ownership Date,” and as adjusted to reflect the sale of shares of our common stock offered by this prospectus, by:

 

   

each beneficial owner of 5% or more of the outstanding shares of our common stock;

 

   

each of our directors;

 

   

each of our named executive officers;

 

   

all directors and executive officers as a group; and

 

   

each of the selling stockholders.

 

Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the SEC. In computing the number of shares beneficially owned by a person and the percentage ownership of that person, shares of common stock subject to options or warrants held by that person that are currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date are deemed outstanding, but are not deemed outstanding for computing the percentage ownership of any other person. Percentage of beneficial ownership is based on 40,208,239 shares of common stock outstanding as of the Beneficial Ownership Date and 40,858,239 shares of common stock outstanding after this offering. The percentage of beneficial ownership assuming the underwriters exercise their option in full to purchase additional shares of common stock is based on 40,955,739 shares of common stock outstanding after the offering and exercise of such option.

 

109


Table of Contents

To our knowledge, except as set forth in the footnotes to this table and subject to applicable community property laws, each person named in the table has sole voting and investment power with respect to the shares set forth opposite such person’s name. Except as otherwise indicated, the address of each of the persons in this table is c/o Cvent, Inc. 8180 Greensboro Dr., 9th Floor, McLean, VA 22102.

 

    Shares  Beneficially
Owned
Prior to the Offering
    Number of
Shares
Offered
    Shares  Beneficially
Owned
After the Offering
    Underwriters’
Option
    Shares Beneficially
Owned  After the
Offering if
Underwriters’ Option
is Exercised in Full
 

Name of Beneficial Owner

  Number     Percent       Number     Percent     Number of
Shares
Offered
    Number     Percent  

Named Executive Officers and Directors:

               

Reggie K. Aggarwal

    5,234,241 (1)      13.0     713,007        4,521,234        11.1     106,951        4,414,283        10.8

Charles V. Ghoorah

    1,498,528 (2)      3.7     204,129        1,294,399        3.2     30,620        1,263,779        3.1

Peter L. Childs

    5,500        *               5,500        *               5,500        *   

Sanju K. Bansal

    3,326,930 (3)      8.3     453,193        2,873,737        7.0     67,979        2,805,758        6.9

Tony Florence

    7,299,146 (4)      18.2     994,286        6,304,860        15.4     149,142        6,155,718        15.0

Jeffrey Lieberman

    8,709,403 (5)      21.7     1,186,391        7,523,012        18.4     177,959        7,345,053        17.9

Kevin T. Parker

    (6)                                                  

All executive officers and directors as a group (10 persons)

    28,144,996 (7)      70.0     3,833,150        24,311,846        59.5     574,973        23,736,873        58.0

Other Principal Stockholders:

               

Entities affiliated with Insight Venture Management, LLC

    8,709,403 (5)      21.7     1,186,391        7,523,012        18.4     177,959        7,345,053        17.9

Entities affiliated with New Enterprise Associates, Inc

    7,299,146 (4)      18.2     994,286        6,304,860        15.4     149,142        6,155,718        15.0

Other Selling Stockholders:

               

Manjula Aggarwal

    826,590 (8)      2.1     112,597        713,993        1.7     16,890        697,103        1.7

Eric Eden

    203,065 (9)      *        27,662        175,403        *        4,149        171,254        *   

Peter Floros

    175,000 (10)      *        23,838        151,162        *        3,575        147,587        *   

Daniel Lapus

    264,174 (11)      *        35,985        228,189        *        5,398        222,791        *   

Michael Lu

    157,463 (12)      *        21,449        136,014        *        3,218        132,796        *   

Brian Ludwig

    345,001 (13)      *        46,996        298,005        *        7,049        290,956        *   

Bharet Malhotra

    342,366 (14)      *        46,637        295,729        *        6,995        288,734        *   

David Quattrone

    1,100,285 (15)      2.7     149,880        950,405        2.3     22,482        927,923        2.3

Dwayne Sye

    970,963 (16)      2.4     132,264        838,699        2.1     19,840        818,859        2.0

John Judge

    12,375        *        1,686        10,689        *        253        10,436        *   

 

  *   Represents beneficial ownership of less than 1%.
  (1)   Includes (i) no shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date; (ii) 212,125 shares held subject to a right of repurchase held by the Company pursuant to early exercise option agreements; (iii) 1,392,051 shares held by the Reggie Aggarwal Grantor Retained Annuity Trust (2011), of which Mr. Aggarwal is the sole trustee and has voting and investment control; and (iv) 1,250,000 shares held by the Reggie and Dharini Aggarwal Irrevocable Trust (2011), of which Dharini Aggarwal and Sanjeev Aggarwal are co-trustees and share voting and investment control.
  (2)   Includes (i) 126,904 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date; and (ii) 127,500 shares held by the Charles V. Ghoorah Irrevocable Trust (2013), of which Robert Ghoorah and Karen Ghoorah are co-trustees and share voting and investment control.
  (3)   Includes (i) no shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date; (ii) 324,640 shares held by the Sanjeev K. Bansal Grantor Retained Annuity Trust, of which Mr. Bansal is the sole trustee and has voting and investment control; and (iii) 45,000 shares held by the Bansal Foundation, of which Mr. Bansal is the trustee and has voting and investment control.
  (4)  

Consists of 7,296,582 shares of common stock held of record by New Enterprise Associates 13, L.P. (“NEA 13”) and 2,564 shares of common stock held of record by NEA Ventures 2011, L.P. (“Ven 2011”). NEA Partners 13, L.P. (“NEA Partners

 

110


Table of Contents
  13”) is the sole general partner of NEA 13, and NEA 13 GP, LTD (“NEA 13 LTD”) is the sole general partner of NEA Partners 13. The individual Directors (collectively, the “Directors”) of NEA 13 LTD are M. James Barrett, Peter J. Barris, Forest Baskett, Ryan D. Drant, Patrick J. Kerins, Krishna “Kittu” Kolluri, David M. Mott, Scott D. Sandell, Ravi Viswanathan and Harry R. Weller. The Directors share voting and dispositive power with regard to the shares directly held by NEA 13. Karen P. Welsh, the general partner of Ven 2011, shares voting and dispositive power with regard to the shares held by Ven 2011. The principal business address of the entities affiliated with New Enterprise Associates is 1954 Greenspring Drive, Suite 600, Timonium, MD 21093.
  (5)  

Consists of (i) 5,705,024 shares owned by Insight Venture Partners VII, L.P.; (ii) 2,511,472 shares owned by Insight Venture Partners (Cayman) VII, L.P.; (iii) 132,047 shares owned by Insight Venture Partners VII (Co-Investors), L.P.; and (iv) 360,860 shares owned by Insight Venture Partners (Delaware) VII, L.P. Insight Holdings Group, LLC (“Holdings”) is the sole shareholder of Insight Venture Associates VII, Ltd. (“IVA Ltd”). IVA Ltd is the general partner of Insight Venture Associates VII, L.P. (“IVP LP”), which is the general partner of Insight Venture Partners VII, L.P., Insight Venture Partners (Cayman) VII, L.P., Insight Venture Partners (Delaware) VII, L.P. and Insight Venture Partners VII (Co-Investors), L.P. (collectively, “Fund VII”). Each of Jeffrey Horing, Deven Parekh and Peter Sobiloff is a member of the board of managers of Holdings. Because Messrs. Horing, Parekh and Sobiloff are members of the board of managers of Holdings, Holdings is the sole shareholder of IVA Ltd and IVA LP is the general partner of Fund VII, Messrs. Horing, Parekh and Sobiloff have voting and dispositive power over the Cvent shares noted below. The foregoing is not an admission by Holdings, IVA Ltd or IVA LP that it is the beneficial owner of the shares held by Fund VII. The principal business address of the entities affiliated with Insight Venture Management, LLC is c/o Insight Venture Partners, 680 Fifth Avenue, 8th Floor, New York, NY 10019.

  (6)   Mr. Parker holds 5,555 restricted stock units, subject to forfeiture until July 5, 2014. See “Management—Director Compensation.”
  (7)   Includes (i) 310,171 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date; (ii) 212,125 shares held subject to a right of repurchase held by the Company pursuant to early exercise option agreements; and (iii) 3,659,216 shares held by trusts, of which a director or executive officer is a trustee and has voting and investment control.
  (8)   Includes 15,942 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date.
  (9)   Includes 103,126 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date.
  (10)   Includes 119,530 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date.
  (11)   Includes 111,564 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date.
  (12)   Includes 126,938 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date.
  (13)   Includes 119,445 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date.
  (14)   Includes (i) 118,751 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date; and (ii) 25,000 shares held by the Bharet Malhotra Irrevocable Trust (2013), of which Shagun Malhotra is the sole trustee and has voting and investment control.
  (15)   Includes (i) 96,522 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date; and (ii) 125,000 shares held by the David C. Quattrone Irrevocable Trust (2013), of which Robyn C. Quattrone is the sole trustee and has voting and investment control.
  (16)   Includes (i) 86,745 shares subject to options that are immediately exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of the Beneficial Ownership Date; and (ii) 394,825 shares held by the Dwayne Jerry Sye Grantor Retained Annuity Trust (2013), of which Mr. Sye is the sole trustee and has voting and investment control.

 

111


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

 

The following information describes our common stock and preferred stock, as well as options to purchase our common stock and provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws. This description is only a summary. You should also refer to our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and bylaws, which have been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission as exhibits to our registration statement, of which this prospectus forms a part.

 

General

 

Our authorized capital stock consists of 1,000,000,000 shares of common stock with a $0.001 par value per share, and 100,000,000 shares of preferred stock with a $0.001 par value per share, all of which shares of preferred stock are undesignated. Our board of directors may establish the rights and preferences of the preferred stock from time to time. Our board of directors is authorized, without stockholder approval except as required by the listing standards of the New York Stock Exchange, to issue additional shares of our capital stock.

 

As of September 30, 2013, there were 39,884,357 shares of common stock, excluding 318,369 shares underlying stock options that have been early exercised and remain subject to vesting, issued and outstanding, held of record by 214 stockholders.

 

Common Stock

 

Each holder of our common stock is entitled to one vote for each share on all matters to be voted upon by the stockholders and there are no cumulative rights. Subject to any preferential rights of any outstanding preferred stock, holders of our common stock are entitled to receive ratably the dividends, if any, as may be declared from time to time by the board of directors out of legally available funds. If there is a liquidation, dissolution or winding up of our company, holders of our common stock would be entitled to share in our assets remaining after the payment of liabilities and any preferential rights of any outstanding preferred stock.

 

Holders of our common stock have no preemptive or conversion rights or other subscription rights, and there are no redemption or sinking fund provisions applicable to the common stock. All outstanding shares of our common stock will be fully paid and non-assessable. The rights, preferences and privileges of the holders of our common stock are subject to, and may be adversely affected by, the rights of the holders of shares of any series of preferred stock which we may designate and issue in the future.

 

Preferred Stock

 

Under the terms of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, our board of directors is authorized to issue shares of preferred stock in one or more series without stockholder approval. Our board of directors has the discretion to determine the rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions, including voting rights, dividend rights, conversion rights, redemption privileges and liquidation preferences, of each series of preferred stock.

 

The purpose of authorizing our board of directors to issue preferred stock and determine its rights and preferences is to eliminate delays associated with a stockholder vote on specific issuances. The issuance of preferred stock, while providing flexibility in connection with possible future acquisitions and other corporate purposes, will affect, and may adversely affect, the rights of holders of common stock. It is not possible to state the actual effect of the issuance of any shares of preferred stock on the rights of holders of common stock until the board of directors determines the specific rights attached to that preferred stock. The effects of issuing preferred stock could include one or more of the following:

 

   

restricting dividends on the common stock;

 

   

diluting the voting power of the common stock;

 

112


Table of Contents
   

impairing the liquidation rights of the common stock; or

 

   

delaying or preventing changes in control or management of our company.

 

We have no present plans to issue any shares of preferred stock.

 

Effect of Certain Provisions of Our Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws and the Delaware Anti-Takeover Statute

 

Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws

 

Some provisions of Delaware law and our certificate of incorporation and bylaws contain provisions that could make the following transactions more difficult:

 

   

acquisition of us by means of a tender offer;

 

   

acquisition of us by means of a proxy contest or otherwise; or

 

   

removal of our incumbent officers and directors.

 

These provisions, summarized below, are expected to discourage coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids and to promote stability in our management. These provisions are also designed to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of us to first negotiate with our board of directors.

 

   

Undesignated Preferred Stock. The ability to authorize undesignated preferred stock makes it possible for our board of directors to issue one or more series of preferred stock with voting or other rights or preferences that could impede the success of any attempt to change control. These and other provisions may have the effect of deferring hostile takeovers or delaying changes in control or management of our company.

 

   

Calling of Special Meetings of Stockholders. Our charter documents provide that a special meeting of stockholders may be called only by resolution adopted by our board of directors.

 

   

Requirements for Advance Notification of Stockholder Nominations and Proposals. Our bylaws establish advance notice procedures with respect to stockholder proposals and the nomination of candidates for election as directors, other than nominations made by or at the direction of the board of directors or a committee of the board of directors.

 

   

Board Classification. Our board of directors is divided into three classes. The directors in each class will serve for a three-year term, one class being elected each year by our stockholders. This system of electing and removing directors may tend to discourage a third party from making a tender offer or otherwise attempting to obtain control of us, because it generally makes it more difficult for stockholders to replace a majority of the directors.

 

   

Limits on Ability of Stockholders to Act by Written Consent. We have provided in our certificate of incorporation that our stockholders may not act by written consent. This limit on the ability of our stockholders to act by written consent may lengthen the amount of time required to take stockholder actions. As a result, a holder controlling a majority of our capital stock would not be able to amend our bylaws or remove directors without holding a meeting of our stockholders called in accordance with our bylaws.

 

   

Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws. The amendment of the above provisions of our certificate of incorporation and bylaws requires approval by holders of at least two-thirds of our outstanding capital stock entitled to vote generally in the election of directors.

 

113


Table of Contents

Anti-Takeover Provisions

 

Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law

 

We are subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law. In general, Section 203 prohibits a publicly held Delaware corporation from engaging in a “business combination” with an “interested stockholder” for a three-year period following the time that this stockholder becomes an interested stockholder, unless the business combination is approved in a prescribed manner. Under Section 203, a business combination between a corporation and an interested stockholder is prohibited unless it satisfies one of the following conditions:

 

   

before the stockholder became interested, our board of directors approved either the business combination or the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder;

 

   

upon consummation of the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, the interested stockholder owned at least 85% of the voting stock of the corporation outstanding at the time the transaction commenced, excluding for purposes of determining the voting stock outstanding, shares owned by persons who are directors and also officers, and employee stock plans, in some instances, but not the outstanding voting stock owned by the interested stockholder; or

 

   

at or after the time the stockholder became interested, the business combination was approved by our board of directors and authorized at an annual or special meeting of the stockholders by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the outstanding voting stock which is not owned by the interested stockholder.

 

Section 203 defines a business combination to include:

 

   

any merger or consolidation involving the corporation and the interested stockholder;

 

   

any sale, transfer, lease, pledge or other disposition involving the interested stockholder of 10% or more of the assets of the corporation;

 

   

subject to exceptions, any transaction that results in the issuance or transfer by the corporation of any stock of the corporation to the interested stockholder;

 

   

subject to exceptions, any transaction involving the corporation that has the effect of increasing the proportionate share of the stock of any class or series of the corporation beneficially owned by the interested stockholder; and

 

   

the receipt by the interested stockholder of the benefit of any loans, advances, guarantees, pledges or other financial benefits provided by or through the corporation.

 

In general, Section 203 defines an interested stockholder as any entity or person beneficially owning 15% or more of the outstanding voting stock of the corporation and any entity or person affiliated with or controlling or controlled by the entity or person.

 

Certain provisions of Delaware law, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and our bylaws contain provisions that could have the effect of delaying, deferring or discouraging another party from acquiring control of us. These provisions, which are summarized below, may have the effect of discouraging coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids. These provisions are also designed, in part, to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of us to first negotiate with our board of directors. We believe that the benefits of increased protection of our potential ability to negotiate with an unfriendly or unsolicited acquiror outweigh the disadvantages of discouraging a proposal to acquire us because negotiation of these proposals could result in an improvement of their terms.

 

Undesignated Preferred Stock

 

As discussed in the preceding sections, our board of directors has the ability to issue preferred stock with voting or other rights or preferences that could impede the success of any attempt to change control of us. These and other provisions may have the effect of deferring hostile takeovers or delaying changes in control or management of our company.

 

114


Table of Contents

Limits on Ability of Stockholders to Call a Special Meeting

 

Our bylaws provide that special meetings of the stockholders may be called only by the board of directors or a committee of the board of directors. A stockholder may not call a special meeting, which may delay the ability of our stockholders to force consideration of a proposal or for holders controlling a majority of our capital stock to take any action, including the removal of directors.

 

Requirements for Advance Notification of Stockholder Nominations and Proposals

 

Our bylaws establish advance notice procedures with respect to stockholder proposals and the nomination of candidates for election as directors. However, our bylaws may have the effect of precluding the conduct of certain business at a meeting if the proper procedures are not followed. These provisions may also discourage or deter a potential acquiror from conducting a solicitation of proxies to elect the acquiror’s own slate of directors or otherwise attempting to obtain control of our company.

 

No Cumulative Voting

 

The Delaware General Corporation Law provides that stockholders are not entitled to the right to cumulate votes in the election of directors unless our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides otherwise. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws do not expressly provide for cumulative voting.

 

Registration Rights

 

We and certain of our stockholders that held our convertible preferred stock prior to our IPO have entered into a second amended and restated investor rights agreement, or investor rights agreement. The registration rights provisions of this agreement provide those holders with demand and piggyback registration rights with respect to certain of the shares of common stock currently held by them.

 

Demand Registration Rights

 

At any time after February 4, 2014, the holders of at least 40% of our registrable securities under our Second Amended and Restated Investors’ Rights Agreement in the aggregate have the right to demand that we file up to a total of two registration statements. These registration rights are subject to specified conditions and limitations, including the right of the underwriters, if any, to limit the number of shares included in any such registration under specified circumstances. Upon such a request, we will be required to use our best efforts to effect the registration as soon as possible. An aggregate of 28,881,251 shares of common stock are entitled to these demand registration rights.

 

Piggyback Registration Rights

 

At any time after the completion of this offering, if we propose to register any of our securities under the Securities Act either for our own account or for the account of other stockholders, the holders of shares of common stock that are issued upon conversion of our convertible preferred stock and some holders of shares of our common stock will each be entitled to notice of the registration and will be entitled to include their shares of common stock in the registration statement. These piggyback registration rights are subject to specified conditions and limitations, including the right of the underwriters to limit the number of shares included in any such registration under specified circumstances. An aggregate of 28,881,251 shares of common stock will be entitled to these piggyback registration rights.

 

Registration on Form S-3

 

At any time after we become eligible to file a registration statement on Form S-3, certain holders of shares of our common stock will be entitled, upon their written request, to have such shares registered by us on a Form S-3 registration statement. This registration on Form S-3 is subject to specified conditions and limitations,

 

115


Table of Contents

including that such requested registration has an anticipated aggregate offering size to the public of at least $1.0 million and we have not already effected two registrations on Form S-3 within the preceding twelve-month period and subject to other specified conditions and limitations. An aggregate of 28,881,251 shares of common stock will be entitled to these Form S-3 registration rights.

 

Expenses of Registration

 

We will pay all of the expenses relating to any demand, piggyback or Form S-3 registration, other than underwriting discounts, commissions, stock transfer taxes, and fees and expenses of counsel to the selling stockholders.

 

Termination of Registration Rights

 

The registration rights granted under the second amended and restated investors’ rights agreement will terminate upon the earlier of: (i) such date on or after the closing of our first registered public offering of common stock, on which all shares of registrable securities held may be immediately sold under Rule 144 of the Securities Act during any ninety-day period and (ii) August 8, 2018.

 

Listing on the New York Stock Exchange

 

Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CVT.”

 

Transfer Agent and Registrar

 

The transfer agent and registrar for our common stock is American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, LLC. The transfer agent’s address is 6201 15th Avenue, Brooklyn, NY 11219.

 

116


Table of Contents

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

 

We will have 40,543,357 shares of common stock outstanding after the completion of this offering based on the number of shares outstanding on September 30, 2013 and assuming no exercise of outstanding options after such date except the 9,000 shares subject to options exercised for sale by selling stockholders in this offering (40,640,857 shares if the underwriters exercise their option in full). Of those shares, all of the 6,440,000 shares of common stock sold in our IPO and the 4,800,000 shares of common stock sold in the offering (5,520,000 shares if the underwriters exercise their option in full) will be immediately freely transferable without restriction under Rule 144 of the Securities Act, unless purchased by persons deemed to be our “affiliates” as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. Any shares purchased by an affiliate may not be resold except pursuant to an effective registration statement or an applicable exemption from registration, including an exemption under Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act. The remaining approximately 29,303,357 shares of common stock to be outstanding immediately following the completion of this offering are “restricted,” which means they were originally sold in offerings that were not registered under the Securities Act. Restricted shares may be sold through registration under the Securities Act or under an available exemption from registration, such as provided through Rule 144, which rules are summarized below. Taking into account the lock-up agreements described below, and assuming the underwriters do not release any stockholders from these agreements earlier than scheduled, our common stock will be available for sale in the public market as follows:

 

   

4,800,000 shares sold in this offering and 6,263,850 shares sold in our IPO will be immediately available for sale in the public market;

 

   

4,189,444 shares that are not subject to the lock-up agreement in connection with this offering will be eligible for sale on February 5, 2014 in the public market, subject to the provisions of Rule 144 or Rule 701, upon the expiration of lock-up agreements entered into in connection with our IPO and market standoff agreements with us; and

 

   

25,290,063 shares will be eligible for sale in the public market, subject to the provisions of Rule 144 or Rule 701, upon the expiration of lock-up agreements entered into in connection with this offering.

 

Rule 144

 

In general, under Rule 144 of the Securities Act, as in effect on the date of this prospectus, a person (or persons whose shares are aggregated) who has beneficially owned restricted stock for at least six months, will be entitled to sell in any three-month period a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of:

 

   

1% of the number of shares of common stock then outstanding (40,543,357 shares immediately after this offering or 40,640,857 shares if the underwriters’ option is exercised in full); or

 

   

the average weekly trading volume of our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange during the four calendar weeks immediately preceding the date on which the notice of sale is filed with the SEC.

 

Sales pursuant to Rule 144 are subject to requirements relating to manner of sale, notice and availability of current public information about us. A person (or persons whose shares are aggregated) who is not deemed to be an affiliate of ours for 90 days preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned restricted stock for at least one year is entitled to sell such shares without complying with the manner of sale, public information, volume limitation or notice provisions of Rule 144.

 

Form S-8 Registration Statement

 

We have filed a registration statement on Form S-8 under the Securities Act to register the shares of our common stock that are issued or reserved for issuance pursuant to our 1999 Plan and our 2013 Plan. Shares covered by this registration statement shall be eligible for sale in the public markets, subject to vesting restrictions, any applicable lock-up agreements described herein and Rule 144 limitations applicable to affiliates.

 

117


Table of Contents

Rule 701

 

Rule 701 under the Securities Act, as in effect on the date of this prospectus, permits resale of shares in reliance upon Rule 144 but without compliance with certain restrictions of Rule 144, including the holding period requirement. Most of our employees, executive officers or directors who purchased shares under a written compensatory plan or contract may be entitled to rely on the resale provisions of Rule 701, but all holders of Rule 701 shares are required to wait until 180 days after the date of this prospectus before selling their shares. However, substantially all Rule 701 shares are subject to lock-up agreements as described in the following section and under “Underwriting” included elsewhere in this prospectus and will become eligible for sale upon the expiration of the restrictions set forth in those agreements.

 

Lock-Up Agreements

 

Lock-Up Agreements Entered into in Connection with this Offering

 

In connection with this offering, we, all of our directors and executive officers and all of the selling stockholders have agreed with the underwriters of this offering, subject to certain exceptions, without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co. on behalf of the underwriters of this offering, we and they will not, during the period ending 90 days from the date of the final prospectus relating to this offering:

 

   

offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant to purchase, lend, or otherwise transfer or dispose of, directly or indirectly, any shares of our common stock or securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for our common stock; or

 

   

enter into any swap or other arrangement that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of the economic consequences of ownership of our common stock;

 

whether any transaction described above is to be settled by delivery of shares of our common stock or such other securities, in cash or otherwise. Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co. may, in their discretion, release any of the securities subject to those lock-up agreements in whole or in part at any time prior to their expiration with or without notice.

 

Certain of our employees, including our executive officers, and/or directors may enter into written trading plans that are intended to comply with Rule 10b5-1 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Sales under these trading plans would not be permitted until the expiration of the lock-up agreements relating to the offering described above.

 

Lock-Up Agreements Entered into in Connection with our IPO

 

In addition, in connection with our IPO, we, our executive officers, directors, and holders of substantially all of our common stock and securities convertible into or exchangeable for our common stock previously agreed that, subject to certain exceptions, without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co. on behalf of the underwriters of our IPO, we and they will not, during the period ending February 4, 2014:

 

   

offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant to purchase, lend, or otherwise transfer or dispose of, directly or indirectly, any shares of our common stock or securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for our common stock; or

 

   

enter into any swap or other arrangement that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of the economic consequences of ownership of our common stock;

 

118


Table of Contents

whether any transaction described above is to be settled by delivery of shares of our common stock or such other securities, in cash or otherwise. Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co. may, in their discretion, release any of the securities subject to those lock-up agreements at any time prior to February 4, 2014.

 

Certain of our employees, including our executive officers, and/or directors may enter into written trading plans that are intended to comply with Rule 10b5-1 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Sales under these trading plans would not be permitted until the expiration of the lock-up agreements relating to our IPO described above.

 

119


Table of Contents

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME AND ESTATE TAX CONSEQUENCES TO

NON-U.S. HOLDERS

 

The following is a summary of the material U.S. federal income tax (and, to the limited extent set forth below, estate tax consequences) of the ownership and disposition of our common stock issued pursuant to this offering to non-U.S. holders. This summary does not purport to be a complete analysis of all of the potential tax considerations relating thereto. It is based upon the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 as amended (the “Code”), Treasury regulations promulgated thereunder, administrative rulings and judicial decisions, all as of the date hereof. These authorities may be changed, possibly retroactively, so as to result in U.S. federal income or estate tax consequences different from those set forth below.

 

This summary does not address tax considerations arising under the laws of any non-U.S., state or local jurisdiction or under U.S. federal gift and estate tax laws, except to the limited extent set forth below. In addition, this discussion does not address tax considerations applicable to an investor’s particular circumstances or to investors that may be subject to special tax rules, including, without limitation:

 

   

banks, insurance companies or other financial institutions;

 

   

persons subject to the alternative minimum tax or net investment income tax;

 

   

tax-exempt organizations;

 

   

controlled foreign corporations, passive foreign investment companies and corporations that accumulate earnings to avoid United States federal income tax;

 

   

dealers in securities or currencies;

 

   

traders in securities that elect to use a mark-to-market method of accounting for their securities holdings;

 

   

persons that own, or are deemed to own, more than 5% of our capital stock (except to the extent specifically set forth below);

 

   

certain former citizens or long-term residents of the United States;

 

   

persons who hold our common stock as a position in a hedging transaction, “straddle,” “conversion transaction” or other risk reduction transaction or who are deemed to sell our common stock under the constructive sale provisions of the Code; or

 

   

persons who do not hold our common stock as a capital asset (within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code).

 

In addition, if a partnership (or entity or arrangement classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes) holds our common stock, the tax treatment of a partner generally will depend on the status of the partner and upon the activities of the partnership. Accordingly, partnerships that hold our common stock, and partners in such partnerships, should consult their tax advisors.

 

You are urged to consult your tax advisor with respect to the application of the U.S. federal income tax laws to your particular situation, as well as any tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our common stock arising under the U.S. federal income, estate or gift tax rules or under the laws of any state, local, non-U.S. or other taxing jurisdiction or under any applicable tax treaty.

 

Non-U.S. Holder Defined

 

For purposes of this discussion, you are a non-U.S. holder if you are person (other than a partnership or any other entity treated as a partnership for United States federal income tax purposes) that is not, for United States federal income tax purposes, any of the following:

 

   

an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;

 

120


Table of Contents
   

a corporation or other entity taxable as a corporation for United States federal income tax purposes created or organized under the laws of the United States or any political subdivision thereof;

 

   

an estate whose income is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its source; or

 

   

a trust (x) the administration of which is subject to the primary supervision of a U.S. court and which has one or more U.S. persons who have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (y) which has made an election to be treated as a U.S. person.

 

Distributions

 

We have not made any distributions on our common stock, and we do not currently intend to make any distributions for the foreseeable future. However, if we do make distributions on our common stock, such distributions will constitute dividends for U.S. tax purposes to the extent paid from our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. To the extent those distributions exceed both our current and our accumulated earnings and profits, they will be treated as a tax-free return of your adjusted basis in our common stock, and then as gain from the sale of stock subject to the tax treatment below in “gain on disposition of common stock.”

 

Any dividend paid to you generally will be subject to U.S. withholding tax at a rate of 30% of the gross amount of the dividend, or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty. In order to obtain a reduced rate, you must provide us with an IRS Form W-8BEN or other applicable IRS Form W-8 including a U.S. taxpayer identification number and certifying qualification for the reduced rate. This certification must be provided to us or our paying agent prior to the payment of dividends and must be updated periodically. Treasury regulations or the applicable income tax treaty will provide rules to determine whether dividends paid to an entity should be treated as paid to the entity or the entity’s owners. If the non-U.S. holder holds the stock through a financial institution or other agent acting on the non-U.S. holder’s behalf, the non-U.S. holder will be required to provide appropriate documentation to the agent, which then will be required to provide certification to us or our paying agent, either directly or through other intermediaries. A non-U.S. holder of shares of our common stock eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. withholding tax pursuant to an income tax treaty may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by timely filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS.

 

Dividends received by you that are effectively connected with your conduct of a U.S. trade or business (and, if an applicable income tax treaty so requires, attributable to a permanent establishment maintained by you in the U.S.) are exempt from such withholding tax. In order to obtain this exemption, you must provide us with an IRS Form W-8ECI or other applicable IRS Form W-8 properly certifying such exemption. Dividends that are effectively connected with a non-U.S. holder’s U.S. trade or business (and, if an income tax treaty so requires, attributable to a permanent establishment maintained by the non-U.S. holder in the United States), although not subject to withholding tax, generally are taxed at the same graduated rates applicable to U.S. persons, net of certain deductions and credits. In addition, if you are a corporate non-U.S. holder, dividends you receive that are effectively connected with your conduct of a U.S. trade or business may also be subject to a branch profits tax at a rate of 30% or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty.

 

Gain on Disposition of Common Stock

 

You generally will not be required to pay U.S. federal income tax on any gain realized upon the sale or other disposition of our common stock unless:

 

   

the gain is effectively connected with your conduct of a U.S. trade or business (and, if an income tax treaty so requires, attributable to a permanent establishment maintained by you in the United States);

 

   

you are an individual who is present in the United States for a period or periods aggregating 183 days or more during the calendar year in which the sale or disposition occurs and certain other conditions are met; or

 

121


Table of Contents
   

our common stock constitutes a U.S. real property interest by reason of our status as a “United States real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes (a “USRPHC”) at any time within the shorter of the five-year period preceding the disposition or your holding period for our common stock.

 

We believe that we are not currently and will not become a USRPHC. However, because the determination of whether we are a USRPHC depends on the fair market value of our U.S. real property relative to the fair market value of our other business assets, there can be no assurance that we will not become a USRPHC in the future. Even if we become a USRPHC, however, as long as our common stock is regularly traded on an established securities market, such common stock will be treated as U.S. real property interests only if you actually or constructively hold more than 5% of such regularly traded common stock at any time during the applicable period that is specified in the Code.

 

If you are a non-U.S. holder described in the first bullet above, you will be required to pay tax on the net gain derived from the sale under regular graduated U.S. federal income tax rates, and corporate non-U.S. holders described in the first bullet above may be subject to the branch profits tax at a 30% rate or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty with respect to its effectively connected earnings and profits attributable to such gain and other income. If you are an individual non-U.S. holder described in the second bullet above, you will be required to pay a flat 30% tax on the gain derived from the sale, which tax may be offset by U.S. source capital losses (even though you are not considered a resident of the United States). You should consult any applicable income tax or other treaties that may provide for different rules.

 

Federal Estate Tax

 

Our common stock beneficially owned by an individual who is not a citizen or resident of the United States (as defined for U.S. federal estate tax purposes) at the time of death generally will be includable in the decedent’s gross estate for U.S. federal estate tax purposes, unless an applicable estate tax treaty provides otherwise.

 

Backup Withholding and Information Reporting

 

Generally, we must report annually to the IRS the amount of dividends paid to you, your name and address, and the amount of tax withheld with respect to such dividends, if any. A similar report is sent to you. Pursuant to applicable income tax treaties or other agreements, the IRS may make these reports available to tax authorities in your country of residence.

 

Payments of dividends or proceeds of the disposition of stock made to you may be subject to information reporting and backup withholding at a current rate of 28% unless you establish an exemption, for example by properly certifying your non-U.S. status on a Form W-8BEN or another appropriate version of IRS Form W-8. Notwithstanding the foregoing, backup withholding and information reporting may apply if either we or our paying agent has actual knowledge, or reason to know, that the beneficial owner is a United States person as defined under the Code.

 

Backup withholding is not an additional tax; rather, the U.S. income tax liability of persons subject to backup withholding will be reduced by the amount of tax withheld. If withholding results in an overpayment of taxes, a refund or credit may generally be obtained from the IRS, provided that the required information is timely furnished to the IRS in a timely manner.

 

Taxation of Our Common Stock Held by or Through Foreign Entities

 

The Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act enacted in 2010 (“FATCA”) generally imposes a U.S. federal withholding tax of 30% on dividends and the gross proceeds of a disposition of our common stock paid to a “foreign financial institution” (as defined under FATCA) unless such institution enters into an agreement with

 

122


Table of Contents

the U.S. government to withhold on certain payments and to collect and provide to the U.S. tax authorities substantial information regarding U.S. account holders of such institution (which includes certain equity and debt holders of such institution, as well as certain account holders that are foreign entities with U.S. owners). An intergovernmental agreement between the United States and an applicable foreign country, or future Treasury regulations, may modify these requirements. FATCA also generally imposes a U.S. federal withholding tax of 30% on dividends and the gross proceeds of a disposition of our common stock paid to a non-financial foreign entity unless such entity either (i) certifies to us that such entity does not have any “substantial United States owners” or (ii) provides the withholding agent with a certification identifying the direct and indirect U.S. owners of the entity. Under final Treasury regulations and administrative guidance, any obligation to withhold from payments made to a foreign financial institution or a foreign non-financial entity under FATCA with respect to dividends on our common stock will not begin until July 1, 2014 and with respect to the gross proceeds of a sale or other disposition of our common stock will not begin until January 1, 2017. Under certain circumstances, a non-U.S. holder might be eligible for refunds or credits of such taxes. Prospective investors are encouraged to consult with their own tax advisors regarding the possible implications of FATCA on their investment in our common stock.

 

The preceding discussion of U.S. federal tax considerations is for general information only. It is not tax advice. Each prospective investor should consult its own tax advisor regarding the particular U.S. federal, state and local and non-U.S. tax consequences of purchasing, holding and disposing of our common stock, including the consequences of any proposed change in applicable laws.

 

123


Table of Contents

UNDERWRITING

 

Under the terms and subject to the conditions in an underwriting agreement dated the date of this prospectus, the underwriters named below, for whom Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co. are acting as representatives, have severally agreed to purchase, and we have agreed to sell to them the number of shares indicated as follows:

 

Underwriter

   Number of
Shares
 

Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC

  

Goldman, Sachs & Co.

Pacific Crest Securities LLC

  

Stifel, Nicolaus & Company, Incorporated

  

Needham & Company, LLC

  
  

 

 

 

Total

     4,800,000   
  

 

 

 

 

The underwriters and the representatives are collectively referred to as the “underwriters” and the “representatives,” respectively. The underwriters are offering the shares of common stock subject to their acceptance of the shares from us and subject to prior sale and their right to reject any order in whole or in part. The underwriting agreement provides that the obligations of the several underwriters to pay for and accept delivery of the shares of common stock offered by this prospectus are subject to the approval of certain legal matters by their counsel and to certain other conditions. The underwriters are obligated to take and pay for all of the shares of common stock offered by this prospectus if any such shares are taken. However, the underwriters are not required to take or pay for the shares covered by the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares described below.

 

The underwriters initially propose to offer part of the shares of common stock directly to the public at the offering price listed on the cover page of this prospectus and part to certain dealers. After the initial offering of the shares of common stock, the offering price and other selling terms may from time to time be varied by the representatives.

 

We and the selling stockholders have granted to the underwriters an option, exercisable for 30 days from the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to 720,000 additional shares of common stock at the public offering price listed on the cover page of this prospectus, less underwriting discounts and commissions. To the extent the option is exercised, each underwriter will become obligated, subject to certain conditions, to purchase about the same percentage of the additional shares of common stock as the number listed next to the underwriter’s name in the preceding table bears to the total number of shares of common stock listed next to the names of all underwriters in the preceding table.

 

The following table shows the per share and total public offering price, underwriting discounts and commissions, and proceeds before expenses to us and the selling stockholders. These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase up to an additional 720,000 shares of common stock.

 

     Per Share      Total  
        No Exercise      Full Exercise  

Public offering price

   $                $                $            

Underwriting discounts and commissions paid by:

        

Us

   $         $         $     

The selling stockholders

   $         $         $     

Proceeds, before expenses, to:

        

Us

   $         $         $     

The selling stockholders

   $         $         $     

 

124


Table of Contents

The estimated offering expenses payable by us and the selling stockholders, exclusive of the underwriting discounts and commissions, are approximately $        . We and the selling stockholders have agreed to reimburse the underwriters for expenses (including fees of their counsel) relating to clearance of this offering with the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority up to $30,000.

 

The underwriters have informed us that they do not intend sales to discretionary accounts to exceed 5% of the total number of shares of common stock offered by them.

 

Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the trading symbol “CVT.”

 

We, all of the executive officers, directors, and the selling stockholders representing the aggregate 75.74% of our outstanding stock and other equity securities outstanding immediately prior to this offering have agreed that, without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co. on behalf of the underwriters of this offering, we and they will not, during the period ending 90 days after the date of the final prospectus for this offering, or the restricted period:

 

   

offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant to purchase, lend or otherwise transfer or dispose of, directly or indirectly, any shares of common stock or any securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for shares of common stock;

 

   

file any registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission relating to the offering of any shares of common stock or any securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for common stock; or

 

   

enter into any swap or other arrangement that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of the economic consequences of ownership of the common stock

 

whether any such transaction described above is to be settled by delivery of common stock or such other securities, in cash or otherwise. In addition, we and each such person agrees that, without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co. on behalf of the underwriters, we or such other person will not, during the restricted period, make any demand for, or exercise any right with respect to, the registration of any shares of common stock or any security convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for common stock.

 

The lock-up restrictions described in the foregoing do not apply to us, our directors, officers and the selling stockholders with respect to, among other things:

 

   

the sale of shares to the underwriters;

 

   

the issuance by us of shares of common stock upon the exercise of an option or warrant or other convertible security outstanding on the date of this prospectus; provided that no public reports or filings reporting the transaction shall be required or shall be voluntarily made in respect of the issuance during the first 30 days of the restricted period and for any issuance thereafter any public reports or filings reporting the transaction that shall be required or shall be voluntarily made in respect of the issuance during the remainder of the restricted period shall include an appropriate footnote clearly indicating that the filing relates to the exercise of a stock option, that no shares were sold by the reporting person and that the shares received upon exercise of the stock option are subject to a lock-up;

 

   

the issuance by us of shares of common stock or other securities convertible into or exercisable for shares of our common stock pursuant to any employee benefit plan that has been described in this prospectus;

 

   

sale or issuance or entry into an agreement providing for the issuance by us of shares of our common stock or any security convertible into or exercisable for shares of our common stock in connection with the acquisition by us of one or more business, products or technologies (whether by means of merger, stock purchase, asset purchase or otherwise) or in connection with joint ventures or other strategic

 

125


Table of Contents
 

transactions, and the issuance of any such securities pursuant to any such agreement; provided, that the aggregate number of shares of our common stock that we may sell or issue or agree to sell or issue shall not exceed 5% of the total number of shares of our common stock issued and outstanding on the date immediately following the completion of this offering (as well as any issuance and sale of any option exercised by the underwriters); and provided further, that any such securities issued shall be subject to transfer restrictions substantially similar to those applicable to our stockholders;

 

   

the approval of by us or the establishment of trading plans by our stockholders pursuant to Rule 10b5-1 under the Exchange Act, for the transfer of shares of common stock by our stockholders; provided that such plan does not provide for the transfer of common stock during the restricted period and to the extent a public announcement or filing under the Exchange Act, if any, is required of or voluntarily made by or on behalf of the holder or us regarding the establishment of such plan, such announcement or filing shall include a statement to the effect that no transfer of common stock may be made under such plan during the restricted period;

 

   

the disposition of shares of common stock to us or the withholding of shares of common stock by us in a transaction exempt from Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act solely in connection with the payment of taxes due with respect to the vesting of restricted stock or restricted stock units, insofar as such restricted stock or restricted stock units is or are outstanding on the date of this prospectus and provided that no public reports or filings reporting the transaction shall be required or shall be voluntarily made in respect of the issuance during the first 30 days of the restricted period;

 

   

transfers to us in connection with the repurchase of shares of our common stock issued pursuant to employee benefit plans disclosed in this prospectus or pursuant to agreements pursuant to which such shares of our common stock were issued.

 

In addition, the lock-up restrictions described in the foregoing do not apply solely to our directors, officers and selling stockholders with respect to, among other things:

 

   

transfers of shares of common stock or any security convertible into common stock as (i) a bona fide gift, (ii) by will or intestacy to any trust for the direct or indirect benefit of the undersigned or any spouse, domestic partner, parent, sibling, child or grandchild of the stockholder, or (iii) if the holder is a corporation, partnership, limited liability company, trust or other business entity, distributions of shares of common stock or any security convertible into common stock to partners, members, stockholders or other equity owners of the holder or to another corporation, partnership, limited liability company, trust, or other business entity that controls, is controlled by or managed by or is under common control of the holder; provided that in the case of any such transfer or distribution, the transferee agrees to be bound in writing by the terms of the lock-up agreement prior to such transfer, such transfer involves no disposition for value and no filing under Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act reporting a reduction in beneficial ownership of shares of common stock shall be required or shall be voluntarily made in respect of the transfer or distribution during the 90-day restricted period; or

 

   

transactions relating to shares of common stock or other securities acquired in open market transactions after the completion of the offering of the shares, provided that no filing under Section 16 of the Exchange Act shall be required or shall be voluntarily made in connection with subsequent sales of common stock or other securities acquired in such open market transactions during the restricted period.

 

Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC and Goldman, Sachs & Co., in their sole discretion, may release the common stock and other securities subject to the lock-up agreements described above in whole or in part at any time with or without notice.

 

In addition, certain stockholders remain subject to lock-up agreements in connection with our IPO expiring on February 4, 2014 as described in greater detail in “Shares Eligible for Future Sale—Lock-Up Agreements—Lock-Up Agreements Entered into in Connection with our IPO.”

 

126


Table of Contents

In order to facilitate the offering of the common stock, the underwriters may engage in transactions that stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the price of the common stock. Specifically, the underwriters may sell more shares than they are obligated to purchase under the underwriting agreement, creating a short position. A short sale is covered if the short position is no greater than the number of shares available for purchase by the underwriters under the option. The underwriters can close out a covered short sale by exercising the option or purchasing shares in the open market. In determining the source of shares to close out a covered short sale, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the open market price of shares compared to the price available under the option. The underwriters may also sell shares in excess of the option, creating a naked short position. The underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the common stock in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in this offering. As an additional means of facilitating this offering, the underwriters may bid for, and purchase, shares of common stock in the open market to stabilize the price of the common stock. These activities may raise or maintain the market price of the common stock above independent market levels or prevent or retard a decline in the market price of the common stock. The underwriters are not required to engage in these activities and may end any of these activities at any time.

 

We, the selling stockholders and the several underwriters have agreed to indemnify each other against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.

 

A prospectus in electronic format may be made available on websites maintained by one or more underwriters, or selling group members, if any, participating in this offering. The representative may agree to allocate a number of shares of common stock to underwriters for sale to their online brokerage account holders. Internet distributions will be allocated by the representative to underwriters that may make Internet distributions on the same basis as other allocations.

 

The underwriters and their respective affiliates are full service financial institutions engaged in various activities, which may include securities trading, commercial and investment banking, financial advisory, investment management, investment research, principal investment, hedging, financing and brokerage activities. Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future perform, various financial advisory and investment banking services for us or our affiliates, for which they received or will receive customary fees and expenses.

 

In the ordinary course of their various business activities, the underwriters and their respective affiliates may make or hold a broad array of investments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of their customers and may at any time hold long and short positions in such securities and instruments. Such investment and securities activities may involve our securities and instruments (directly, as collateral securing other obligations or otherwise). The underwriters and their respective affiliates may also make investment recommendations and/or publish or express independent research views in respect of such securities or instruments and may at any time hold, or recommend to clients that they acquire, long and/or short positions in such securities and instruments.

 

In the ordinary course of business, we have sold, and may in the future sell, products or services to one or more of the underwriters or their respective affiliates in arms-length transactions on market competitive terms.

 

Selling Restrictions

 

European Economic Area

 

In relation to each Member State of the European Economic Area which has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a “Relevant Member State”) an offer to the public of any shares of our common stock may not

 

127


Table of Contents

be made in that Relevant Member State, except that an offer to the public in that Relevant Member State of any shares of our common stock may be made at any time under the following exemptions under the Prospectus Directive, if they have been implemented in that Relevant Member State:

 

  (a)   to any legal entity which is a qualified investor as defined in the Prospectus Directive;

 

  (b)   to fewer than 100 or, if the Relevant Member State has implemented the relevant provision of the 2010 PD Amending Directive, 150, natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined in the Prospectus Directive), as permitted under the Prospectus Directive, subject to obtaining the prior consent of the representatives for any such offer; or

 

  (c)   in any other circumstances falling within Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive, provided that no such offer of shares of our common stock shall result in a requirement for the publication by us or any underwriter of a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive.

 

For the purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer to the public” in relation to any shares of our common stock in any Relevant Member State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and any shares of our common stock to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase any shares of our common stock, as the same may be varied in that Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that Member State, the expression “Prospectus Directive” means Directive 2003/71/EC (and amendments thereto, including the 2010 PD Amending Directive, to the extent implemented in the Relevant Member State), and includes any relevant implementing measure in the Relevant Member State, and the expression “2010 PD Amending Directive” means Directive 2010/73/EU.

 

United Kingdom

 

Each underwriter has represented and agreed that:

 

  (a)   it has only communicated or caused to be communicated and will only communicate or cause to be communicated an invitation or inducement to engage in investment activity (within the meaning of Section 21 of the FSMA) received by it in connection with the issue or sale of the shares of our common stock in circumstances in which Section 21(1) of the FSMA does not apply to us; and

 

  (b)   it has complied and will comply with all applicable provisions of the FSMA with respect to anything done by it in relation to the shares of our common stock in, from or otherwise involving the United Kingdom.

 

Hong Kong

 

The shares may not be offered or sold by means of any document other than (i) in circumstances which do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap.32, Laws of Hong Kong), or (ii) to “professional investors” within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap.571, Laws of Hong Kong) and any rules made thereunder, or (iii) in other circumstances which do not result in the document being a “prospectus” within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap.32, Laws of Hong Kong), and no advertisement, invitation or document relating to the shares may be issued or may be in the possession of any person for the purpose of issue (in each case whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere), which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public in Hong Kong (except if permitted to do so under the laws of Hong Kong) other than with respect to shares which are or are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to “professional investors” within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571, Laws of Hong Kong) and any rules made thereunder.

 

Singapore

 

This prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this prospectus and any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or

 

128


Table of Contents

invitation for subscription or purchase, of the shares may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the shares be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to persons in Singapore other than (i) to an institutional investor under Section 274 of the Securities and Futures Act, Chapter 289 of Singapore (the “SFA”), (ii) to a relevant person, or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A), and in accordance with the conditions, specified in Section 275 of the SFA or (iii) otherwise pursuant to, and in accordance with the conditions of, any other applicable provision of the SFA.

 

Where the shares are subscribed or purchased under Section 275 by a relevant person which is: (a) a corporation (which is not an accredited investor) the sole business of which is to hold investments and the entire share capital of which is owned by one or more individuals, each of whom is an accredited investor; or (b) a trust (where the trustee is not an accredited investor) whose sole purpose is to hold investments and each beneficiary is an accredited investor, shares, debentures and units of shares and debentures of that corporation or the beneficiaries’ rights and interest in that trust shall not be transferable for 6 months after that corporation or that trust has acquired the shares under Section 275 except: (1) to an institutional investor under Section 274 of the SFA or to a relevant person, or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A), and in accordance with the conditions, specified in Section 275 of the SFA; (2) where no consideration is given for the transfer; or (3) by operation of law.

 

Japan

 

The securities have not been and will not be registered under the Financial Instruments and Exchange Law of Japan (the Financial Instruments and Exchange Law) and each underwriter has agreed that it will not offer or sell any securities, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to, or for the benefit of, any resident of Japan (which term as used herein means any person resident in Japan, including any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of Japan), or to others for re-offering or resale, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to a resident of Japan, except pursuant to an exemption from the registration requirements of, and otherwise in compliance with, the Financial Instruments and Exchange Law and any other applicable laws, regulations and ministerial guidelines of Japan.

 

129


Table of Contents

LEGAL MATTERS

 

The validity of the shares of common stock offered hereby has been passed upon for Cvent, Inc. by Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional Corporation, Washington, D.C. The underwriters have been represented in connection with this offering by Davis Polk & Wardwell LLP, New York, NY.

 

EXPERTS

 

The consolidated financial statements and schedule of Cvent, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2012 and for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2012, have been included herein and in the registration statement in reliance on the report of KPMG LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, appearing elsewhere herein, and upon the authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

 

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

 

We have filed a registration statement on Form S-1 with the SEC for the common stock we are offering pursuant to this prospectus. The rules and regulations of the SEC allow us to omit certain information from this prospectus that is included in the registration statement. Statements made in this prospectus concerning the contents of any contract, agreement or other document are summaries of all material information about the contract, agreement or other document summarized, but are not complete descriptions of all terms of those contracts, agreements or other documents. If we filed any of those contracts, agreements or other documents as an exhibit to the registration statement, you may read the contract, agreement or other document itself for a complete description of its terms.

 

You can read our SEC filings, including the registration statement, over the Internet at the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. You may also read and copy any document we file with the SEC at its public reference facilities at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. You may also obtain copies of the documents at prescribed rates by writing to the Public Reference Section of the SEC at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the operation of the public reference facilities.

 

We are subject to the information reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, and we file reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC. These reports, proxy statements and other information are available for inspection and copying at the public reference room and the SEC’s website referred to above. We also maintain a website at www.cvent.com, at which you may access these materials free of charge as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. The information contained in, or that can be accessed through, our website is not part of, and is not incorporated into, this prospectus.

 

130


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

     Page  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-2   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2012

     F-3   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012

     F-4   

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December  31, 2011 and 2012

     F-5   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012

     F-6   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012

     F-7   

Unaudited Consolidated Balance Sheet as of September 30, 2013

     F-33   

Unaudited Consolidated Statements of Operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013

     F-34   

Unaudited Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 and 2013

     F-35   

Notes to Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements for the nine months ended September  30, 2012 and 2013

     F-36   

 

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

The Board of Directors and Stockholders

Cvent, Inc.:

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Cvent, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2012. In connection with our audits of the consolidated financial statements, we also have audited financial statement schedule II. These consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Cvent, Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2012, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.

 

/s/ KPMG LLP

 

McLean, Virginia

April 29, 2013, except as to the third paragraph in

Note 14 to the consolidated financial

statements, which is as of August 5, 2013

 

F-2


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2012  

Assets

    

Current assets:

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 18,150      $ 16,850   

Restricted cash

            455   

Short-term investments

     8,335        9,320   

Accounts receivable, net of reserve of $326 and $505, respectively

     17,620        29,081   

Prepaid expense and other current assets

     4,240        3,128   

Deferred tax assets

     419        2,486   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     48,764        61,320   

Property and equipment, net

     4,939        6,756   

Capitalized software development costs, net

     4,269        5,428   

Intangible assets, net

            3,919   

Goodwill

            12,505   

Deferred tax assets, non-current

     469        102   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 58,441      $ 90,030   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

    

Current liabilities:

    

Accounts payable

   $ 412      $ 3,272   

Accrued and other current liabilities

     7,484        13,921   

Deferred revenue

     37,293        51,554   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     45,189        68,747   

Deferred tax liabilities, non-current

            2,134   

Other liabilities, non-current

     1,086        419   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     46,275        71,300   

Commitments and contingencies (Note 11)

    

Stockholders’ equity:

    

Series A convertible preferred stock, $0.001 par value, 69,675,300 shares authorized and 17,418,807 issued and outstanding

     17        17   

Common stock, $0.001 par value; 223,700,000 and 154,492,987 shares authorized, 15,665,416 and 15,901,183 issued and 15,652,261 and 15,380,969 outstanding at December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively

     16        16   

Treasury stock

     (16     (3,966

Additional paid-in capital

     36,200        42,409   

Accumulated deficit

     (24,051     (19,746
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     12,166        18,730   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

   $ 58,441      $ 90,030   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

F-3


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

 

     Year ended December 31,  
     2011     2012  

Revenue

   $ 60,854      $ 83,474   

Cost of revenue(1)

     16,660        20,573   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit

     44,194        62,901   

Operating expenses:

    

Sales and marketing(1)

     29,305        35,873   

Research and development(1)

     4,172        7,605   

General and administrative(1)

     8,422        11,523   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     41,899        55,001   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from operations

     2,295        7,900   

Interest income

     270        811   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from operations before income tax expense

     2,565        8,711   

Provision for income taxes

     2,749        4,406   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ (184   $ 4,305   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share:

    

Basic

   $ (0.01   $ 0.13   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ (0.01   $ 0.12   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding—basic

     16,757,527        33,167,358   

Weighted average common shares outstanding—diluted

     16,757,527        34,790,637   

 

(1)    Stock-based compensation expense included in the above:

    

Cost of revenue

   $ 690      $ 762   

Sales and marketing

     2,376        2,895   

Research and development

     373        539   

General and administrative

     512        1,010   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,951      $ 5,206   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

F-4


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

(in thousands except share data)

 

    Series B-1
redeemable
convertible
preferred stock
    Series B-2
redeemable
convertible
preferred stock
    Series A
redeemable
convertible
preferred stock
    Series A convertible
preferred stock
    Common stock     Treasury stock     Additional
paid-in
capital
    Accumulated
deficit
    Total
stockholders’
equity
 
    Shares     Amount     Shares     Amount     Shares     Amount     Shares     Amount     Shares     Amount     Shares     Amount        

Balance at January 1, 2011

    5,421,875      $ 14,982        9,508,789      $ 10,818        190,000      $ 716                      16,642,766      $ 17        (13,155     (16          $ (16,155   $ 10,362   

Exercise of restricted shares

                                                            1,090,988        1                      12               13   

Preferred stock accretion

           7,301               (401            15                                                  (12     (6,903       

Repurchase of preferred stock

    (19,531     (80     (554,298     (641                                                                    (809     (1,530

Conversion of preferred stock to common stock

    (5,402,344     (22,203     (8,954,491     (9,776     (190,000     (731                   14,926,832        15                      32,695                 

Issuance of preferred stock, net of transaction costs

                                              17,418,807      $ 17                                    135,006               135,023   

Repurchase of common stock

                                                                          (17,418,695     (135,866                   (135,866

Retirement of common stock

                                                            (17,418,695     (17     17,418,695        135,866        (135,849              

Exercise of stock options and warrants

                                                            423,525                             397               397   

Stock-based compensation expense

                                                                                        3,951               3,951   

Net loss

                                                                                               (184     (184
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2011

                                              17,418,807        17        15,665,416        16        (13,155     (16     36,200        (24,051     12,166   

Stock issued for Seed Labs acquisition

                                                            116,925                             935               935   

Repurchase of common stock

                                                                          (507,059     (3,950                   (3,950

Exercise of stock options

                                                            118,842                             68               68   

Stock-based compensation expense

                                                                                        5,206               5,206   

Net income

                                                                                               4,305        4,305   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2012

                                              17,418,807      $ 17        15,901,183      $ 16        (520,214   $ (3,966   $ 42,409      $ (19,746   $ 18,730   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

F-5


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(in thousands)

 

     Year ended December 31,  
     2011     2012  

Operating activities:

    

Net income (loss)

   $ (184   $ 4,305   

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:

    

Depreciation and amortization

     3,917        5,446   

Bad debt expense

     180        344   

Foreign currency transaction loss

     68          

Stock-based compensation expense

     3,951        5,206   

Change in deferred taxes

     175        434   

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

    

Accounts receivable, net

     (3,357     (9,618

Prepaid expenses and other assets

     (1,447     (587

Accounts payable, accrued and other liabilities

     3,376        4,486   

Deferred revenue

     7,931        13,565   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

     14,610        23,581   

Investing activities:

    

Purchase of property and equipment and capitalized software development costs

     (5,396     (8,118

Purchase of short-term investments

     (6,271     (986

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired

            (12,460

Restricted cash

            (455
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (11,667     (22,019

Financing activities:

    

Repurchase of preferred and common stock

     (137,055     (3,950

Proceeds from issuance of Series A preferred stock, net of transaction costs

     135,023          

Proceeds from exercise of stock options and warrants

     56        1,088   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in financing activities

     (1,976     (2,862
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     (68       

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     899        (1,300

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year

     17,251        18,150   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

   $ 18,150      $ 16,850   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental cash flow information:

    

Income taxes paid

   $ 3,153      $ 3,207   

Supplemental disclosure of non-cash investing and financing activities:

    

Change in accounts payable for purchase of property and equipment

   $      $ 102   

Issuance of common stock in acquisition

   $      $ 935   

Cashless exercise of common stock warrants

   $ 341      $   

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

F-6


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

1. Description of Business

 

Cvent, Inc. (the “Company”) was incorporated on August 20, 1999 in the State of Delaware. The Company provides a cloud-based enterprise event management platform with solutions for both sides of the events and meetings value chain: (i) event and meeting planners and (ii) hotels and venues. The Company’s integrated, cloud-based solution addresses the entire event lifecycle by allowing event and meeting planners to organize, market and manage their meetings, conferences, tradeshows and other events. The Company’s online marketplace connects event planners and venues through its vertical search engine that accesses its proprietary database of detailed hotel and venue information. The combination of these solutions creates an integrated platform that allows the Company to generate revenue from both sides of the events and meetings value chain.

 

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

 

(a) Basis of Presentation

 

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiaries. All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. These consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.

 

(b) Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Significant estimates and assumptions made by management include estimated useful lives of property and equipment, application of appropriate revenue recognition standards, allowances for doubtful accounts, valuation of deferred tax assets, stock-based compensation, income taxes and legal and other contingencies. The current economic environment has increased the degree of uncertainty inherent in those estimates and assumptions. Actual results could differ from those estimates and assumptions.

 

(c) Cash and Cash Equivalents

 

Highly liquid financial instruments purchased with original maturities of 90 days or less at the date of purchase are reported as cash equivalents. Cash equivalents are recorded at cost, which approximates fair value.

 

Included in cash and cash equivalents are funds representing amounts reserved for the face value of registration fees or tickets sold on behalf of customers. While these cash accounts are not restricted as to their use, a liability for amounts due to customers under these arrangements has been recorded in accounts payable in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The Company had amounts due to customers of zero and $1,351 of these funds as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

(d) Restricted Cash

 

Restricted cash includes amounts required to be held for specified purposes in India. The Company held zero and $455 of restricted cash as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

(e) Short-term Investments

 

The Company’s short-term investments consist of highly liquid financial instruments with original maturities greater than 90 days but less than one year. These short-term investments are comprised of certificates-of-deposit and are carried at fair value.

 

(f) Accounts Receivable

 

Accounts receivable are recorded at the invoiced amount and do not bear interest. The Company maintains an allowance for doubtful accounts for estimated losses inherent in its accounts receivable portfolio. In reviewing outstanding receivables, management considers historical write-off experience, the amount of receivables in dispute, and the current receivables aging and current payment patterns. Past due balances over 90 days and over a specified amount are reviewed individually for collectability. Account balances are written off after all means of collection have been exhausted and the potential for recovery is considered remote.

 

Bad debt expense during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 was $180 and $344, respectively. The allowance for bad debt is consistent with actual historical write-offs; however, higher than expected bad debts may result in the future if write-offs are greater than the Company’s estimates. The Company does not have any off-balance-sheet credit exposure related to its customers.

 

No single customer accounted for more than 10% of the total accounts receivable as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, and no single customer accounted for more than 10% of revenue during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012.

 

(g) Revenue Recognition

 

The Company derives revenue from two primary sources: platform subscription-based solutions and marketing solutions. These services are generally provided under annual and multi-year contracts that are generally only cancellable for cause and revenue is generally recognized on a straight-line basis over the life of the contract. The Company recognizes revenue when all of the following conditions are met:

 

  (i)   persuasive evidence exists of an arrangement with the customer reflecting the terms and conditions under which the solutions or services will be provided;

 

  (ii)   delivery to customers has occurred or services have been rendered;

 

  (iii)   the fee is fixed or determinable; and

 

  (iv)   collection of the fees is reasonably assured.

 

The Company considers a signed agreement or other similar documentation to be persuasive evidence of an arrangement. Collectability is assessed based on a number of factors, including transaction history and the creditworthiness of a customer. If it is determined that collection is not reasonably assured, revenue is not recognized until collection becomes reasonably assured, which is generally upon receipt of cash.

 

The Company adopted the provisions of FASB ASU 2009-13, Revenue Recognition (Topic 605): Multiple-Deliverable Revenue Arrangements (EITF Issue No. 08-1, Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables) with respect to its multiple-element arrangements entered into or significantly modified on or after January 1,

 

F-8


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

2011. ASU 2009-13 amends ASC 605-25 to eliminate the requirement that all undelivered elements have vendor-specific objective evidence (VSOE) or third-party evidence (TPE) of selling price before an entity can recognize the portion of an overall arrangement fee that is attributable to items that have already been delivered. The adoption of ASU 2009-13 did not have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations.

 

Platform Subscription Revenue

 

The Company generates the majority of its revenue through software-as-a-service (SaaS) subscriptions to the event management platform, pricing for which is subject to the features and functionality selected. No features or functionality within the subscription-based services have stand alone value from one another and, therefore, the entire subscription fee is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the subscription arrangement.

 

SaaS subscriptions may include functionality that enables customers to manage the registration of participants attending the customer’s event or events. In some cases, the negotiated fee for the subscription is based on a maximum number of event registrations permitted over the subscription term. At any time during the subscription term, customers may elect to purchase blocks of additional registrations, which are referred to as up-sells. The fees associated with the up-sells are added to the original subscription fee, and the revenue is recognized over the remaining subscription period. In other more limited cases, a customer may purchase additional registrations on a pay-as-you-go basis, which are referred to as overages. The revenue for overages is recognized as each additional registration is used by the customer. No portion of the subscription fee is refundable regardless of the actual number of registrations that occur. Other subscription-based solutions include the sale of mobile event apps as well as survey solutions, both of which are contracted through annual or multi-year agreements.

 

Subscription agreements do not provide customers with the right to take possession of the underlying software at any time.

 

Marketing Solutions Revenue

 

Marketing solutions revenue is generated through the delivery of various forms of advertising sold through annual or multi-year advertising contracts. Such solutions include prominent display of a customer’s venue within the Cvent Supplier Network, the Cvent Destination Guide or in various electronic newsletters. Pricing for the advertisements is based on the targeted geography, number of advertisements and prominence of the ad placement.

 

The Company enters into arrangements with multiple deliverables that generally include various marketing solutions that may be sold individually or bundled together and delivered over various periods of time. In such situations, the Company applies the provisions of Financial Accounting Standards Board, or FASB, Accounting Standards Codification, or ASC, No. 605-25, Revenue Recognition—Multiple Element Arrangements to account for the various elements within the marketing solution agreements delivered over the platform. Under such guidance, in order to treat deliverables in a multiple-deliverable arrangement as separate units of accounting, the deliverables must have standalone value upon delivery. If the deliverables have standalone value upon delivery, the Company accounts for each deliverable separately and revenue is recognized ratably over the contractual period that the related advertising deliverable is provided. Annual marketing solutions on the Cvent Supplier Network are often sold separately, and, as such, all have standalone value.

 

F-9


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

Some one-time marketing solutions, which can run for a month, several months, or a year, are primarily sold in a package. In determining whether the marketing solutions sold in packages have standalone value, the Company considers the availability of the services from other vendors, the nature of the solutions, and the contractual dependence of the solutions to the rest of the package. The Company has concluded that all of the marketing solutions in the packages included in multiple-deliverable arrangements executed have standalone value.

 

Revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables are divided into separate units of accounting and the arrangement consideration is allocated to all deliverables based on the relative selling price method. In such circumstances, the Company uses the selling price hierarchy of: (i) vendor specific objective evidence of fair value, or VSOE, if available, (ii) third-party evidence of selling price, or TPE, and (iii) best estimate of selling price. VSOE is limited to the price charged when the same element is sold separately by the Company. Due to the unique nature of some multiple deliverable revenue arrangements, the Company may not be able to establish selling prices based on historical stand-alone sales using VSOE or TPE; therefore the Company may use its best estimate to establish selling prices for these arrangements. The Company establishes the best estimates within a range of selling prices considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, factors such as size of transaction, customer demand and price lists.

 

(h) Deferred Revenue

 

Deferred revenue consists of billings or payments received in advance of revenue recognition from platform subscription services or marketing solutions that are subsequently recognized when the revenue recognition criteria are met. The Company generally invoices customers in annual or quarterly installments.

 

(i) Cost of Revenue

 

The Company’s cost of revenue consists of employee-related expenses, including salaries, benefits and stock-based compensation related to providing support and hosting applications, costs of data center capacity, software license fees and amortization expense associated with capitalized software. In addition, the Company allocates a portion of overhead, such as rent, information technology costs, depreciation and amortization to cost of revenue based on headcount.

 

(j) Property and Equipment

 

Property and equipment is stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Improvements and replacements of property and equipment are capitalized. Maintenance and repairs that do not improve or extend the lives of property and equipment are charged to expense as incurred. When assets are sold or retired, their cost and related accumulated depreciation are removed from the accounts and any gain or loss is reported in operating income of the consolidated statements of income. Depreciation is computed using the straight line method over the estimated useful lives of the related assets. The estimated useful life of computer equipment and software is three years while the estimated useful lives of furniture and equipment is seven years. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the shorter of the lease term or estimated useful life of the asset.

 

(k) Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

 

The Company evaluates the recoverability of its long-lived assets in accordance with Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets Subsections of FASB ASC Subtopic 360-10, Property, Plant, and Equipment—

 

F-10


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

Overall. Long-lived assets are reviewed for possible impairment whenever events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. If such review indicates that the carrying amount of long-lived assets is not recoverable from future undiscounted cash flows, the carrying amount of such assets is reduced to the lower of the carrying value or fair value.

 

In addition to the recoverability assessment, the Company routinely reviews the remaining estimated lives of its long-lived assets. Any reduction in the useful life assumption will result in increased depreciation and amortization expense in the period when such determinations are made, as well as in subsequent periods. There was no impairment of long-lived assets during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012.

 

(l) Goodwill

 

As a result of the Company’s acquisitions in 2012 (Note 4), the Company recorded goodwill. Goodwill represents the excess of: (i) the aggregate of the fair value of consideration transferred in a business combination, over (ii) the fair value of assets acquired, net of liabilities assumed. Goodwill is not amortized, but is subject to annual impairment tests. The goodwill impairment test is a two-step test. Under the first step, the fair value of the reporting unit is compared with its carrying value (including goodwill). If the fair value of the reporting unit is less than its carrying value, an indication of goodwill impairment exists for the reporting unit and the entity must perform step two of the impairment test (measurement). Under step two, an impairment loss is recognized for any excess of the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s goodwill over the implied fair value of that goodwill. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined by allocating the fair value of the reporting unit in a manner similar to a purchase price allocation and the residual fair value after this allocation is the implied fair value of the reporting unit goodwill. Fair value of the reporting unit is determined using a discounted cash flow analysis. If the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying value, step two does not need to be performed.

 

In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-08, Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Testing Goodwill for Impairment. This ASU permits an entity to make a qualitative assessment of whether it is more likely than not that a reporting unit’s fair value is less than its carrying amount before applying the two-step goodwill impairment test. If an entity concludes it is not more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, it need not perform the two-step impairment test. The ASU is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption is permitted. The Company adopted the provisions of ASU 2011-08 as of January 1, 2012.

 

The Company performs its annual impairment review of goodwill on November 30 and when a triggering event occurs between annual impairment tests. Based on the Company’s qualitative assessment, there was no indication of impairment as of December 31, 2012.

 

(m) Capitalized Software Development Costs

 

Costs to develop internal use software are capitalized and recorded as capitalized software in accordance with the provisions of FASB ASC Subtopic 350-40, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other Subtopic 40 Internal-Use Software on the balance sheet. These costs are amortized on a project-by-project basis using the straight-line method over the estimated economic life of the application, which is generally three years, beginning when the asset is substantially ready for use. Costs incurred during the preliminary development stage, as well as maintenance and training costs are expensed as incurred.

 

F-11


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

(n) Research and Development

 

Research and development expenses consist primarily of personnel and related expenses for the Company’s research and development staff, including salaries, benefits, bonuses and stock-based compensation and the cost of certain third-party contractors. Research and development costs, other than software development expenses qualifying for capitalization, are expensed as incurred.

 

(o) Sales Commissions

 

Sales commissions are the costs directly associated with platform subscription and marketing solutions contracts with customers and consist of commissions paid to the Company’s direct sales force. Sales commissions are expensed when incurred as a component of sales and marketing expense and are generally paid one month in arrears. Commissions incurred, but not paid, are included in accrued expenses in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Sales commissions paid are subject to a claw back provision in the event a customer contract is cancelled in proportion to the remaining contract period at the date of cancellation and are recorded net in sales and marketing expense. Amounts charged back have not been material to the Company’s results of operations.

 

(p) Deferred Tax Assets and Liabilities

 

Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date. To the extent that it is not considered to be more likely than not that a deferred tax asset will be realized, a valuation allowance is established. The Company applies the provisions of FASB interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes (“FIN 48”) (included in ASC Subtopic 740-10, Income Taxes—Overall), which provides guidance related to the accounting for uncertain tax positions. In accordance with FIN 48, the Company only recognizes the tax benefit from an uncertain tax position if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained on examination.

 

(q) Stock-Based Compensation Plan

 

The Company accounts for its employee stock-based compensation awards in accordance with ASC Topic 718, Compensation—Stock Compensation. ASC Topic 718 requires that all employee stock-based compensation is recognized as a cost in the financial statements and that for equity-classified awards such cost is measured at the grant date fair value of the award. The Company estimates grant date fair value using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model.

 

Determining the fair value of stock-based compensation awards under this model requires judgment, including estimating the value per share of the Company’s common stock, estimated volatility, risk free rate, expected term and estimated dividend yield. The assumptions used in calculating the fair value of stock-based compensation awards represent the Company’s best estimates, based on management judgment. The estimate of the value per share of the Company’s common stock used in the option-pricing model is based on the

 

F-12


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

contemporaneous valuations performed with the assistance of an unrelated third-party valuation specialist and management’s analysis of market transactions in proximity to the valuation dates. The estimated dividend yield is zero since the Company has not issued dividends to date and does not anticipate issuing dividends. The risk-free interest rate is based on the implied yield currently available on U.S. Treasury zero coupon issues with an equivalent remaining term. The Company estimates volatility for option grants by evaluating the average historical volatility of a peer group of similar public companies. The expected term of the Company’s option plans represent the period that its stock-based awards are expected to be outstanding. For purposes of determining the expected term, the Company applies the simplified approach, in which the expected term of an award is presumed to be the mid-point between the vesting date and the expiration date of the award. Awards generally vest over a service period of four years, with a maximum contractual term of ten years.

 

Pursuant FASB ASC Subtopic 718-10-35, Stock Compensation, the initial determination of compensation cost is based on the number of stock options granted amortized over the vesting period. The value of the awards granted is discounted by the forfeiture rate equal to the value expected to vest. The forfeiture rate was derived by taking into consideration historical employee turnover rates as well as expectations for the future. Expense is recognized using the straight-line attribution method.

 

(r) Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 

There was no difference between net income (loss) presented in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss) for each of the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012.

 

(s) Foreign Currency Transactions

 

The Company’s foreign subsidiary in India designates the U.S. dollar as the functional currency. For the subsidiary, assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currency are remeasured into U.S. dollars at current exchange rates for monetary assets and liabilities and historical exchange rates for nonmonetary assets and liabilities. Foreign currency gains and losses associated with remeasurement are included in general and administrative expense in the consolidated statements of operations.

 

Foreign currency transaction losses associated with remeasurement were $1,568 and $137 for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

(t) Non-Monetary Transactions

 

The Company occasionally participates in non-monetary transactions with its customers in exchange for marketing services. The cost of the services received approximate the value of the services provided and as a result no gain or loss is recognized on the transaction. Non-monetary transactions totaled $362 for the year ended December 31, 2012. The Company did not have any non-monetary transactions during the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

(u) Fair Value Measurements

 

Fair value represents the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. Valuation techniques used to measure fair value must maximize the

 

F-13


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. The fair value hierarchy is based on the following three levels of inputs, of which the first two are considered observable and the last one is considered unobservable:

 

   

Level 1 Inputs: Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities accessible to the reporting entity at the measurement date.

 

   

Level 2 Inputs: Other than quoted prices included in Level 1 inputs that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly, for substantially the full term of the asset or liability.

 

   

Level 3 Inputs: Unobservable inputs that require the Company to use present value and other valuation techniques in the determination of fair value.

 

The Company’s financial instruments include cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments, accounts receivable, accounts payable and accrued liabilities. The carrying value of these financial instruments on the consolidated balance sheets approximate their fair value based on their short-term nature.

 

The Company is also subject to certain contingent consideration arrangements associated with recent acquisitions that are based on achieving specified operating targets and the passage of time. Assumptions including revenue forecasts, future market opportunities, complexity and size of addressable markets and the scalability of the product are developed to determine the fair value of such contingent consideration. In addition, the probability of achieving the specified targets is considered in determining the fair value of the contingent consideration included in the purchase price. Cvent will continue to remeasure contingent consideration to fair value at each reporting date, and will recognize any changes to the fair value in earnings for any changes resulting from events after the acquisition date, such as meeting a sales target.

 

F-14


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

3. Net Income (Loss) Per Share

 

The Company calculates basic net income (loss) per share of common stock by dividing net income (loss) attributable to the common stockholders for the period by the weighted-average number of shares of common stock and participating convertible preferred stock outstanding during the period. The Company calculates diluted net income (loss) per share by dividing net income (loss) attributable to the Company for the period by the weighted-average number of shares of common stock and convertible preferred stock outstanding during the period, plus any dilutive effect from share-based equity awards and warrants during the period, as calculated in 2012 using the treasury stock method. The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock does not participate in earnings differently than common stock. Accordingly, the net income attributable to common and preferred stockholders would be divided proportionately by the number of shares outstanding of each and there would be no difference in the determination of basic and diluted net income (loss) per share calculated separately for common and preferred stock. Included in the diluted weighted average shares outstanding is the effect of early option exercises of 573,941 shares on June 13, 2012. These shares are removed from the basic earnings per share calculation as the shares can be repurchased by the Company prior to the vesting date should employment of the early exercised option shareholders be terminated. The computation of basic and diluted net income (loss) per share is as follows:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2011     2012  

Net income (loss)

   $ (184   $ 4,305   

Weighted average number of shares outstanding:

    

Weighted average common shares outstanding

     16,757,527        15,748,551   

Effect of convertible preferred stock

            17,418,807   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding for basic earnings per share

     16,757,527        33,167,358   

Effect of share-based equity award plan

            1,555,447   

Effect of warrants

            67,832   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding for diluted earnings per share

     16,757,527        34,790,637   

Net income (loss) per share:

    

Basic

   $ (0.01   $ 0.13   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ (0.01   $ 0.12   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

The weighted average number of shares outstanding used in the computation of basic and diluted loss per share for the year ended December 31, 2011 does not include the effect of 17,418,807 convertible preferred stock, as these shares are not obligated to participate in losses. The weighted average number of shares outstanding used in the computation of diluted loss per share for the year ended December 31, 2011 does not include the effect of 1,839,607 stock options and warrants and convertible preferred stock. The effects of these potentially outstanding shares were not included in the calculation of diluted loss per share because the effect would have been anti-dilutive.

 

Unaudited Pro Forma Information

 

All of the outstanding shares of convertible preferred stock will convert into common stock on the closing of an initial public offering of common stock at a price per share of not less than $15.60 under the Securities Act of 1933 on a 1:1 basis. For purposes of pro forma basic net income per share, all shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock have been treated as though they have converted to common stock of the Company at the beginning of the period.

 

F-15


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

The computation of pro forma basic and diluted net income per share is as follows:

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2012
 

Net income

   $ 4,305   
  

 

 

 

Pro forma weighted average number of shares outstanding:

  

Weighted average common shares outstanding

     15,748,551   

Effect of convertible preferred stock

     17,418,807   
  

 

 

 

Pro forma weighted average shares outstanding for basic earnings per share

     33,167,358   

Effect of share-based equity award plan

     1,555,447   

Effect of warrants

     67,832   
  

 

 

 

Pro forma weighted average shares outstanding for diluted earnings per share

     34,790,637   

Pro forma net income per share:

  

Basic

   $ 0.13   
  

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ 0.12   
  

 

 

 

 

4. Acquisitions

 

During the year ended December 31, 2012, we acquired three separate businesses as further described below. Operating results of the acquisitions for the period from the date of acquisition through December 31, 2012 are not significant, both individually and in the aggregate for the year ended December 31, 2012 and as a result, pro forma results of the acquisitions have not been presented.

 

Seed Labs

 

On January 17, 2012, the Company acquired all outstanding units of Seed Labs, LLC, a developer of mobile apps for consumer events. Upon completion of the acquisition the Company re-branded Seed Labs, LLC with the name CrowdTorch (“CrowdTorch”). CrowdTorch was acquired for total consideration of $2,398 in cash and stock consideration. The Company funded the purchase price with $1,406 of cash (net of cash acquired) and from the issuance of 116,925 shares of common stock with an estimated fair value of $935 at the date of acquisition. Of the total consideration, $57 was not paid as of December 31, 2012, and will be paid out over a three year period as deferred consideration. The present value of the deferred consideration was not materially different from the fair value. In addition, nominal contingent consideration of up to $43 based on the achievement of certain revenue targets has not been included in purchase price as the probability of achieving the targets was considered remote.

 

The table below represents the allocation of the purchase price for the acquired net assets of CrowdTorch based on their estimated fair values as of January 17, 2012. The allocation of the purchase price was based upon estimates of fair value of the corresponding assets and liabilities as follows:

 

Tangible assets

   $ 269   

Software technology

     423   

Customer relationships

     70   

Goodwill

     1,909   

Current liabilities

     (273
  

 

 

 

Total consideration

   $ 2,398   
  

 

 

 

 

F-16


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

In addition to amounts included as purchase consideration, the purchase agreement also provides for additional amounts totaling $1,167 to be paid over specified periods of time (deferred payments) or upon the achievement of specified targets (earn-outs) over one to three years. These additional payments are contingent upon the continued employment of those eligible to receive the payments and are considered compensatory arrangements that are being recognized as expense over the requisite service period, as earned. As of December 31, 2012, the Company has accrued approximately $260 of additional payments under these provisions, which were paid on January 17, 2013. Additionally, the purchase agreement also provides for payments of up to $893 upon the attainment of certain sales targets as well as on continued employment. These additional payments are deemed to be compensatory arrangements that will be recognized as expense over the requisite service period, as earned, but only to the extent that defined sales targets are forecasted to be met. As of December 31, 2012, no amounts related to these provisions have been accrued as the Company believes the likelihood of making contingent payments associated with the sales targets to be remote.

 

Software technology represents the preliminary estimated fair value of CrowdTorch’s mobile app development software. Customer relationships represent the preliminary fair values of the underlying relationships and agreements with CrowdTorch customers. The excess of purchase consideration over the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired of $1,909 was recorded as goodwill and was primarily attributed to enhanced marketing opportunities within the consumer event planning market.

 

Acquisition-related costs of $77 including transaction costs such as legal and accounting fees were expensed as incurred. The acquisition-related costs are included in general and administrative expenses in the consolidated statements of operations.

 

CrowdCompass

 

On June 12, 2012, the Company completed the acquisition of all of the capital stock of CrowdCompass, Inc. (“CrowdCompass”) for total consideration of $5,977, which consisted of $5,831 in cash (net of cash acquired and settlement of debt) and deferred consideration of $200 (fair value $146) to be paid over a three-year period. The acquisition of CrowdCompass was to, among other reasons, expand the Companies offering of event planning tools to include mobile apps for business events.

 

The table below represents the allocation of the preliminary purchase price for the acquired net assets of CrowdCompass based on their estimated fair values as of June 12, 2012. The allocation of the purchase price was based upon estimates of fair value of the corresponding assets and liabilities as follows:

 

Tangible assets

   $ 296   

Software technology

     1,400   

Customer relationships

     550   

Trademarks / trade names

     180   

Goodwill

     5,081   

Current liabilities

     (688

Deferred tax liability

     (842
  

 

 

 

Total consideration

   $ 5,977   
  

 

 

 

 

In addition to amounts included as purchase consideration, the purchase agreement also provides for additional amounts totaling $3,800 to be paid over specified periods of time (deferred payments) or upon the

 

F-17


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

achievement of specified targets (earn-outs) over one to three years. These additional payments are contingent upon the continued employment of those eligible to receive the payments and are considered compensatory arrangements that are being recognized as expense over the requisite service period, as earned. As of December 31, 2012, $736 related to these provisions has been accrued.

 

Software technology represents the preliminary estimated fair value of CrowdCompass’s mobile app development software. Customer relationships represent the preliminary fair values of the underlying relationships and agreements with CrowdCompass customers. The trademarks/trade names represent the CrowdCompass trademarks and trade names that the Company intends to use for a fixed period of time. The excess of purchase consideration over the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired of $5,081 was recorded as goodwill. The initial purchase price allocation is preliminary as of December 31, 2012. Changes to amounts recorded as assets or liabilities, may result in a corresponding adjustment to goodwill. The goodwill balance is attributed to the assembled workforce, event planning synergies and cost reductions gained through integration. The goodwill balance is deductible for U.S. income tax purposes.

 

Acquisition-related costs of $232 including transaction costs such as legal and accounting fees were expensed as incurred. The acquisition-related costs are included in general and administrative expenses in the consolidated income statements.

 

TicketMob

 

In December 2012, the Company completed the acquisition of TicketMob LLC (“TicketMob”) for total consideration of $5,918 to, among other things, extend the Company’s ability to provide a more comprehensive solution for business-to-business event planning worldwide as well as enter the business-to-consumer market. The $5,918 acquisition price includes $5,223 in cash (net of cash acquired), $250 retained as litigation holdback and $445, to be paid in equal installments on the 18-month and 36-month anniversary of the transaction. The present value of the consideration was not materially different from the fair value. The purchase agreement also provides for additional payments up to $6,494 (“contingent consideration”), based upon achievement of certain revenue targets. The estimated fair value of the contingent consideration is nominal, based on the Company’s assessment of the probability of achieving the contractual revenue targets, as adjusted to present value. As a result, no additional consideration was included in the total purchase price. The Company will record any adjustments to the fair value of the contingent consideration each reporting period based on TicketMob’s achievement of revenue targets as it relates to the contingent consideration. Any changes in fair value of contingent consideration will be recorded in the statement of operations.

 

In addition, the Company is obligated to pay $1,055, contingent on continued employment, in equal installments on the 18-month and 36-month anniversaries of the acquisition. This amount will be accrued over the 36-month period as earned based upon service to the Company. Additionally, the purchase agreement provides for up to an additional $7,006 in payments contingent upon the attainment of certain revenue targets as well as on continued employment. These additional payments are deemed to be compensatory arrangements that will be recognized as expense over the requisite service period, as earned, but only to the extent that defined revenue targets are forecasted to be met. As of December 31, 2012, no amounts related to these provisions have been accrued as TicketMob was acquired on the last day of calendar year 2012 and no amounts have been earned. The Company believes the likelihood of making contingent payments associated with the acquisition to be remote.

 

F-18


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

The table below represents the allocation of the preliminary purchase price for the acquired net assets of TicketMob based on their estimated fair values as of December 31, 2012. The allocation of the purchase price was based upon estimates of fair value of the corresponding assets and liabilities as follows:

 

Tangible assets

   $ 1,930   

Software technology

     437   

Customer relationships

     1,096   

Trademarks / trade names

     82   

Goodwill

     5,515   

Current liabilities

     (3,142
  

 

 

 

Total consideration

   $ 5,918   
  

 

 

 

 

Software technology represents the estimated fair value of TicketMob’s ticketing and venue management platform. Customer relationships represent the fair values of the underlying relationships and agreements with TicketMob customers. The trademarks / trade names represent the TicketMob trademarks and tradenames that the Company intends to use for a given period of time. The excess of purchase consideration over the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired of $5,515 was recorded as goodwill. The initial purchase price allocation is preliminary as of December 31, 2012. Changes to amounts recorded as assets or liabilities, may result in a corresponding adjustment to goodwill. The goodwill balance is attributed to the assembled workforce and expanded market opportunities when integrating TicketMob’s ticketing and venue management platform with the Company’s suite of event planning tools. The goodwill balance is deductible for U.S. income tax purposes.

 

Acquisition-related costs of $173 including transaction costs such as legal and accounting fees were expensed as incurred. The acquisition-related costs are included in general and administrative expenses in the consolidated income statements.

 

5. Property and Equipment and Capitalized Software Development Costs

 

Property and equipment and capitalized software development costs are summarized as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2012  

Computer equipment and purchased software

   $ 6,243      $ 8,226   

Furniture and equipment

     1,938        2,773   

Leasehold improvements

     3,558        4,561   

Automobile

     11        43   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     11,750        15,603   

Less accumulated depreciation

     (6,811     (8,847
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total property and equipment, net

   $ 4,939      $ 6,756   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Capitalized software development costs

   $ 7,327      $ 10,990   

Less accumulated amortization

     (3,058     (5,562
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capitalized software development costs

   $ 4,269      $ 5,428   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-19


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

Depreciation expense on property and equipment was $1,891 and $2,623 during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively. Amortization expense on capitalized software development costs was $2,026 and $2,504 during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

6. Goodwill and Intangible Assets

 

The following table presents the change in carrying amount of goodwill:

 

Goodwill as of December 31, 2011

       

Additions from acquisitions

   $ 12,505   
  

 

 

 

Goodwill as of December 31, 2012

   $ 12,505   
  

 

 

 

 

There were no intangible assets as of December 31, 2011. Intangible assets were acquired through acquisitions completed during the year ended December 31, 2012. Intangible assets are amortized on a straight line basis over their estimated useful lives between four and six years. The following table represents the acquisition of intangible assets made during the year ended December 31, 2012:

 

     Net carrying
amount
December 31,
2011
     Additions      Accumulated
amortization
     Net carrying
amount
December 31,
2012
 

Customer relationships

           $ 1,716       $ 66       $ 1,650   

Software technology

             2,260         233         2,027   

Trademarks/Tradenames

             262         20         242   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total intangible assets

           $ 4,238       $ 319       $ 3,919   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

The total amount of amortization expense relating to acquired intangibles was $319 during the year ended December 31, 2012. The intangible balance remaining as of December 31, 2012 will be amortized in future periods as follows:

 

2013

   $ 796   

2014

     796   

2015

     796   

2016

     780   

2017

     526   

Thereafter

     225   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,919   
  

 

 

 

 

F-20


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

7. Income Taxes

 

The Company’s income before taxes was taxed as indicated in the following jurisdictions:

 

     Years ended December 31,  
         2011             2012      

Pretax income (loss):

    

U.S.

   $ 2,818      $ 6,638   

Foreign

     (253     2,073   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2,565      $ 8,711   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

The components of the provision for income taxes attributable to continuing operations are as follows:

 

     Year ended December 31,  
         2011             2012      

Current income tax expense:

    

U.S. federal

   $ 1,786      $ 3,132   

U.S. state and local

     424        900   

Foreign jurisdiction

     714        808   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current tax expense

   $ 2,924      $ 4,840   

Deferred income tax expense (benefit):

    

U.S. federal

   $ (102   $ (304

U.S. state and local

     (18     (81

Foreign jurisdiction

     (55     (49
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax expense (benefit)

     (175     (434
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income tax provision

   $ 2,749      $ 4,406   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

A reconciliation between the Company’s statutory tax rate and the effective tax rate is as follows:

 

     Year ended December 31,  
         2011             2012      

U.S. federal statutory rate

     34.0     35.0

Increase (reduction) resulting from:

    

U.S. state income taxes, net of federal benefits

     4.7        5.9   

Stock compensation adjustment

     43.0        16.1   

Non-deductible expenses

     30.9        2.3   

Uncertain tax positions

     11.2        1.2   

Benefit of credits

     (5.3     (9.1

Provision to return differences

     (15.9       

Foreign tax rate differential

     5.4        (0.6

Other

     (0.5     (0.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     107.5     50.3
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-21


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2011     2012  

Deferred tax assets:

    

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 125      $ 199   

Reserves

     910        823   

Deferred rent

     374        488   

Accrued expenses and other

     595        674   

Foreign tax credit carryforward

     136        185   

Stock compensation

     317        790   

Net operating loss carryforwards

     1,029        970   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

   $ 3,486      $ 4,129   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

    

Basis difference in fixed assets

   $ (967   $ (914

Capitalized software development costs

     (1,631     (2,147

Intangibles—acquisitions

            (614
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

     (2,598     (3,675
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax asset

   $ 888      $ 454   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

Based on the Company’s operating history and management’s expectations of future profitability, management determined that it was more likely than not that its net deferred tax asset will be realized. No valuation allowance has been provided as of December 31, 2011 and 2012.

 

The Company had approximately $2,735 and $2,488 of federal net operating loss carryforwards at December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively. The tax effected amounts of these carryforward are $930 and $871 at December 31, 2011 and 2012 respectively. Additionally the tax effected state carryforward for losses are $99 at the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012. The net operating loss carryforwards will expire, if unused, in varying amounts beginning in 2021. The realization of the benefits of the net operating loss carryforwards is dependent on sufficient taxable income in future years. Lack of future earnings, a change in ownership of the Company, or the application of the alternative minimum tax rules could adversely affect the Company’s ability to utilize the net operating loss carryforward to reduce future current tax expense.

 

The Company had an ownership change in a prior year, as defined by Internal Revenue Code section 382, which triggered a limitation on the amount of net operating loss carryforward available to offset annual taxable income. The remaining net operating loss carryforward at December 31, 2011 and 2012 is subject to an annual limitation of approximately $246. Management has determined the Company will be able to utilize its net operating loss carryforwards subject to Section 382 limitations during the carryforward period.

 

The Company permanently reinvests cumulative undistributed earnings of its non- U.S. subsidiary in non-U.S. operations. U.S. federal income taxes have not been provided for in relation to undistributed earnings to the extent that they are permanently reinvested in the Company’s non-U.S. operations. It is not practical at this time to determine the income tax liability that would result upon repatriation to the U.S. As of December 31, 2012, the undistributed earnings of the Company’s foreign affiliate was approximately $1.6 million.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

The Company applies the provisions of ASC 740-10 to uncertain tax positions. ASC 740-10 clarifies accounting for income taxes by prescribing a minimum probability threshold that a tax position must meet before a financial statement benefit is recognized. If the probability for sustaining a tax position is greater than 50%, then the tax position is warranted and recognition should be at the highest amount which would be expected to be realized upon ultimate settlement. The impact of the adoption of ASC 740-10 did not have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements of the Company.

 

The following table presents a reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits:

 

     December 31,  
         2011              2012      

Unrecognized tax benefits, opening balance

   $ 36       $ 508   

Gross increases—tax positions in prior period

     220           

Gross decreases—tax positions in prior period

             1   

Gross increases—current-period tax positions

     252         105   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unrecognized tax benefits, ending balance

   $ 508       $ 614   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

The Company’s tax reserves relate to state and international tax issues. The Company does not believe it is reasonably possible that its unrecognized tax benefits would materially change in the next 12 months.

 

The Company is subject to U.S. federal income tax and state and local income tax in multiple jurisdictions. With few exceptions, the Company is no longer subject to income tax examinations by the U.S. federal, state or local tax authorities for years before 2008. While the federal statute of limitations generally is three years, the IRS can re-determine items in tax years normally barred by the statute of limitations if a net operating loss utilized in an open year was carried over from a closed year.

 

The Company’s practice is to recognize interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in income tax expense. The amount of interest and penalties included in income tax expense for the year ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 was approximately $258 and $50, respectively.

 

8. Stock-Based Compensation Plan

 

In 1999, the Company adopted a Stock Incentive Plan (the “Plan”) pursuant to which the Company’s Board of Directors may grant stock options or nonvested shares to officers and key employees. The Plan was amended in April 19, 2000 to increase the number of incentive stock and restricted stock (collectively the “Stock”) authorized to be issued under the Plan (the “Stock Pool”) from 600,000 to 4,050,000. The Plan was subsequently amended on April 1, 2001 to increase the Stock Pool to 6,331,250, on March 12, 2007 to increase the Stock Pool to 10,901,635, on March 11, 2011 to increase the Stock Pool to 14,783,135, and on July 15, 2011 to increase the Stock Pool to 15,854,691. To date, the Company has only granted stock options settleable in shares. Stock options can be granted with an exercise price less than, equal to or greater than the stock’s fair value at the date of grant. The awards have various terms and vest at various times from the date of grant, with most options vesting in tranches generally over four years. All options expire 10 years after the date of grant.

 

At December 31, 2012, there were 2,038,985 shares available for the Company to grant under the Plan. The grant-date fair value of each option award is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-

 

F-23


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

pricing model. The weighted average assumptions for 2012 and 2011 grants are provided in the following table. Because the Company’s shares are not publicly traded and its shares are rarely traded privately, expected volatility is estimated based on the average historical volatility of similar entities with publicly traded shares. The risk-free rate for the expected term of the option is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve at the date of grant. Expense is recognized using the straight-line attribution method.

 

The following is a summary of the weighted average assumptions used in the valuation of stock-based awards under the Black-Scholes model:

 

     Year ended December 31,  
         2011             2012      

Dividend yield

     0.00     0.00

Volatility

     54.01     54.28

Expected term (years)

     6.38        6.49   

Risk-free interest rate

     2.47     0.97

 

Stock option activity during the periods indicated is as follows:

 

     Number
of shares
subject to
option
    Weighted
average
exercise
price
     Weighted
average
remaining
contractual
term
(years)
     Aggregate
intrinsic
value
 

Balance at January 1, 2011

     742,071      $ 0.52         7.25       $ 950   

Granted

     2,766,284        1.96         

Exercised

     (211,995     0.20         

Forfeited

     (178,843     1.72         

Expired

     (150     2.40         
  

 

 

         

Balance at December 31, 2011

     3,117,367        1.76         8.79         19,452   

Granted

     396,625        6.76         

Exercised

     (118,842     0.56         

Forfeited

     (105,111     2.56         
  

 

 

         

Balance at December 31, 2012

     3,290,039        2.40         8.08         23,030   
  

 

 

         

Exercisable at December 31, 2012

     318,688      $ 0.56         5.33       $ 2,817   
  

 

 

         

 

The weighted average grant date fair value of options granted during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 was $2.60 and $4.68, respectively. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 was $1,192 and $891.

 

The Company recorded stock-based compensation expense related to options of $554 and $862 as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively, exclusive of the additional stock-based compensation expense related to the increases to the Company’s estimates of fair value per share, discussed below.

 

F-24


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

A summary of the status of the Company’s nonvested stock options as of December 31, 2012, and changes during the years ended December 31, 2012, is presented below:

 

     Number of
shares
subject to
option
    Weighted
average
grant-date
fair value
 

Balance at January 1, 2012

     2,813,783      $ 2.48   

Granted

     396,000        4.68   

Vested

     (136,881     0.84   

Forfeited

     (102,188     2.76   
  

 

 

   

Balance at December 31, 2012

     2,970,714      $ 2.84   
  

 

 

   

 

At December 31, 2012, there was $4,904 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested stock options granted under the Plan. That cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.79 years. The total fair value of shares vested during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 was $43 and $113, respectively.

 

On June 13, 2012, 573,941 of shares subject to option were exercised prior to vesting pursuant to an early exercise feature. The proceeds from the transaction are recorded as a liability within accrued and other current liabilities and other liabilities, non-current. These will be reclassified to common stock as the Company’s repurchase rights lapse.

 

Common Stock Valuations

 

The fair value of the common stock underlying the stock options was determined by the board of directors, which intended all options granted to be exercisable at a price per share not less than the per share fair value of the common stock underlying those options on the date of grant. The valuations of the common stock were determined in accordance with the guidelines outlined in the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Practice Aid, Valuation of Privately-Held-Company Equity Securities Issued as Compensation and Internal Revenue Service Revenue Ruling 59-60. The assumptions the Company used in the valuation model were based on future expectations combined with management judgment. In the absence of a public trading market, the board of directors with input from management exercised significant judgment and considered numerous objective and subjective factors to determine the fair value of the common stock as of the date of each option grant, including the following factors:

 

   

contemporaneous independent valuations performed at periodic intervals by an unrelated third-party valuation specialist;

 

   

the nature of the business and its history since inception;

 

   

the economic outlook in general and the condition and outlook of the specific industry;

 

   

the book value of the stock and the financial condition of the business;

 

   

the operating and financial performance and forecast;

 

   

whether or not the Company has goodwill or other intangible values;

 

   

recent sales of the common stock;

 

F-25


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

   

the prices, rights and privileges of the preferred stock relative to the common stock;

 

   

the hiring of key personnel;

 

   

present value of estimated future cash flows;

 

   

the likelihood of achieving a liquidity event for the shares of common stock underlying these stock options, such as an initial public offering or sale of the company, given prevailing market condition and the nature and history of the business;

 

   

illiquidity of stock-based awards involving securities in a private company;

 

   

the market performance of comparable publicly traded technology companies; and

 

   

the U.S. and global capital market conditions.

 

In addition to the values derived from the valuation models, management and the Company’s board of directors also considered relevant market activity and recent transactions, including the July 2011 transaction (note 9(c)) in evaluating the estimate of fair value per share for stock options granted during 2011 and 2012. As a result, the Company recorded additional stock-based compensation expense of $887 and $1,173 in the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 based on increases to the Company’s estimate of fair value. At December 31, 2012, there was $2,573 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to the revised estimated fair value of stock at grant dates. The following table summarizes the option grants from January 1, 2011 through December 31, 2012 and includes the revised fair value per share at grant date and related revised intrinsic value per share.

 

Grant date

   Number of
shares
subject to
option
     Per share
exercise price
     Common stock
fair value per
share at grant
date
     Intrinsic
value per
share
 

  1/21/2011

     45,375       $ 1.80       $ 3.60       $ 1.80   

  3/11/2011

     2,605,909         1.80         3.60         1.80   

12/29/2011

     115,000         5.96         8.00         2.04   

  3/19/2012

     45,750         5.96         8.00         2.04   

  6/11/2012

     194,625         5.96         8.00         2.04   

  7/24/2012

     75,750         8.00         8.00           

10/15/2012

     80,500         8.00         9.00         1.00   

 

Restricted Shares

 

On June 26, 2007, the Company granted options to purchase 4,363,950 shares of common stock per share with an exercise price of $0.01 per share equal to the fair market value per share of the common shares at the time of grant. These options, which were subject to certain performance vesting requirements, were early exercised, but continued to vest according to the original vesting terms.

 

In January 2011, management concluded that the performance vesting requirements had been met and the remaining 1,090,988 unvested shares were fully vested. Compensation expense relating to these shares was insignificant.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

9. Stockholders’ Equity

 

a) Series B-1, B-2 and A Redeemable Convertible Preferred Stock

 

Prior to the July 2011 transaction described below, Stockholders’ Equity was comprised of common stock and three classes of preferred stock issued to stockholders, as follows:

 

The Series B-1 Redeemable Convertible Preferred stock was convertible to common stock at the option of the stockholder on a one-for-one basis, and in the event of any liquidation, the holders of the Series B-1 preferred stock were entitled to be paid out first, a liquidation preference equal to $0.64 per share plus all unpaid dividends. At any time on or after the fifth anniversary of the original issue date, the holders of Series B-1 preferred stock were entitled to redeem the stock at a price per share equal to the greater of: (i) $0.64 per share, or (ii) any accrued dividends plus the result of a formula stipulated in the Certificate of Incorporation dated July 11, 2001. In addition, holders of the Series B-1 preferred stock were entitled to receive preferential cumulative dividends at a rate of 8% per annum.

 

The Series B-2 Redeemable Convertible Preferred stock was convertible to common stock at the option of the stockholder on a one-for-one basis, and in the event of any liquidation, the holders of the Series B-2 preferred stock were entitled to, after payments to the B-1 preferred stockholders, a liquidation preference equal to $0.64 per share plus all unpaid dividends. At any time on or after the first anniversary of a majority of Series B-1 preferred stock being redeemed, the holders of Series B-2 preferred stock were entitled to redeem their stock at a price per share equal to $0.64 per share plus all unpaid dividends accrued or declared. In addition, holders of the Series B-2 preferred stock were entitled to receive preferential cumulative dividends at a rate of 8% per annum.

 

The Series A Redeemable Convertible Preferred shares were convertible to common stock at the option of the stockholder on a three-for-one basis, and in the event of any liquation, the holders of the Series A preferred stock were entitled to a liquidation preference equal to $2.00 per share, plus all unpaid dividends accrued or declared, after payments to the Series B-1 and B-2 preferred stockholders. At any time on or after the first anniversary of a majority of Series B-1 preferred stock being redeemed, the holders of Series A preferred stock were entitled to redeem their stock at a price per share equal to the original purchase price plus simple interest at a rate of 8% per annum, plus all unpaid dividends accrued or declared.

 

Accretion of dividends to record redemption value was recognized as a decrease to additional paid-in capital, or if additional paid-in capital was reduced to zero, then accretion was recorded as an increase to accumulated deficit in the accompanying balance sheets.

 

b) Repurchase of Series B-1 and B-2 Redeemable Convertible Shares

 

In May 2011, subject to a tender offer to all of the Series B-1 and B-2 stockholders, the Company entered into a Stock Repurchase Agreement with certain B-1 and B-2 stockholders to repurchase 19,531 shares of Series B-1 preferred stock and 554,298 shares of Series B-2 preferred stock at a purchase price of $2.67 per share (inclusive of all rights and preferences), for a total of $1,530. The shares of B-1 and B-2 that were repurchased were retired.

 

c) Recapitalization and New Series A Convertible Preferred Stock

 

In July 2011 (July 2011 transaction), the holders of all existing Series B-1, B-2 and A redeemable convertible preferred stock approved the conversion of all outstanding shares of preferred stock to common stock

 

F-27


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

at a one-to-three ratio for Series A preferred stock and a one-to-one ratio for Series B-1 preferred stock and Series B-2 preferred stock, as set forth in the Certificate of Incorporation dated July 11, 2001. The Company simultaneously issued and sold 17,418,807 shares of the Company’s new Series A Convertible Preferred Stock to new, unaffiliated investors at a price of $7.80 per share, generating proceeds of $135,023, net of transaction costs and reimbursements of $844. Immediately thereafter, the Company repurchased 17,418,695 shares of common stock held by certain stockholders (including all of the previous holders of Series B-1, B-2 and A redeemable convertible preferred stock) for an aggregate of $135,525, net of $341 related to a cashless exercise of warrants. The repurchased shares were retired by the Company’s Board of Directors upon repurchase. Pursuant to and concurrent with these equity transactions, the Board of Directors amended and restated its Certificate of Incorporation and bylaws to adjust the amount of shares authorized for issuance to 224,168,287, of which 154,492,987 are designated as $0.001 common stock and 69,675,300 as $0.001 Series A Convertible Preferred Stock.

 

The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock is convertible at the option of the holder, at any time, on a one-to-one basis to common stock. The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock is not redeemable, has no preferences over the common stock with respect to dividends and voting rights, and has no liquidation preferences upon the winding up and dissolution of the Company. As a result, the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock is effectively akin to common stock. The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock votes on an as-if converted to common basis and has one vote for each share held. The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock does not participate in earnings differently than common stock. Each share of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock will be automatically converted to common stock on a one to one basis, immediately prior to the closing of an Initial Public Offering of the Company’s stock at a price per share of not less than $15.60 or upon request for conversion from holders of at least 67% of the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock.

 

d) Common Stock Call Option

 

In conjunction with the July 2011 transaction, the Company entered into a stock repurchase agreement (the Agreement) with certain members of senior management. The Agreement includes a contractual call option, providing the Company an option to repurchase up to 50% of the employee’s then outstanding shares of common stock for $7.80 per share in the event of resignation or termination by the employee. The call option is effective for the two-year period following the July 2011 transaction, expiring on July 15, 2013, and represents a compensatory arrangement in that the key employees must continue employment for a period of two years to earn back the right to participate in any appreciation in the value of the underlying shares or be subject to repurchase under the Company’s call option. Pursuant to the terms of the Agreement, stock options that vest and are exercised by management during the two-year period of the Agreement become subject to the repurchase provisions.

 

The value of the effective stock options created upon execution of the Agreement was determined using a Black-Scholes pricing model, and the associated compensation expense is being recognized on a straight-line basis over the two-year period and is included in sales and marketing, research and development, and general and administrative expense in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. Key assumptions used in the Black-Scholes pricing model were:

 

Dividend yield

     0.00

Volatility

     40.00

Expected term (years)

     2.00   

Risk-free interest rate

     0.37

 

F-28


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

The Company recorded stock-based compensation expense related to the employee’s compensatory arrangement created by the Company’s call option of $1,651 and $2,965 as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively. At December 31, 2012, there was $1,721 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to call options.

 

As of December 31, 2012, the Company had repurchased 504,559 shares of common stock at $7.80 per share for a total of $3,936 under this agreement resulting from the exercise of its call option in connection with the termination of the former chief financial officer. The repurchased shares are held in treasury stock at cost.

 

e) Common Stock

 

Pursuant to the July 2011 transactions, the Company designated 55,925,000 shares of $0.001 common stock, of which 15,652,261 and 15,380,969 were outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively. The holders of the common stock are entitled to dividends only when declared by the Board of Directors. Each share of common stock has one vote and vote together with the holders of the Series A Convertible Preferred Stock.

 

f) Common Stock Warrants

 

In 2011, the Company issued warrants to a non-employee to purchase 125,000 shares of common stock, with which it had an existing commercial agreement. The warrants have an exercise price of $1.80, vest annually over a four-year period, and expire on December 31, 2017. Additionally in 2011, the Company issued warrants to certain other non-employee stockholders for 203,700 shares of common stock at the exercise price of $1.80 per share, vesting immediately and expiring in 2018.

 

In connection with the July 2011 transaction, 188,974 of the warrants to non-employee shareholders were exercised in a cashless exercise resulting in the issuance of 145,365 shares of common stock. In addition, 22,559 warrants were exercised at an exercise price of $0.76 resulting in the issuance of 22,559 shares of common stock.

 

Unvested warrants to non-employees are re-measured at fair value as of each balance sheet date. The following is a summary of the weighted average assumptions used in the valuation of warrants under the Black-Scholes model at each balance sheet date:

 

     Year ended December 31,  
         2011             2012      

Dividend yield

     0.00     0.00

Volatility

     55.28     55.0

Expected term (years)

     6.00        5.00   

Risk-free interest rate

     1.09     0.72

 

F-29


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

Common stock warrant activity during the periods indicated is as follows:

 

     Number
of
shares
subject to
warrants
    Weighted
average
exercise
price
     Weighted
average
remaining
contractual
term
(years)
     Aggregate
intrinsic
value
 

Balance at January 1, 2011

     22,559      $ 0.76         8.83       $ 23   

Granted

     328,700        1.80         

Exercised

     (211,530     1.72            1,290   
  

 

 

         

Balance at December 31, 2011

     139,729        1.80         6.02         866   
  

 

 

         

Balance at December 31, 2012

     139,729        1.80         5.02         1,006   
  

 

 

         

Exercisable at December 31, 2012

     108,479      $ 1.80         5.02       $ 781   
  

 

 

         

 

The weighted average grant date fair value of warrants granted during the years ended December 31, 2011 was $2.56. There were no warrants granted in 2012. The total intrinsic value of warrants exercised during the years ended December 31, 2011 was $1,290. The related compensation expense for non-employee warrants recognized during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, recorded in general and administrative expense, was $859 and $206, respectively.

 

A summary of the status of the Company’s nonvested warrants to purchase common stock as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, and changes during the years ended December 31, 2012, is presented below:

 

     Number of
shares
subject to
warrants
    Weighted
average
grant-date
fair value
 

Balance at January 1, 2012

     62,500      $ 2.56   

Vested

     (31,250     2.56   
  

 

 

   

Balance at December 31, 2012

     31,250      $ 2.56   
  

 

 

   

 

At December 31, 2012, there was $181 of total unrecognized expense related to unvested warrants granted under the Plan. That cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of one year. The total fair value of warrants vested during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012 was $859 and $206, respectively.

 

10. Retirement Plans

 

a) U.S. 401(k) Plan

 

All employees are eligible to participate in the Company’s Profit Sharing 401(k) Plan according to certain age and period of service restrictions. The Plan provides for discretionary Company contributions. No Company contributions were made during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

b) India Gratuity Plan

 

In addition, under the India Payment of Gratuity Act of 1972, the Company maintains a gratuity defined-benefit plan for eligible employees of the Company’s India subsidiary. Upon termination of an employee for any reason, the Company must pay the equivalent of 15 days of the current salary to the employee for each year of service. The benefit begins to accrue after five years of service.

 

The funding liability under the plan is actuarially-determined, based on a rate of interest of 8.5% and a retirement age of 58 years, and was $434 and $555 as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively. The liability is included in accrued and other current liabilities in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. Expense under the plan was $207 and $145 for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively. The plan is currently unfunded.

 

11. Commitments and Contingencies

 

a) Legal Proceedings, Regulatory Matters and Other Contingencies

 

From time to time, the Company may become involved in legal proceedings, regulatory matters or other contingencies in the ordinary course of its business. The Company is not presently involved in any legal proceeding, regulatory matter or other contingency that, if determined adversely to it, would individually or in the aggregate have a material adverse effect on its business, operating results, financial condition or cash flows.

 

b) Bank Line of Credit

 

During the year ended December 31, 2011, the Company maintained a bank line of credit in the amount of $2,000. The Company closed the line in March 31, 2012. The Company made no draws on the line of credit during the year ended December 31, 2011 or through closure date on March 31, 2012 and no amount remains outstanding thereunder.

 

c) Lease Agreements

 

The Company leases office facilities under non-cancelable operating leases with various expiration dates. The operating leases may include options that permit renewals for additional periods. Rent abatements and escalations are considered in the determination of straight-line rent expense for operating leases. Lease incentives are recorded as a deferred credit and recognized as a reduction to rent expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

 

Future minimum lease payments under non-cancelable operating leases as of December 31, 2012 are as follows:

 

2013

   $ 3,377   

2014

     1,581   

2015

     522   

2016

     127   

2017

     130   

2018

     33   
  

 

 

 

Total minimum lease payments

   $ 5,770   
  

 

 

 

 

Rent expense under the operating leases was $1,667 and $2,080 for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

December 31, 2011 and 2012

 

d) Strategic Partnership Agreement

 

The Company is a party to a strategic partnership agreement, pursuant to which the Company is obligated to make payments in exchange for the receipt of referrals from a provider’s existing customers. The Company pays a fee based on the actual number of referrals, subject to a minimum. These fees are paid by the Company quarterly, in arrears, and the agreement is effective until November 17, 2013. The Company accrued expenses totaling $321 and $417 during 2011 and 2012, respectively, under this agreement.

 

12. Related-Party Transactions

 

In July 2011, the Company repurchased 5,669,374 shares of its common stock held by the executive officers and directors at a purchase price of $7.80 per share for the aggregate amount of $44,221.

 

13. Segment Information and Geographic Data

 

The company is organized and operates in one reportable segment. The Company’s chief operating decision maker is its chief executive officer, who reviews financial information presented on a consolidated basis for the purpose of making operating decisions and assessing financial performance.

 

Platform subscription and marketing solutions revenue are principally derived from North America. Revenue from non-North American sources represented 7% and 9% of total revenue in 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

Property and equipment in non-North American geographic locations represented 23% and 26% of total assets as of December 31, 2011 and 2012, respectively.

 

14. Subsequent Events

 

In April 2013, the Company signed two new office leases in India that will replace the existing leases when they expire. The Company will take possession of the new office space on July 1, 2013 and the leases are for a term of three years. The first lease is for 43,463 square feet of office space and the other includes 22,237 additional square feet of office space. Base rent payments for the new leases will begin in January 2014 and April 2014, respectively.

 

The Company has evaluated subsequent events through April 29, 2013, the date the financial statements were available to be issued.

 

The Company’s board of directors and stockholders authorized a reverse stock split of its outstanding common stock and Series A preferred stock at a ratio of 1-for-4. On August 5, 2013, the reverse stock split was effected such that, (i) each 4 shares of then-outstanding common stock was reduced to one share of common stock; (ii) the number of shares of common stock into which each then-outstanding share of our Series A Convertible Preferred Stock and our then-outstanding warrants or options to purchase common stock is exercisable was proportionately reduced; and (iii) the exercise price of each then-outstanding warrant or option to purchase common stock was proportionately increased. The accompanying consolidated financial statements give retroactive effect as though the 1-for-4 reverse stock split of the Company’s common and preferred stock occurred for all periods presented, without any change in the par value per share and in the authorized number of common and preferred shares. Fractional shares resulting from the reverse stock split have been rounded up to the next whole share.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

(unaudited)

 

     September 30,
2013
 

Assets

  

Current assets:

  

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 144,524   

Restricted cash

     651   

Short-term investments

     13,287   

Accounts receivable, net of reserve of $242

     15,455   

Prepaid expense and other current assets

     7,833   

Deferred tax assets

     2,486   
  

 

 

 

Total current assets

     184,236   

Property and equipment, net

     5,479   

Capitalized software development costs, net

     9,281   

Intangible assets, net

     3,322   

Goodwill

     12,505   

Other assets

     141   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 214,964   
  

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

  

Current liabilities:

  

Accounts payable

   $ 3,126   

Accrued and other current liabilities

     18,732   

Deferred revenue

     48,754   
  

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     70,612   

Deferred tax liabilities, non-current

     2,134   

Other liabilities, non-current

     263   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     73,009   

Commitments and contingencies (Note 8)

  

Stockholders’ equity

  

Series A convertible preferred stock, $0.001 par value, 100,000,000 shares authorized at September 30, 2013; zero issued and outstanding at September 30, 2013

       

Common stock, $0.001 par value; 1,000,000,000 shares authorized at September 30, 2013; 40,404,571 shares issued and 39,884,357 outstanding at September 30, 2013

     40   

Treasury stock

     (3,966

Additional paid-in capital

     168,432   

Accumulated deficit

     (22,551
  

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     141,955   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

   $ 214,964   
  

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

F-33


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

(unaudited)

 

     Nine Months Ended
September 30,
 
     2012      2013  

Revenue

   $ 59,865       $ 80,440   

Cost of revenue(1)

     14,648         21,588   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross profit

     45,217         58,852   

Operating expenses:

     

Sales and marketing(1)

     25,748         35,202   

Research and development(1)

     5,391         8,105   

General and administrative(1)

     7,957         16,891   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     39,096         60,198   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     6,121         (1,346

Interest income

     670         677   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations before income tax expense

     6,791         (669

Provision for income taxes

     4,007         2,136   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 2,784       $ (2,805
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss) per common share:

     

Basic

   $ 0.08       $ (0.14
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ 0.08       $ (0.14
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding—basic

     33,252,002         20,336,459   

Weighted average common shares outstanding—diluted

     34,847,340         20,336,459   

 

  

(1) Stock-based compensation expense included in the above:

  

Cost of revenue

   $ 586       $ 886   

Sales and marketing

     2,105         2,092   

Research and development

     392         553   

General and administrative

     734         689   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,817       $ 4,220   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

F-34


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC.

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(in thousands)

(unaudited)

 

     Nine Months Ended
September 30,
 
     2012     2013  

Operating activities:

    

Net income (loss)

   $ 2,784      $ (2,805

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:

    

Depreciation and amortization

     3,863        5,782   

Foreign currency transaction (gain) loss

     (11     568   

Stock-based compensation expense

     3,817        4,220   

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

    

Accounts receivable, net

     6,668        13,626   

Prepaid expenses and other assets

     (1,237     (4,744

Accounts payable, accrued and other liabilities

     10,721        5,051   

Deferred revenue

     (857     (2,800
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

     25,748        18,898   

Investing activities:

    

Purchase of property and equipment and capitalized software development costs

     (6,036     (7,761

Sale (purchase) of short-term investments

     1,422        (3,967

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired

     (7,237     (90

Restricted cash

     (473     (196
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (12,324     (12,014

Financing activities:

    

Repurchase of preferred, common stock, and warrants

     (3,950     (1,275

Proceeds from exercise of stock options and warrants

     1,133        502   

Proceeds from Initial Public Offering, net of expenses

            122,131   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

     (2,817     121,358   

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     11        (568

Increase in cash and cash equivalents

     10,618        127,674   

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

     18,150        16,850   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

   $ 28,768      $ 144,524   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental cash flow information:

    

Income taxes paid

   $ 1,888      $ 3,062   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental disclosure of noncash investing activities:

    

Issuance of common stock in acquisition

   $ 935      $   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

F-35


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

1. Description of Business

 

Cvent, Inc. (the “Company”) was incorporated on August 20, 1999 in the State of Delaware. The Company provides a cloud-based enterprise event management platform with solutions for both sides of the events and meetings value chain: (i) event and meeting planners and (ii) hotels and venues. The Company’s integrated, cloud-based solution addresses the entire event lifecycle by allowing event and meeting planners to organize, market and manage their meetings, conferences, tradeshows and other events. The Company’s online marketplace connects event planners and venues through its vertical search engine that accesses its proprietary database of detailed hotel and venue information. The combination of these solutions creates an integrated platform that allows the Company to generate revenue from both sides of the events and meetings value chain.

 

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

 

(a) Basis of Presentation

 

The financial information presented in the accompanying unaudited consolidated financial statements as of September 30, 2013, and for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 has been prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (U.S. GAAP) and in accordance with rules and regulations of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) regarding interim financial reporting. Accordingly, they do not include all of the information and footnotes required by US GAAP for complete financial statements. In the opinion of management, the accompanying unaudited consolidated financial statements reflect all adjustments, consisting primarily of normal recurring accruals, necessary for a fair presentation of the financial position as of September 30, 2013, and the results of operations for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 and cash flows for the nine month periods ended September 30, 2013 and 2012. These unaudited consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the annual audited consolidated financial statements and notes thereto.

 

(b) Principles of Consolidation

 

The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Cvent and its wholly-owned subsidiaries. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

 

(c) Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Significant estimates and assumptions made by management include estimated useful lives of property and equipment, application of appropriate revenue recognition standards, allowances for doubtful accounts, valuation of deferred tax assets, stock-based compensation, income taxes and legal and other contingencies. The current economic environment may have increased the degree of uncertainty inherent in some of those estimates and assumptions. Actual results could differ from those estimates and assumptions.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

(d) Cash and Cash Equivalents

 

Highly liquid financial instruments purchased with original maturities of 90 days or less at the date of purchase including money market securities held in the U.S. are reported as cash equivalents. Cash equivalents are recorded at cost, which approximates fair value and include approximately $122.1 million of proceeds from the Company’s initial public offering.

 

Included in cash and cash equivalents are funds representing amounts reserved for the face value of registration fees or tickets sold on behalf of customers. While these cash accounts are not restricted as to their use, a liability for amounts due to customers under these arrangements has been recorded in accounts payable in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. The Company had amounts due to customers of $1,964 as of September 30, 2013.

 

(e) Short-Term Investments

 

The Company’s short-term investments consist of highly liquid financial instruments with original maturities greater than 90 days but less than one year. These short-term investments are comprised of certificates-of-deposit held in India and are carried at fair value.

 

(f) Revenue Recognition

 

The Company derives revenue from two primary sources: platform subscription-based products and marketing solutions. These services are generally provided under annual and multi-year contracts and revenue is generally recognized on a straight-line basis over the life of the contract. The Company recognizes revenue when all of the following conditions are met:

 

  (i)   persuasive evidence exists of an arrangement with the customer reflecting the terms and conditions under which the products or services will be provided;

 

  (ii)   delivery to customers has occurred or services have been rendered;

 

  (iii)   the fee is fixed or determinable; and

 

  (iv)   collection of the fees is reasonably assured.

 

The Company considers a signed agreement or other similar documentation to be persuasive evidence of an arrangement. Collectability is assessed based on a number of factors, including transaction history and the creditworthiness of a customer. If it is determined that collection is not reasonably assured, revenue is not recognized until collection becomes reasonably assured, which is generally upon receipt of cash.

 

The Company adopted the provisions of FASB ASU 2009-13, Revenue Recognition (Topic 605): Multiple-Deliverable Revenue Arrangements (EITF Issue No. 08-1, Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables) with respect to its multiple-element arrangements entered into or significantly modified on or after January 1, 2011. ASU 2009-13 amends ASC 605-25 to eliminate the requirement that all undelivered elements have vendor specific objective evidence (VSOE) or third-party evidence (TPE) of selling price before an entity can recognize the portion of an overall arrangement fee that is attributable to items that have already been delivered. The adoption of ASU 2009-13 did not have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations.

 

F-37


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

Deferred revenue consists of billings or payments received in advance of revenue recognition from platform subscription services or marketing solutions that are subsequently recognized when the revenue recognition criteria are met. The Company generally invoices customers in annual or quarterly installments.

 

Platform Subscription Revenue

 

The Company generates the majority of its revenue through software-as-a-service (SaaS) subscriptions to the event management platform, pricing for which is subject to the features and functionality selected. No features or functionality within the subscription-based services have stand alone value from one another and, therefore, the entire subscription fee is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the subscription arrangement.

 

SaaS subscriptions may include functionality that enables customers to manage the registration of participants attending the customer’s event or events. In some cases, the negotiated fee for the subscription is based on a maximum number of event registrations permitted over the subscription term. At any time during the subscription term, customers may elect to purchase blocks of additional registrations, which are referred to as up-sells. The fees associated with the up-sells are added to the original subscription fee, and the revenue is recognized over the remaining subscription period. In other more limited cases, a customer may purchase additional registrations on a pay-as-you-go basis, which are referred to as overages. The revenue for overages is recognized as each additional registration is used by the customer. No portion of the subscription fee is refundable regardless of the actual number of registrations that occur. Other subscription-based solutions include the sale of mobile event apps as well as survey solutions, both of which are contracted through annual or multi-year agreements.

 

Subscription agreements do not provide customers with the right to take possession of the underlying software at any time.

 

Marketing Solutions Revenue

 

Marketing solutions revenue is generated through the delivery of various forms of advertising sold through annual or multi-year advertising contracts. Such solutions include prominent display of a customer’s venue within the Cvent Supplier Network, the Cvent Destination Guide or in various electronic newsletters. Pricing for the advertisements is based on the targeted geography, number of advertisements and prominence of the ad placement.

 

The Company enters into arrangements with multiple deliverables that generally include various marketing solutions that may be sold individually or bundled together and delivered over various periods of time. In such situations, the Company applies the provisions of Financial Accounting Standards Board, or FASB, Accounting Standards Codification, or ASC, No. 605-25, Revenue Recognition—Multiple Element Arrangements to account for the various elements within the marketing solution agreements delivered over the platform. Under such guidance, in order to treat deliverables in a multiple-deliverable arrangement as separate units of accounting, the deliverables must have standalone value upon delivery. If the deliverables have standalone value upon delivery, the Company accounts for each deliverable separately and revenue is recognized ratably over the contractual period that the related advertising deliverable is provided. Annual marketing solutions on the Cvent Supplier Network are often sold separately, and, as such, all have standalone value.

 

F-38


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

Some one-time marketing solutions, which can run for a month, several months, or a year, are primarily sold in a package. In determining whether the marketing solutions sold in packages have standalone value, the Company considers the availability of the services from other vendors, the nature of the solutions, and the contractual dependence of the solutions to the rest of the package. The Company has concluded that all of the marketing solutions in the packages included in multiple-deliverable arrangements executed have standalone value.

 

Revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables are divided into separate units of accounting and the arrangement consideration is allocated to all deliverables based on the relative selling price method. In such circumstances, the Company uses the selling price hierarchy of: (i) vendor specific objective evidence of fair value, or VSOE, if available, (ii) third-party evidence of selling price, or TPE, and (iii) best estimate of selling price. VSOE is limited to the price charged when the same element is sold separately by the Company. Due to the unique nature of some multiple deliverable revenue arrangements, the Company may not be able to establish selling prices based on historical stand-alone sales using VSOE or TPE; therefore the Company may use its best estimate to establish selling prices for these arrangements. The Company establishes the best estimates within a range of selling prices considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, factors such as size of transaction, customer demand and price lists.

 

(g) Comprehensive Income

 

There was no material difference between net income (loss) presented in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss) for each of the nine month periods ended September 30, 2013 and 2012.

 

(h) Fair Value Measurements

 

Fair value represents the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. Valuation techniques used to measure fair value must maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. The fair value hierarchy is based on the following three levels of inputs, of which the first two are considered observable and the last one is considered unobservable:

 

   

Level 1 Inputs: Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities accessible to the reporting entity at the measurement date.

 

   

Level 2 Inputs: Other than quoted prices included in Level 1 inputs that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly, for substantially the full term of the asset or liability.

 

   

Level 3 Inputs: Unobservable inputs that require the Company to use present value and other valuation techniques in the determination of fair value.

 

The Company’s financial instruments include cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments, accounts receivable accounts payable and accrued liabilities. The carrying value of these financial instruments on the consolidated balance sheets approximate their fair value based on their short-term nature.

 

The Company is also subject to certain contingent consideration arrangements associated with recent acquisitions that are based on achieving specified operating targets and the passage of time. Assumptions

 

F-39


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

including revenue forecasts, future market opportunities, complexity and size of addressable markets and the scalability of the product are developed to determine the fair value of such contingent consideration. In addition, the probability of achieving the specified targets is considered in determining the fair value of the contingent consideration included in the purchase price. Cvent will continue to remeasure contingent consideration to fair value at each reporting date, and will recognize any changes to the fair value in earnings for any changes resulting from events after the acquisition date, such as meeting a sales target.

 

(i) Foreign Currency Transactions

 

The Company has designated the U.S. dollar as its functional currency for its foreign subsidiary in India. For the subsidiary, assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currency are remeasured into U.S. dollars at current exchange rates for monetary assets and liabilities and historical exchange rates for nonmonetary assets and liabilities. Foreign currency gains and losses associated with remeasurement are included in general and administrative expense in the consolidated statements of operations.

 

Foreign currency gains (losses) associated with remeasurement and transaction gains (losses) were $(2,009) and $(110) for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

The Company’s subsidiary in the United Kingdom designates the British pound as the functional currency. For the subsidiary, balances are translated into U.S. dollars at current exchange rates. For the nine months ended September 30, 2013, foreign currency translation and transaction losses were immaterial.

 

(j) Foreign Currency Forward Contracts

 

The Company is exposed to certain risks related to its ongoing business operations, including the effect of changes in foreign exchange rates on the Company’s monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currency. The Company occasionally uses short-term foreign currency forward contracts as part of its strategy to manage these risks but does not hold or issue derivative instruments for trading purposes or speculation. These foreign currency forward contracts do not meet the requirements for hedge accounting and changes in the fair value of these derivative instruments are recorded in general and administrative expenses in the Company’s consolidated statement of operations.

 

Prior to the quarter ended September 30, 2013, the Company entered into short-term exchange-rate related forward contracts to purchase Indian Rupees. As of September 30, 2013, the Company had entered into forward contracts with a total notional value of $2.5 million, and all contracts had expired at various dates from July through September 2013. Through September 30, 2013, the Company has recorded a realized loss of $32, net of transaction costs, related to these forward contracts within general and administrative expenses.

 

3. Initial Public Offering

 

On August 14, 2013, the Company completed its Initial Public Offering (IPO) of common stock. In connection with the Company’s IPO, the Company’s Board of Directors and stockholders approved a 1-for-4 reverse stock split of its outstanding common stock and convertible preferred stock effective August 5, 2013. All share and per share amounts contained in the accompanying consolidated financial statements have been retroactively adjusted to reflect the reverse stock split. Upon completion of the Company’s IPO, (i) all outstanding shares of convertible preferred stock converted into an aggregate of 17,418,807 shares of common stock and (ii) the Company issued 6,440,000 shares of common stock resulting in net proceeds of $122.1 million after deducting the underwriters discount and offering expenses.

 

F-40


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

4. Net Income (Loss) Per Share

 

The Company calculates basic net income per share of common stock by dividing net income attributable to the common stockholders for the period by the weighted-average number of shares of common stock and participating convertible preferred stock outstanding during the period. The Company calculates diluted net income per share by dividing net income attributable to the Company for the period by the weighted-average number of shares of common stock and convertible preferred stock outstanding during the period, plus any dilutive effect from share-based equity awards and warrants during the period, as calculated for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 using the treasury stock method. The Series A Convertible Preferred Stock does not participate in positive earnings differently than common stock. Accordingly, the net income attributable to common and preferred stockholders would be divided proportionately by the number of shares outstanding of each and there would be no difference in the determination of basic and diluted net income per share calculated separately for common and preferred stock. As of August 8, 2013, the preferred stock converted to common stock on a 1:1 basis, being included in the basic EPS calculation for positive and negative earnings from that point forward. Included in the diluted weighted average shares outstanding is the unvested portion of early option exercises of 573,941 shares on June 13, 2012. These unvested shares are removed from the basic earnings per share calculation as the shares can be repurchased by the Company prior to the vesting date should employment of the early exercised option shareholders be terminated. On March 11 and July 16, 2013, 244,009 and 11,563, respectively, of these shares vested. The computation of basic and diluted net income per share is as follows:

 

     Nine Months Ended
September 30,
 
     2013     2012  

Net income (loss)

   $ (2,805   $ 2,784   

Weighted average number of shares outstanding:

    

Weighted average common shares outstanding

     20,336,459        15,833,195   

Effect of convertible preferred stock

            17,418,807   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding for basic earnings per share

     20,336,459        33,252,002   

Effect of share-based equity award plan

            1,532,210   

Effect of warrants

            63,128   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding for diluted earnings per share

     20,336,459        34,847,340   

Net income (loss) per share:

    

Basic

   $ (0.14   $ 0.08   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted

   $ (0.14   $ 0.08   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

The weighted average number of shares outstanding used in the computation of basic and diluted loss per share for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 does not include the effect of 14,037,134 shares of convertible preferred stock, as these shares are not obligated to participate in losses. The weighted average number of shares outstanding used in the computation of diluted loss per share for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 do not include the effect of 1,867,295 stock options and warrants. The effect of these potentially outstanding shares were not included in the calculation of diluted loss per share because the effect would have been anti-dilutive.

 

F-41


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

5. Income Taxes

 

The Company has historically estimated its annual effective tax rate for the full fiscal year and applied that rate to its income from continuing operations before income taxes in determining its provision for income taxes for the respective periods. The Company has also historically recorded discrete items in each respective period as appropriate. However, if a company is unable to reliably estimate its annual effective tax rate, then the actual effective tax rate for the year-to-date may be the best estimate for the annual effective tax rate. For the nine months ended September 30, 2013, the Company determined that the annual rate method would not provide for a reliable estimate due to its sensitivity to minimal changes in forecasted annual pre-tax earnings. As a result, the Company has recorded the provision for income taxes for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 using the actual effective rate for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 (the “cut-off” method). The effective tax rate for the nine months ended September 30, 2012 was calculated based on an estimated annual effective tax rate plus discrete items. The Company’s consolidated effective tax rate for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012 was (319.3)% and 59.0%, respectively. The decrease in rate from the comparable period is primarily due to the ratio of book expenses that are not deductible for income tax purposes compared to pre-tax book income (loss), principally related to stock compensation expense. Additionally, the decrease in rate from the comparable period is primarily related to the decrease in income from operations before income tax, placing the Company in a loss position for operations before income tax expense for the nine months ended September 30, 2013, as opposed to an income position for the nine months ended September 30, 2012.

 

The Company’ estimated effective tax rate is subject to fluctuation based upon the level and mix of earnings and losses by tax jurisdiction, and the relative impact of permanent book to tax differences (e.g., non-deductible expenses). Each quarter, a cumulative adjustment is recorded for any fluctuations in the estimated annual effective tax rate as compared to the prior quarter. As a result of these factors, and due to potential changes in the Company’s period to period results, fluctuations in the Company’s effective tax rate and respective tax provisions or benefits may occur. The Company is subject to U.S. federal income tax, various state income taxes and various foreign income taxes. The effective income tax rate for the nine months ended September 30, 2013 reflects various foreign income taxes and estimated benefit of the 2013 U.S. Federal Research and Development Tax Credit.

 

In assessing the Company’s ability to realize the future benefit associated with its deferred tax assets, management considers whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets may not be realized. The ultimate realization is dependent on the generation of taxable income within the periods that those temporary differences become deductible. The Company has not recorded a valuation allowance for its U.S. deferred tax assets due to management’s assessment that it is more-likely-than-not that the Company will be able to realize these tax assets.

 

The Company has recorded a valuation allowance on certain foreign net operating loss carryforwards and does not currently anticipate recording an income tax benefit related to these deferred tax assets. The Company will reassess the realization of deferred tax assets based on accounting standards for income taxes each reporting period and will be able to reduce the valuation allowance to the extent that the financial results of these operations improve and it becomes more likely than not that the deferred tax assets are realizable.

 

The Company permanently reinvests cumulative undistributed earnings of its non-U.S. subsidiaries in non-U.S. operations. U.S. federal income taxes have not been provided for in relation to undistributed earnings to the extent that they are permanently reinvested in the Company’s non-U.S. operations. It is not practical at this time to determine the income tax liability that would result upon repatriation to the U.S. As of September 30, 2013, the undistributed earnings of the Company’s foreign affiliates was $1,614.

 

F-42


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

The Company’s practice is to recognize interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in income tax expense.

 

6. Stock-Based Compensation Plan

 

As of September 30, 2013, the Company has only granted stock options settleable in shares. Stock options can be granted with an exercise price less than, equal to or greater than the stock’s fair value at the date of grant. The awards have various terms and vest at various times from the date of grant, with most options vesting in tranches generally over four years. All options expire 10 years after the date of grant. At September 30, 2013, there were 4,923,771 shares available for the Company to grant under the 2013 Equity Incentive Plan.

 

The grant-date fair value of each option award is estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. The weighted average assumptions for grants made during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 are provided in the following table. Because the Company’s shares were not publicly traded during those periods prior to August 9, 2013 and its shares were rarely traded privately, expected volatility is estimated based on the average historical volatility of similar entities with publicly traded shares. The risk-free rate for the expected term of the option is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve at the date of grant. Expense is recognized using the straight-line attribution method.

 

The following is a summary of the weighted average assumptions used in the valuation of stock-based awards under the Black-Scholes model:

 

     Nine Months Ended
September 30, 2013
 

Dividend yield

     0.00

Volatility

     53.86

Expected term (years)

     6.43   

Risk-free interest rate

     1.37

 

Stock option activity during the periods indicated is as follows:

 

     Number of
shares
subject to
options
    Weighted
average
exercise
price per
share
     Weighted
average
remaining
contractual
term
     Aggregate
intrinsic
value
 

Balance at December 31, 2012

     3,290,039      $ 2.40         8.08       $ 23,030   

Granted

     1,072,651        12.72         

Exercised

     (629,850     1.47         

Forfeited

     (90,144     5.56         

Expired

     (625     8.00         
  

 

 

         

Balance at September 30, 2013

     3,642,071      $ 5.51         8.10       $ 102,685   
  

 

 

         

Exercisable at September 30, 2013

     887,299      $ 1.58         6.96       $ 29,804   

 

The weighted average grant date fair value of options granted during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 was $6.74. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 was $21,226.

 

F-43


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

The Company recorded stock-based compensation expense related to options of $1,321 and $624 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively. At September 30, 2013, there was $6,750 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested stock options granted under the Plan. That cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 2.34 years.

 

On June 13, 2012, 573,941 of stock options were exercised prior to vesting pursuant to an early exercise feature. The proceeds from the transaction were recorded as a liability within accrued and other current liabilities and other liabilities, non-current. During the nine months ended September 30, 2013, 255,572 of these options vested and the portion of the liability related to the vesting options was reclassified to the Company’s stockholders’ equity. The remainder will be reclassified to stockholders’ equity as the Company’s repurchase rights lapse as the options vest.

 

Common Stock Valuations

 

In addition to the values derived from the valuation models, management and the Company’s Board of Directors also considered relevant market activity including the then anticipated Initial Public Offering (IPO), and other recent events, including the July 2011 transaction described below in evaluating the estimate of fair value per share for stock options granted during 2011 and 2012. As a result, the Company recorded additional stock-based compensation expense of $775 and $868 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively based on subsequent increases to the Company’s initial estimate of fair value. At September 30, 2013, there was $1,358 of unrecognized compensation cost related to the revised estimated fair value of stock at grant dates included in total unrecognized compensation cost.

 

F-44


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

7. Stockholders’ Equity

 

a) Changes in Stockholders’ Equity

 

In connection with the Company’s IPO (note 3), the Company issued an additional 6,440,000 shares for net proceeds of $122.1 million. Upon closing of the IPO on August 8, 2013, all shares of Series A convertible preferred stock were converted to common stock. Changes in stockholders’ equity for the nine-months ended September 30, 2013 were as follows (in thousands, except for share amounts):

 

    Preferred
Stock
    Series A
Convertible
Preferred
Stock
    Common
Stock
    Common
Stock
    Treasury
Stock
    Additional
Paid-In
Capital
    Accumulated
Deficit
    Total
Stockholders’
Equity
 

Balance as of December 31, 2012

    17,418,807        17        15,901,183        16        (3,966     42,409        (19,746     18,730   

Net Loss

                                              (2,805     (2,805

Share-based compensation expense

                                       4,220               4,220   

Exercise of stock options and warrants

                  389,009        1               502               503   

Issuance of common stock upon vesting of early exercised options

                  255,572                      451               451   

Repurchase of warrants

                                       (1,275            (1,275

Conversion of preferred stock to common stock

    (17,418,807     (17     17,418,807        17                               

Issuance of common stock in IPO

                  6,440,000        6               122,125               122,131   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of September 30, 2013

                  40,404,571        40        (3,966     168,432        (22,551     141,955   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

b) Common Stock Call Option

 

In conjunction with the Company’s July 2011 recapitalization transaction, the Company entered into a stock repurchase agreement (the Agreement) with certain members of senior management. The Agreement included a contractual call option, providing the Company an option to repurchase up to 50% of the employee’s then outstanding shares of common stock for $7.80 per share in the event of resignation or termination by the employee. The call option was effective for the two-year period following the July 2011 transaction and represented a compensatory arrangement in that the key employees were required to continue employment for a period of two years to earn back the right to participate in any appreciation in the value of the underlying shares or be subject to repurchase under the Company’s call option. Pursuant to the terms of the Agreement, stock options that vested and were exercised by management during the two-year period of the Agreement became subject to the repurchase provisions. The Company’s right to repurchase these shares expired July 15, 2013.

 

The Company recorded stock-based compensation expense related to call options of $1,824 and $2,170 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively. At September 30, 2013, there was no remaining unrecognized compensation cost related to call options.

 

F-45


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

As of December 31, 2012, the Company had repurchased 504,559 shares of common stock at $7.80 per share for a total of $3,950 under the Agreement resulting from the exercise of its call option in connection with the termination of the Company’s former chief financial officer. The repurchased shares are held in treasury stock at cost. No other shares were repurchased prior to the expiration of the call option.

 

c) Common Stock Warrants

 

In 2011, the Company issued warrants to a non-employee to purchase 125,000 shares of common stock, in connection with a profit-sharing agreement. The warrants had an exercise price of $1.80, vested annually over a four-year period, and expired on December 31, 2017. On June 28, 2013, the Company repurchased these warrants for $1,275, which was equal to the estimated fair value at the time of purchase of $12.00 per share less the exercise price of $1.80. There were no warrants granted and 14,729 warrants were exercised at an exercise price of $1.80 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013.

 

Unvested warrants to non-employees are re-measured at fair value as of each balance sheet date. The Company recorded stock-based compensation expense in general and administrative expense related to non-employee warrants of $299 and $154 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

At September 30, 2013, there was no unrecognized expense related to unvested warrants granted under the Plan as there were no outstanding warrants.

 

8. Commitments and Contingencies

 

a) Legal Proceedings, Regulatory Matters and Other Contingencies

 

From time to time, the Company may become involved in legal proceedings, regulatory matters or other contingencies in the ordinary course of its business. The Company is not presently involved in any legal proceeding, regulatory matter or other contingency that, if determined adversely to it, would individually or in the aggregate have a material adverse effect on its business, operating results, financial condition or cash flows.

 

b) Strategic Partnership Agreement

 

The Company is a party to a strategic partnership agreement, pursuant to which the Company is obligated to make payments in exchange for the receipt of referrals from a provider’s existing customers. The Company pays a fee based on the actual number of referrals, subject to a minimum. These fees are paid by the Company quarterly, in arrears, and the agreement is effective until November 17, 2013. The Company accrued expenses totaling $225 and $308 during the nine months ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively, under this agreement. On June 28, 2013 the Company renewed its strategic partnership agreement, effective November 18, 2013 through November 19, 2017. Under the renewal agreement, the Company pays a set fee each quarter in exchange for the receipt of referrals from a provider’s existing customers.

 

F-46


Table of Contents

CVENT, INC

 

NOTES TO UNAUDITED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands, except share and per share data)

September 30, 2012 and 2013

 

c) Acquisition Payouts

 

A summary of the changes in the recorded amount of accrued compensation and consideration from acquisitions from December 31, 2012 to September 30, 2013 is as follows (dollars in thousands):

 

Acquisition:

   Liability as of
December 31, 2012
     Payments     Additional
Accruals
     Liability as of
September 30,
2013
 

CrowdTorch (Seed Labs)

     280         (280     206         206   

CrowdCompass

     736         (1,388     1,471         819   

TicketMob

                    375         375   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,016         (1,668     2,052         1,400   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

The accrued compensation and consideration related to acquisition payouts is recorded within accrued and other current liabilities on the balance sheet.

 

On September 30, 2013, the Company amended its payout agreement with one of the individuals from its CrowdCompass acquisition due to the individual’s resignation from employment. The updated agreement removed the requirement for the individual to remain employed by the Company in order to receive payment and reduced the individual’s year three payout. As the amended agreement eliminates the service requirement, the full amount of the remaining year two and amended year three payouts have been recorded as compensation expense in the current period and accrued as of September 30, 2013 and will be paid over the next two years.

 

9. Subsequent Events

 

The Company has evaluated subsequent events through November 12, 2013, the date the financial statements were available to be issued.

 

In October 2013, the Company signed a new lease for office space in McLean, VA that will replace the existing lease for the Company’s corporate headquarters when it expires in 2014. The new lease is for a fixed 11-year term with options for two additional renewal terms of five years each. The new lease will cover approximately 129,000 square feet of office space and will include tenant improvements of $7.2 million. The Company expects to occupy the new office space during the third quarter of 2014 with contractual base rent payments of $40.7 million beginning in August 2014.

 

F-47


Table of Contents

Schedule II—VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS

 

Description

   Balance at
Beginning of
Period
     Charged to
Costs and
Expenses
     Charged to
Other
Accounts
     Deductions      Balance at
End of
Period
 

Year ended December 31, 2011:

              

Allowance for doubtful accounts

   $ 286       $ 180               $ 140       $ 326   

Year ended December 31, 2012:

              

Allowance for doubtful accounts

     326         344                 165         505   

 

F-48


Table of Contents

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 


Table of Contents

PART II

 

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

 

ITEM 13. Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

 

The following table sets forth all expenses to be paid by the registrant, other than estimated underwriting discounts and commissions, in connection with this offering. All amounts shown are estimates except for the Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, or FINRA, filing fee and the exchange listing fee:

 

     Amount
to be Paid
 

Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee

   $ 25,950   

FINRA filing fee

     30,722   

Blue Sky fees and expenses

     20,000   

Printing and engraving expenses

     125,000   

Legal fees and expenses

     275,000   

Accounting fees and expenses

     175,000   

Transfer agent and registrar fees

     8,800   

Miscellaneous

     50,000   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 710,472   
  

 

 

 

 

ITEM 14. Indemnification of Directors and Officers

 

Section 145(a) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that a Delaware corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than an action by or in the right of the corporation) by reason of the fact that such person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation or enterprise, against expenses (including attorneys’ fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection with such action, suit or proceeding if he or she acted in good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no cause to believe his or her conduct was unlawful.

 

Section 145(b) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that a Delaware corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action or suit by or in the right of the corporation to procure a judgment in its favor by reason of the fact that such person acted in any of the capacities set forth above, against expenses (including attorneys’ fees) actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection with the defense or settlement of such action or suit if he or she acted under similar standards, except that no indemnification may be made in respect of any claim, issue or matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be liable to the corporation unless and only to the extent that the court in which such action or suit was brought shall determine that, despite the adjudication of liability but in view of all the circumstances of the case, such person is fairly and reasonably entitled to be indemnified for such expenses which the court shall deem proper.

 

Section 145 of the Delaware General Corporation Law further provides that: (i) to the extent that a former or present director or officer of a corporation has been successful in the defense of any action, suit or proceeding referred to in subsections (a) and (b) or in the defense of any claim, issue or matter therein, such person shall be

 

II-1


Table of Contents

indemnified against expenses (including attorneys’ fees) actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection therewith; (ii) indemnification provided for by Section 145 shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which the indemnified party may be entitled; and (iii) the corporation may purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any present or former director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation or any person who at the request of the corporation was serving in such capacity for another entity against any liability asserted against such person and incurred by him or her in any such capacity or arising out of his or her status as such, whether or not the corporation would have the power to indemnify him or her against such liabilities under Section 145.

 

In addition, the proposed form of Underwriting Agreement (to be filed by amendment) is expected to provide for indemnification of our directors and officers by the underwriters against certain liabilities.

 

Article X of our certificate of incorporation authorizes us to provide for the indemnification of directors to the fullest extent permissible under Delaware law.

 

Article VII of our bylaws provides for the indemnification of officers, directors and third parties acting on our behalf if such person acted in good faith and in a manner reasonably believed to be in and not opposed to our best interest and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, the indemnified party had no reason to believe his or her conduct was unlawful.

 

We have entered into indemnification agreements with our directors, executive officers and others, in addition to indemnification provided for in our bylaws, and intend to enter into indemnification agreements with any new directors and executive officers in the future.

 

We have purchased and intend to maintain insurance on behalf of any person who is or was a director or officer against any loss arising from any claim asserted against him or her and incurred by him or her in any such capacity, subject to certain exclusions.

 

See also the undertakings set out in response to Item 17 herein.

 

ITEM 15. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

 

Since January 1, 2011, we have made the following sales of unregistered securities:

 

1. From January 1, 2011 through August 8, 2013 (the date we first became subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act), we granted options under our Stock Incentive Plan to purchase an aggregate of 4,186,495 shares of our common stock to employees, having exercise prices ranging from $1.80 to $12.00 per share. Of these, options to purchase an aggregate of 343,140 shares have been cancelled without being exercised. During the period from January 1, 2011 through through August 29, 2013, an aggregate of 931,036 shares were issued upon the exercise of stock options, at exercise prices between $0.01 and $1.80 per share, for aggregate proceeds of approximately $1.0 million.

 

2. In March 2011, we granted warrants to purchase an aggregate of 328,700 shares of our common stock to nine accredited investors at a per share price of $1.80. In July 2011, 188,974 shares were issued and 43,609 shares were surrendered to us upon the cashless exercise of these warrants by seven of the accredited investor holders. In June 2013, 14,729 shares were issued pursuant to a cash exercise by one of the accredited investors holders.

 

3. In July 2011, we issued an aggregate of 17,418,807 shares of our Series A preferred stock to ten accredited investors at a per share price of $7.80, for aggregate consideration of approximately $135.9 million.

 

4. In July 2011, we issued 22,559 shares of common stock upon the exercise of outstanding warrants to one accredited investor at a per share price of $0.76 by one accredited investors holder.

 

5. In January 2012, we issued an aggregate of 116,925 shares of our common stock with a value of approximately $0.9 million at the time of issuance to five non-accredited investors pursuant to Rule 504 promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

 

II-2


Table of Contents

None of the foregoing transactions involved any underwriters, underwriting discounts or commissions, or any public offering, and we believe the transactions were exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act of 1933 in reliance on Section 4(2) thereof, and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, Regulation D thereof, and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, or Rule 701 thereunder, as transactions by an issuer not involving a public offering or transactions pursuant to compensatory benefit plans and contracts relating to compensation as provided under such Rule 701. The recipients of securities in such transactions represented their intention to acquire the securities for investment only and not with a view to or for sale in connection with any distribution thereof, and appropriate legends were affixed to the share certificates and instruments issued in such transactions. Certain of the recipients of securities pursuant to Item 1 above represented to us that they were accredited investors, as defined in Rule 501 promulgated under the Securities Act, and received adequate information about the registrant or had access, through their respective relationships with the registrant, to such information. The recipients of securities pursuant to Items 2 and 3 represented to us that they were accredited investors as defined in Rule 501 promulgated under the Securities Act.

 

ITEM 16. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

 

(a) Exhibits

 

A list of exhibits filed herewith is contained in the exhibit index that immediately precedes such exhibits and is incorporated herein by reference.

 

(b) Financial Statement Schedule

 

See page F-48 of Part I for financial statement schedules included in this Registration Statement, which are incorporated by reference herein.

 

ITEM 17. Undertakings

 

The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the underwriting agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.

 

Insofar as indemnification by the Registrant for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the provisions described in Item 14 or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

 

The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that:

 

(1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(l) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.

 

(2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

 

II-3


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the registrant has duly caused this Amendment No. 2 to Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the County of Fairfax, Commonwealth of Virginia, on the fifteenth day of January, 2014.

 

Cvent, Inc.
By:   /s/ Rajeev K. Aggarwal
 

Rajeev K. Aggarwal

Chief Executive Officer

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Amendment No. 2 to Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated:

 

Signature

  

Title

 

Date

/s/    Rajeev K. Aggarwal        

Rajeev K. Aggarwal

  

Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer

(Principal Executive Officer)

  January 15, 2014

/s/    Peter L. Childs        

Peter L. Childs

  

Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

  January 15, 2014

*

Sanju K. Bansal

   Director  

*

Tony Florence

   Director  

*

Jeffrey Lieberman

   Director  

*

Kevin T. Parker

   Director  

 

* By:  

/s/    Rajeev K. Aggarwal        

Rajeev K. Aggarwal

Attorney-in-fact

   Director   January 15, 2014

 

II-4


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

            Incorporated by Reference  

Exhibit
Number

    

Description

   Form    File No.      Exhibit
Number
   Filing Date  
    1.1*       Form of Underwriting Agreement.            
    2.1       Stock Purchase Agreement, dated June 12, 2012, by and among Registrant, CrowdCompass, Inc. and stockholders of CrowdCompass, Inc.    S-1      333-189837       2.1      July 8, 2013   
    3.1       Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation.    S-1/A      333-189837       3.2      August 5, 2013   
    3.2       Amended and Restated Bylaws    S-1      333-189837       3.3      July 8, 2013   
    4.1       Second Amended and Restated Investors’ Rights Agreement, dated July 15, 2011, by and among Registrant and certain security holders of Registrant.    S-1      333-189837       4.1      July 8, 2013   
    5.1*       Opinion of Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional Corporation.            
  10.1+       Form of Indemnification Agreement entered into between Registrant and its directors and executive officers.    S-1      333-189837       10.1      July 8, 2013   
  10.2+       Stock Incentive Plan, as amended to date.    S-1      333-189837       10.4      July 8, 2013   
  10.3+       Form of Stock Option Agreement under Stock Incentive Plan.    S-1      333-189837       10.5      July 8, 2013   
  10.4+       2013 Equity Incentive Plan.    S-1/A      333-189837       10.6      July 29, 2013   
  10.5+       Form of Stock Option Grant Notice and Stock Option Agreement under 2013 Equity Incentive Plan.    S-1/A      333-189837       10.7      July 29, 2013   
  10.6+       Form of Restricted Stock Unit Grant Notice and Restricted Stock Unit Agreement under 2013 Equity Incentive Plan.    S-1/A      333-189837       10.8      July 29, 2013   
  10.7+       Form of Restricted Stock Agreement under 2013 Equity Incentive Plan.    S-1/A      333-189837       10.14      July 29, 2013   
  10.8+       Form of Stock Repurchase Agreement by and between the Registrant and each of Rajeev K. Aggarwal, Charles V. Ghoorah, David Quattrone, Dwayne J. Sye and certain other employees of the Registrant dated July 15, 2011.    S-1      333-189837       10.10      July 8, 2013   
  10.9+       Offer Letter by and between the Registrant and Peter L. Childs, dated October 2, 2012.    S-1      333-189837       10.11      July 8, 2013   
  10.10+       Non-Employee Director Compensation Policy    S-1/A      333-189837       10.13      July 29, 2013   
  10.11       Office Lease, dated as of May 17, 2006, as amended, by and between the Registrant and Greensboro Park Property Owner LLC.    S-1/A      333-189837       10.2      August 5, 2013   


Table of Contents
            Incorporated by Reference  

Exhibit
Number

    

Description

   Form    File No.      Exhibit
Number
   Filing Date  
  10.12       Office Leases, dated as of January 13, 2010 and May 15, 2011, by and between Cvent India Private Limited and DLF Cyber City Developers Limited.    S-1      333-189837       10.3      July 8, 2013   
  10.13       Office Leases by and between Cvent India and DLF Assets Private Limited.    S-1/A      333-189837       10.15      August 5, 2013   
  10.14       Office Leases by and among Registrant and TMG Solutions Plaza 1, L.L.C., TMG Solutions Plaza 2, L.L.C., and TMG Solutions Plaza 3, L.L.C. dated October 23, 2013.    10-Q      001-36043       10.1     
 
November 12,
2013
  
  
  10.15       Service Agreement, dated as of August 23, 2010, by and between the Registrant and JPS Holdings, Inc.    S-1      333-189837       10.12      July 8, 2013   
  10.16       Third Amended and Restated Stockholders’ Agreement, dated July 15, 2011, by and among Registrant and certain security holders of Registrant.    S-1      333-189837       10.9      July 8, 2013   
  10.17       Voting Agreement, dated July 15, 2011, by and among Registrant and certain security holders of Registrant.    S-1      333-189837       4.2      July 8, 2013   
  21.1*       Subsidiaries of Registrant.            
  23.1       Consent of KPMG LLP, independent registered public accounting firm.            
  23.2*       Consent of Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional Corporation (included in Exhibit 5.1).            
  23.3*       Consent of Frost & Sullivan.            
  24.1*       Power of Attorney            
  101.INS†*       XBRL Instance Document.            
  101.SCH†*       XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema.            
  101.CAL†*       XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase.            
  101.LAB†*       XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase.            
  101.PRE†*       XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase.            
  101.DEF†*       XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase.            

 

  *   Previously filed.
  +   Indicates management contract or compensatory plan.
    XBRL (Extensible Business Reporting Language) information is furnished and not filed or a part of a registration statement or prospectus for purposes of Sections 11 or 12 of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, is deemed not filed for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and is not otherwise subject to liability under these Sections.